Home
        ARM r1p3 Computer Hardware User Manual
         Contents
1.                 191  O Electric Rear Window Defroster             191       134 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL    INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS    ON O14 09 n2       Air Outlet  Instrument Cluster  Hazard Switch  Analog Clock    Electronic Stability Program Off Button     Traction Control System Off Button     Glove Box    3  WY     9      13     Ignition Switch  14     Hood Release  15     Trunk Release Switch    16     Headlight Switch     f Equipped    7     Radio   8     Climate Control   9     Heated Seat Switch   10     Power Outlet   11     Ash Tray     12     Storage Compartment        B18f7218       UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 135    PREMIUM INSTRUMENT CLUSTER       B1BfFEcT    136 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS    1  Electronic Speed Control Indicator Light     If  Equipped     Y    2  Low Fuel Indicator Light  This light will turn on and a single chime will  sound when the fuel level drops to 1 8 tank   See  page 249 for more information      This light will turn on when the electronic  speed control is ON   See page 109 for more  information      3  Front Fog Light Indicator  4 This light will turn on when the front fog lights  are ON   See page 98 for more information      4  Turn Signal Indicators      The arrow will flash with the exterior turn signal  when the turn signal lever is operated     NOTE  Acontinuous chime will sound if the vehicle is  driven more than 1 mile  1 6 km  with either turn signa
2.               143  Service Manuals 2 54 440  dep RE Ro 3 341  Setung He Clock a vada eumd a misi 157 160 171  bellitigs  Personal wanes gar bese RR Bea Ren 153  DIE user qd SE EDE poete spo aud d dw des 199   Automatic Transmission               199 203  Shoulder Belt Upper Anchorage               34  Shoulder Belts              SS SS SS SS SS eee 30  PIU Aide MDC 43  Signals TUM 6444444554304 4ehtaeaeees 98 136  Slippery Surfaces  Driving On               209  SmartBeams 4 6   4  624464044 0443406464 SE Ho 96  Snow Chains  Tire Chains                   299  ae N  ORE 445 9 56 505 668 04s 85  236    Oem Nui one AREA KERS DR ees ee 278    Speed Control  Cruise Control                109  visco A  er  rrr  136  DiS A  Dc  196  Automatic Transmission                  197  Engine Fails to Start aus cad ESTY DIS t eS ads 197  Staran anc Ope v ED  a ER HAAS ER 196  Starting Procedures 222r re Pes as 196  Steering  Column Controls 245v RR RD Ee He 98  bnc  PL  284  ed BE AE EE ESSE RASA 213 284  Tilt Column 4a 66 ok eh a OAR n 107  Wheel TIE bies best oe EDS oe ey Se 107  Steering Wheel Mounted  Sound System Controls   meu ra EE an 179  Juro Mr  127 306  Storage Velidle qM aay oo 188 306    Storing Your Vehicle  Sun Roof  Sunglasses Storage  Supplemental Restraint System   Airbag         38  System  Navigation       358 INDEX M    Tachometer 59g une E EC RE a MA 4005808544  137  Telescoping Steering Column                107  Temperature Control  Automatic  ATC          183  Tempera
3.               ll Power Sunroof     If Equipped       D Opening Sunroof   Express    O Closing Sunroof   Express   44 m e sux 122  H Pinch  Protect Feature ss ov ope Gas Re VR ee 122  oO Pinch Protect Oveitide wesse igasse anais 123  O Venting Sunroof  Express   dese URE ERG we 129  O Sunshade Operation 222 s dci ic het omens 123  E Mind BUCHAS    444 5446 EA ME deed oa d 123  O Sunroof Maintenance soss 2444 aceto wes 123  BHIsnibon  OM Operation x 23i em deeem a 129  O Sunroof Fully Closed      edant es 124  W Electrical Power Outlets                   124  O Electrical Outlet Use With Engine Off         125    62 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    B Cup Holders                      00   126        EER EE EE EE ET 127  ELE veil oeat Cup Holde is eva sees ese  126 EMC onol te NE  so oie ME 127  HRearbeabCup Holders 24245 22x OER KERE 126 HCUFen Feds  dU ES SR sees eee ERES 127    N Load Leveling System                    129    N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 63    MIRRORS    Automatic Dimming Inside Mirror   This mirror automatically adjusts for annoying headlight  glare from vehicles behind you  You can turn the feature  on or off by pressing the button at the base of the mirror   A light in the button will indicate when the dimming  feature is activated        81789204    Automatic Dimming Mirror    CAUTION     To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning     never spray any cleaning solution directly onto the  mirror  Apply the solution onto a cl
4.           214 Pi diie PIE IE xou gara MEER EERS Eu ot 232  o ABS  Anti Lock Brake System    4c 9g s 214 D Tread Wear Indicators               LL  299  O TCS  Traction Control System               215 O Life Of Tire ies eas Ges ee ba E RE as RSS 235  H BAS  Brake Assist System        ese see 215 H Replacement Tires ars ee are HR o n 234  O ESP  Electronic Stability Program            216 O Alignment And Balance   ua ce parum d ew 235  D 5vHchtronizinp ESP sese esa deos ote RE pes 219 Ma Vite Chains   o   es see ire o BR 9 9 PR Ron 3 235  o ESP BAS Malfunction Indicator Light And W Snow Tires                     eene 236  d ME E Bt W Tire Rotation Recommendations             237  W Tire Safety Information                    220 4 Tire Rotation     Standard Mese eara aa 238  EE nes x O Tire Rotation     All Season Tires            238  D Tire Identification Number  TIN             224 ll Tire Pressure Monitor System  TPMS      If  O Tire Loading And Tire Pressure             225 ele e T              239  W Tires     General Information                229 o Base System     If Equipped                241  awilfu con PD PET wm 229 O Premium System     If Equipped            242  E Tire Inflation Pressures  2uusu weed ss ek Es 230 OGeneral Mnformation o uowaa dose Ee SE E Sess 245    O Radial Ply Tires oca duce de orba ob dede 4 202 W Fuel Requirements saccos RR c GE RE 5 84 246    ee STARTING AND OPERATING 195       miu MN rar T 246 O Vehicle Certification Label is vac Rx 252  O Re
5.          288 289 313  Disposal  2444 vows werd eed eed qo 3 am 290  Anti Lock Brake System  ABS             211 214  Anti Lock Warning Light 422x239 137 213  Anti Theft Security Alarm  Theft Alarm         15  Du Theb OVS x ascia 1 599 39 03 e ou  140  Pppeatance     JO  ioexeeso d steedbad ee Rd Ne 296  Auto Down Power Windows                 25  Auto Up Power Windows sa amem es 26  Automatic Dimming Mirror soas pis RE PL N DER 63  Automatic Door Locks                    22 23  Aditomgalc Hesdligliis 5 ups doc oro od E 95  Automatic Temperature Control  ATC          185  Automatic Transaxle  Special Additives sine Bes o homi e oh d aes 295  Automatic Transmission              203 294 295  Adding Fluid 13324425249 4553 295 315  PUMOSICN  iii Red MR de iii dr di eed aos 207  Fluid and Filter Changes 4229 SR be 295  Pid Change PD  295  Fluid Level Check 5 25 22 544 294  Po TOE ia oe AE HELE RES DRS 315    N INDEX 347    UDE PPP cm 203  Dpectal MOCUIVES  ses de 8 od arima etaa 295  PANOSHCK CC   Pr   nem 205 207  ball Jonis 232a 9e 5 6456605464 OE OE 284  DANOIS aou 555 cech ER OUE HARARE Poke eee 281  Emerecncy Staring Dp DM N 262  Jomp ei eed PE 262  Keyless Transmitter Replacement  RKE        19  Location 6 44 4 dca deser e oy dr yb e 9 263 281  DEE Ee 6 itaveiarvatarcien s in She DEE 295  Belts  Drive is Een 244546 2d RAS Adm S dd 278  belts Ded 25223323925 9909 9 5 5 5 eas tad 30  Body Mechanism Lubrication                284  BEFillat LOcauOn  4d   6 GeaGu Geer oye ee qr es
6.         e Off road or desert operation     NOTE  If ANY of these apply to you  then change your  engine oil every 3 000 miles  5 000 km  or 3 months   whichever comes first  and follow the maintenance rec   ommendations in Schedule  B  in this section     NOTE  If ANY of these apply to you  then flush and  replace the engine coolant every 102 000 miles  170 000  km  or 60 months  whichever comes first  and follow the  maintenance recommendations in Schedule  B  in this  section     M  A  l  N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       322 SCHEDULE  B      Kilometers   5 000     10 000     15 000     20 000     25 000     30 000      replaced at 3 months        a a  Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re  X X X X X  quired    Lo  o  X    Replace the air cleaner filter  MEE EE    NEM  rotors   Replace the air conditioning filter                                        X          Replace the air conditioning filter     Rotate the tires      X       J  X       X       M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8          SCHEDULE    B    323    Miles 21 000 24 000 27 000 30 000 33 000 36 000   Kilometers   35 000     40 000     45 000     50 000     55 000     60 000     Change engine oil and engine oil filter  if not  replaced at 3 months    Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re  A N  quired     aa  MEEN    Replace the air cleaner filter     Inspect the front and rear brake linings and X  rotors   Check and replace  if necessary
7.       Child Lock Control  3  Repeat Steps 1 and 2 on the opposite rear door     NOTE  After disengaging the child protection door lock  system  always test the door from the inside to make  certain it is in the desired position     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25    WINDOWS    Power Windows  The window controls on the driver s door control all the  door windows        Power Window Switches    There are single window controls on each passenger door  trim panel  which operate the passenger door windows   The window controls will operate only when the ignition  switch is in the ON or ACCESSORY position     WARNING     Never leave children in a vehicle  with the keys in  the ignition switch  Occupants  particularly unat     tended children  can become entrapped by the win   dows while operating the power window switches     Such entrapment may result in serious injury or  death        Auto Down Feature   The driver door power window switch  and some model  passenger door power window switches have an auto  down feature  Press the window switch to the second  detent  release  and the window will go down automati   cally     To open the window part way  press the window switch  to the first detent and release it when you want the  window to stop     To stop the window from going all the way down during  the auto down operation  pull up on the switch briefly     26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    The power window switches will remain active for up 
8.      105 285  leel e e sek RARR OER HAHA AE ER 307  WI Gace ou see ees A545 ETES 298    High Beant ED Sa VAAG HS 99       High Beam Low Beam Select Switch         99  Lights On Reminder 3 22a auch oos er gai PES 98  On With DERS ooi eet AREA PT 96 102  PASSIONS 142444943 20b 4E SURE Rd d d E doe die dn d 29  OW  Gos 4caetanaenees 546595 a5 e085 95  Hie Deli ai oar RE                 97  Washers 259 2354 AE EE ira 105 285  Heated Mites  oe cennen ag ghacran goes ax 65  Pigated cats  as cedo sued TT NE ETE 87  Heater Engine DICK ceased adoira diais 199  High Beam Low Beam Select   Dimmer  Switch                    less  99  Holder CUD MD ban EE e ea 126  HomeLink     Garage Door Opener  Transmitter            116  Hood RKel  ds    C  93  Hoses  Ignition  Key  Ipiugon Key Removal  24 ae ns wa Es ded 5658 11  eds teel ENUY 12 2 9270 T2 x9 ee   TAPES RE 17  IitgopINZEr  Oen Key  rere ESRA SAAK 4065 12    352 INDEX NEE Id    Infant Restraint                eee 47 48  Inflation Pressure Tires iis u   e gom oem 141  Information Center  Vehicle                 144  Instrument Cluster                 ls  135 136  Instrument Panel and Controls               134  Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning              299  Interior Appearance Gate  sis e erbe 298  Intcr FUSES 244444044007 IE HOE TUE NE 300  iese SA EN OE NE EE EER 4 100  Intermittent Wipers  Delay Wipers            101  MOL ON sa case os avete erac REDES ares     MO Satine pide RE EE Ped des 262  Key  TIOTI ducere nudos dee ey aad e
9.      116 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id  GARAGE DOOR OPENER  HomeLink       The HomeLink  Universal Transceiver replaces up to   three remote controls  hand held transmitters  that Oper  e A moving garage door can cause injury to people  ate devices such as garage door openers  motorized and pets in the path of the door  People or pets  gates  or home lighting  It triggers these devices at the could be seriously or fatally injured  Only use this    push of a button  The Universal Transceiver operates off transceiver with a garage door opener that has a    your vehicle s battery and charging system  no batteries stop and reverse  feature as required by federal  are needed safety standards  This includes most garage door    opener models manufactured after 1982  Do not    NOTE  The HomeLink   Universal Transceiver is dis  use a garage door opener without these safety            features it could cause injury or death  Call toll   abled when the Vehicle Security Alarm is active  free 1 800 355 3515 or  on the Internet at    For additional information on HomeLink    call 1 800  www homelink com for safety information or as   355 3515  or on the internet at www homelink com  sistance   Vehicle exhaust contains carbon monoxide  a dan   gerous gas  Do not run the vehicle s exhaust while  training the transceiver  Exhaust gas can cause  serious injury or death     Your motorized door or gate will open and close  while you are training the Un
10.      9  Anti Lock Brake Light    G9  This light monitors the Anti Lock Brake System   The light will turn on when the ignition switch   is turned to the ON position and may stay on for as   long as four seconds     Pus land    If the ABS light remains on or turns on while driving   then the Anti Lock portion of the brake system is not  functioning and service is required  However  the con   ventional brake system will continue to operate normally  if the BRAKE warning light is not on     UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 137    If the ABS light is on  the brake system should be serviced  as soon as possible to restore the benefits of Anti Lock  brakes  If the ABS light does not turn on when the  Ignition switch is turned to the ON position  have the  light inspected by an authorized dealer   See page 211 for  more information      10  Electronic Stability Program  ESP    Brake  Assist System  BAS  Malfunction Indicator Light  The yellow ESP BAS malfunction indicator  light will tum on when the key in the  ignition switch is turned to the  ON  posi   tion  The light should go out with the engine  running  If the light remains on after several ignition  cycles  and the vehicle has been driven several miles at  speeds greater than 30 mph  48 km h   see your  authorized dealer as soon as possible to have the  problem diagnosed and corrected   See page 214 for  more information      ESP  BAS    11  Airbag Warning Light  This light will turn on for 6 to 8 seconds as a      bulb c
11.      e You can say  O   letter  O   for  0   zero    800  must be  spoken  eight zero zero      e Even though international dialing for most number  combinations is supported  some shortcut dialing  number combinations may not be supported     Far End Audio Performance  e Audio quality is maximized under   e low to medium blower setting   e low to medium vehicle speed   e low road noise   e smooth road surface   e fully closed windows  and    e dry weather condition     e Operation from driver seat     e Performance  such as audio clarity  echo  and loudness  to a large degree rely on the phone and network  and  not the UConnect    system     e Echo at far end can sometime be reduced by lowering 3  the in vehicle audio volume     Bluetooth Communication Link   Occasionally  Cellular phones have been found to lose  connection to the UConnect    system  When this hap   pens  the connection can generally be re established by  switching the phone off on  Your cell phone is recom   mended to remain in Bluetooth  on  mode     Power Up   After switching the ignition key from OFF to either ON  or ACC position  or after a reset  you must wait at least  five  5  seconds prior to using the system     82 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE       Voice Command Tree           Main Menu  Towing E English  BEA  Assistance     e geney Espanol  PIOnepook    Francais       Last  Enter Number  Number on Phone  Is redialed    3  The 32 name language NOCT See Setup    specific phonebook wil
12.     It  PETI    Accessing The VES       EER AE  Tee  Tte Is  Te  PERETI    t  inn  iD  EEEEEE ED  z                E       EE AA N    PPRPP T en nana LE    MAA MSN NN    Wee    rr   EEFE    Prete ere eee  eS   PRESE  BREER RES    pits       BANAN    SR Ha Ee SS He Ba Es Ha Me  Wes cae rra  sae    pop  ae  oes  uml Ho Re Se He Me Es Pe  ea Ry Fa Na En Se Sa He Ha Sa Re Sn Aa Re Ha Ar ae  Se He Re Re Se Re Be As Ha  DEERE EDE ni NOI    M He SR Pa Sa Ra Be Sa Pr Ha Re Sa    BonrsTssJ2   EER d  Sere   Spee    errr  Te  SEE ER  DPA   EE    g The DVD Screen    EM  TM  Taror  eee  T0 TeTII          ee UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 175    iiw IIlIili  lllllif RR  pressed rrr MANENMNSNN EN  T1 eee  rd Lk BEEF RS  haas IEEE  PERRA   2222223  ze  wees  T  ae    ass har  IL cane  nr  mE  ERETTI  EER     EER rn  ek 1  t    one eee    oS  en LI  Se  Se  Se  TSS  con  nny  oon  nny  err con    XCCO aes sn    EERE ee    EER EER HERE aaa  ERK    t  ORR  oe kk  DOES    bien iM  ER RE EA    MEER Cord NRF       2  X    OR RE Ry hy ae ha hel  eee eee  EFIE    are eee  Se          s    Se 2       S15 hied       PTT Te n n n n ete    KERR IH  ee TETET  bei      EER EEEIS      EER ERELE   teenies   sheeeeee  EER EG  Hd    Remote Control Location    Kicker Mobile Surround  KMS1    The VES for this vehicle comes eguipped with Kicker  Mobile Surround  KMS1   This feature offers the ultimate  movie experience by providing surround sound uniquely  equalized for the interior space of your vehicle   
13.     NOTE  The Easy Entry Easy Exit feature can be en   abled or disabled  For details  refer to  Automatically  Move Seat Back on Exit   under  Personal Settings  Cus   tomer Programmable Features      under  Electronic Ve     hicle Information Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this  manual     TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD    Two latches must be released to open the hood  First  pull  the hood release lever located under the left side of the    instrument panel   EERS EE EE RR IE    Er       E  E  E  E  It  x   I       HH    2  at    mof  n    i       Hood Release Lever    94 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    Next  move to the outside of the vehicle and push the Use the hood prop rod  if equipped  to secure the hood in  safety catch to the left  The safety catch is located under the open position     To prevent possible damage  do not slam the hood to  close it  Lower the hood  until it is open approximately 6  inches  15 cm   and then drop it  This should secure both  latches  Never drive your vehicle unless the hood is fully  closed  with both latches engaged     WARNINCG     If the hood is not fully latched  it could fly up when    the vehicle is moving and block your forward vision   You could have a collision  Be sure all hood latches   amp 18c748d are fully latched before driving        Hood Safety Catch       LIGHTS    Headlight Switch  MF The headlight switch is located on the left side of  9  the instrument panel  This switch contro
14.     The battery in this vehicle has a vent hose that  should not be disconnected and should only be  replaced with a battery of the same type  vented         282 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    WARNING     CAUTION     e It is essential when replacing the cables on the  battery that the positive cable is attached to the  positive post and the negative cable is attached to  the negative post  Battery posts are marked posi   tive     and negative     and identified on the    battery case  Cable clamps should be tight on the  terminal posts and free of corrosion     If a    fast charger    is used while battery is in  vehicle  disconnect both vehicle battery cables  before connecting the charger to battery  Do not  use a    fast charger    to provide starting voltage        Air Conditioner Maintenance   For best possible performance  your air conditioner  should be checked and serviced by an Authorized Dealer  at the start of each warm season  This service should  include cleaning of the condenser fins and a performance  test  Drive belt tension should also be checked at this  time     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 283    WARNING     e Use only refrigerants and compressor lubricants  approved by the manufacturer for your air condi   tioning system  Some unapproved refrigerants are  flammable and can explode  injuring you  Other  unapproved refrigerants or lubricants can cause  the system to fail  requiring costly repairs  Refer  to Section 3 of the Warranty Information book for  f
15.     UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 145    Press the FUNCTION SELECT button to accept If Compass Temp  Audio is already displayed when the  b a selection  The FUNCTION SELECT button     AUDIO MODE button is pressed  then the radio mode  also advances the radio to the next preset will change from AM to FM  to Tape  to CD  or to Satellite   FUNC  Station  changes the side of the tape being  SAT  accordingly   TION played  if so equipped   or changes the current  SELECT CD track being played  if so equipped  when  Button the EVIC is in the Compass Temp  Audio   screen    Press the SCROLL button to scroll through Trip    Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC    Displays   When the appropriate conditions exist  the Electronic raad  Vehicle Information Center  EVIC  displays the following    A Functions  Navigation  if equipped   System messages    v Status Messages  and Personal Settings  Cus  e Turn Signal On  with a continuous warning chime if  SCROLL tomer Programmable Features   The SCROLL the vehicle is driven more than 1 mile  1 6 km  with  Button button also seeks up and down the radio either turn signal on     stations  CD track numbers  if so equipped   or  satellite radio channels  if so equipped  when the EVIC is  in the Compass   Temp   Audio screen  e Left Rear Turn Signal Light Out  with a single chime   Press the AUDIO MODE button to select the     S  D Compass Temp Audio screen  This screen  displays radio station frequencies  any one of  AUDIO twelve rad
16.    0 0  eee ee eee ee eee 294  AUICOMIAUIC ii sce dox EET eee eee ee EDS 203 294  FRU  AR AE SEE EA ee oe SEE 315  OMUNO 242549995929 whe SERS Ve ds 199    D EEEEIIIIIIGIIIIIIIILULILILILILLLIIIIILIIIIIT LL IWLLwAI CEgsAO LENULULILOAUIAA C  CBB   eEPB  ABAU   GIGAAGUP  SAAUATeGGGOGAUI   L7  ILULPRLLAL  A INDEX 359    Transmitter Battery Service     Remote Keyless Entry  is kde dos meo Paus 19  Transmitter  Garage Door   Opener  Hemel mk   si suce re ded dom ird des 116  Transmitter Programming    Remote Keyless EOY  au que oa oa AE pres ees 19  Transmitter  Remote Keyless Entry  RKE         17  Transportne Vets 24 4024 e dob a dob ebbe gd 55  Tread  Wear Indicators neu   rate EE RED 233  Tip OGOmerer sai 444240864  04 dot ade ii 140  Trunk Release  EmereenCy x3 2x4 vob 29  Trunk Release Remote Control  saak Es RE RS 28  TOM  ik vos os be 6 3 R5 d E od 98 136  UConnect     Hands Free Phone               66  Uniform Tire Quality Grades                343  Universal Iransmitter so doene doe rro anten 116  Unleaded Gasoline 4243     4 xev REK xs 246  Untwisang Procedure  Seat Belt    sessie ARK 35  Yaniy MITOS aces de dee Y duh e dead des 65  Variance  Compass X249 ER 55405 HER e des 149  Vehicle Certification Label 224444454 es 252    Vehicle Identification Number  VIN             6  Vehicle Loading ie ses EPOS BAD 226 252 253  Vehicle Modifications Alterations              7  Welle Storage m 188 306  Vehicle Theft Alarm  Security Alarm            15  Video Entertainment System  
17.    Ignition Off Draw  IOD  Jam                Yellow 8           2 40 Amp     Battery 14     10 Amp AC Heater Control     Green 4 4                       2          Red Cluster Sentry Key Re   9                   0   mote Keyless Entr   4 40 Amp     Battery 15                 een JJ           6               5 40 Amp     Heated Seats   if 17   20 Amp Cluster      Green equipped         0  Yellow   6     20 Amp Fuel Pump 18 EE 20 Amp Selectable Power Outlet  Yellow ee Yellow   7     20Amp Amplifier     Subwoofer 19 EN 10 Amp Stop Lights  MENU AMEN Red   8     15 Amp Ignition Switch  Airbag 20 a   a  Blue   Control Module  ACM  5 E         9     20 Amp Console Power Outlet 22 mm me Ma   Yellow 23   z             24         ce                      25          304 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    Cavity  26  27  28    29    Entry 7 stop Lights    30    Steering Control Module    31  32  33  34    Car   tridge  Fuse    Mini  Fuse    10 Amp  Red    10 Amp  Red    5 Amp  Orange    10 Amp  Red    Description    Airbag  Airbag Control  Module  ACM    Curtain Airbag   if  equipped   Anti lock Brakes  Module Cluster  Front  Control Module  FCM    Powertrain Control  Module  PCM  Sentry  Key Remote Keyless    Door Modules Power  Mirrors   if equipped      Cavity    9D    38    Car   tridge  Fuse    Mini  Fuse    5 Amp  Orange    20 Amp  Yellow    15 Amp  Blue    5 Amp  Orange    Description    Amplifier   if equipped    Antenna Ignition   Delay  Overhead  Console Passenger Door  Lock  a
18.    Vehicles equipped with Anti Lock brakes  ABS  are also  equipped with Electronic Brake Force Distribution  EBD    Both the Brake Warning Light and the ABS Light will  turn on in the event of an EBD failure  Immediate repair  of the ABS system is required in the event of an EBD  failure     N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 139    The operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked  by turning the ignition switch from the OFF position to  the ON position  The light should turn on for approxi   mately two seconds and then turn off  The light will  remain on if the parking brake is applied or if a brake  fault is detected  If the parking brake is not applied and  the light remains on  or if the light does not turn on  have  the light inspected by an authorized dealer     NOTE  The light will turn on when the ignition switch  in the ON position and the parking brake is applied  This  light shows only that the parking brake is applied  It does  not show the degree of brake application   See page 211  for more information    13  Electronic Stability Program  ESP  Traction  Control System  TCS  Indicator Light  If this indicator light flashes during accelera     tion  ease up on the accelerator and apply as  little throttle as possible  Adapt your speed  and driving to the prevailing road condi   tions  and do not switch off the ESP   See page 214 for  more information      14  Temperature Gauge   The temperature gauge shows engine coolant tempera   ture  Any reading with
19.    gt    OX  o   id   OX  o   gt     OX  o    KENN  NN    X    M  A  l  N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8          326 SCHEDULE  B   Miles 75 000 78 000 81 000 84 000 87 000 90 000   Kilometers   125 000     130 000     135 000     140 000     145 000     150 000   Change engine oil and engine oil filter  if not X X X X  replaced at 3 months    Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re  X X X  quired         Replace the air cleaner filter     Inspect the front and rear brake linings and  rotors     NN  Check and replace  if necessary  the PCV  valve    f   MEN    Replace the air conditioning filter   Rotate the tires     ERE       SCHEDULE  B  327    Miles 93 000 96 000 99 000 102 000 105 000   Kilometers  ET 000  a 000  a 000  x 000  x 000     Change engine oil and engine oil filter  if not re   placed at 3 months     Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re   quired      Replace the air cleaner filter  Eoo oL LX i  Inspect the front and rear brake linings and rotors  spect the font and rear brake eim and rotos fff     Replace the spark plugs           X        O  Sore epe i regie mm  o  o EN  o  sioner  Replace if IUe   Change the rear axle fluid  O O       O O X               y  I5 dd EA    Flush and replace engine coolant at 102 000 miles if  not done at 60 months     Rotate the tires     M  A  l  N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       328 SCHEDULE  B     Miles 108 000 111 000 114 000 117 000 120 000   Kilometers    00
20.    road only     Synchronizing ESP   The malfunction indicator light for the ESP is  combined with BAS indicator  If the power  supply is interrupted  battery disconnected or  discharged   the ESP BAS malfunction indica   tor light may illuminate with the engine running  If this  should occur  turn the steering wheel completely to the  left and then to the right  The ESP BAS malfunction  indicator light should go out  However  if the light  remains on  have the ESP and BAS checked at your  authorized dealer as soon as possible        ESP BAS Malfunction Indicator Light and  ESP TCS Indicator Light   The malfunction indicator light for the ESP is  combined with the BAS indicator  The yellow     ESP BAS Malfunction Indicator Light    and  the yellow    ESP TCS Indicator Light    in the  instrument cluster both come on when the ignition  switch is turned to the    ON    position  They should go  out with the engine running     The system will turn the    ESP BAS Malfunction Indica   tor Light    on continuously while the engine running if it  detects a malfunction in either the ESP or the BAS or  both  If the light remains on after several ignition cycles   and you have driven the vehicle several miles at speeds  greater than 30 mph  48 km h   and the ESP is synchro   nized  refer to Synchronizing ESP   see your authorized  dealer as soon as possible to have the problem diagnosed  and corrected     ESP  BAS    220 STARTING AND OPERATING    NOTE    e   he  ESP TCS Indicator Light
21.   RR EE RR ED ER RE RR ER  see eet EER RE             EEEEEER EEEE EEE    EEM  wate  2  E  pan  vee  TS  TOT  Tuy  Ty          Tarsus          ES  ES ee  DINMSEE  R oe OOOO eee  ae AA oe RR Be He RE x aa we  MELLE sooo TETIT  EED HE ee eres    E fiie  TIT  Deed    mr  Se  ee Pi ee PELLE  De  UL n n n Ee RE PR RR RR EE  MELT DE See  vene x eee  oe RR ese ETER Id  RE REN REDE ARE EIE oe He SR Be  ee en See se    tter    Memory  i    d with Driver  you can use your remote keyless entry transm    or the memory switch on the driver s door panel to  return the power mirrors to pre programmed positions    Refer to  Driver Memory Seat  in this section for details    equippe    icles    For veh    NOTE    Seat    irror    ty M    i    inated Van    Illum    Heated Remote Control Mirrors  These mirrors are heated to melt frost or ice  This feature    tivated whenever you turn on the Rear Window    Defrost     1S ac    66 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    HANDS FREE COMMUNICATION  UConnect         IF EQUIPPED   UConnect M is a voice activated  hands free  in  vehicle  communications system  UConnect    allows you to dial  a phone number with your cellular phone using simple  voice commands  e g    Call      Mike     Work  or  Dial      248 555 1212    Your cellular phone s audio is trans   mitted through your vehicle s audio system  the system  will automatically mute your radio when using the  UConnect    system     NOTE  The UConnect    system u
22.   Rear Seat Video System    9599 9 9 98 tas 174  Warning Flasher  Hazard 3353 m9 Ee X EO 256  Warning Lights    Instrument Cluster Description               136  Warnings and Cautions   5204630666 00840044 6  Warranty Information    2 9 sy Di Re 900  4s 340  Washer  Adding Fluid   353m s 104 106 285  Washers  LIea3dlsBE iua ek eor yii raae 105  Washers  Windshield                   102 285    Washing Vehicle nosti ese dea an dap temi es 296  Wheel Alignment and Balance  Wheel and  Wheel Trim 12 oo ie oi es he Dk His  Wheel and Wheel Trim Care                  Wheel Bearings  Wind Buffeting  Window Airbag  Side Curtain               38 43       TST Id    VOW Fogging oss e err axo art RA VR eR 189 Windshield Wiper Blades                   285  juo JO                ES 25 Windshield Wipers s c me y vC ded  pe rg d 101   POWCE 3 EE EE EE Rc Ee S e 29  Wiper Blade Replacement   ud zd a9 des 285  Windshield Defroster 1 0444 sm css 157    Wipers  Intermittent   23 2 dnt a9 101  Windshield Washers                 101102285    Wipers  Rain Sensitive 2429 r9 x PES TERRAS 102    PHI  ien toe EA oo REG ee AO ed 285    
23.   Remove and replace the battery  Avoid touching the  new battery with your fingers  Skin oils may cause  battery deterioration  If you touch a battery  clean it with  rubbing alcohol     4  To assemble the transmitter case  snap the two halves  together  If so equipped  install and tighten the screw  until snug  Make sure there is an even  gap  between the  two halves     5  Test the transmitter operation     General Information   This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and  RSS 210 of Industry Canada  Operation is subject to the  following conditions     e This device may not cause harmful interference     e This device must accept any interference received   including interference that may cause undesired op   eration     NOTE  Changes or modifications not expressly ap   proved by the party responsible for compliance could  void the user s authority to operate the equipment     If your Remote Keyless Entry transmitter fails to operate  from a normal distance  check for these two conditions     1  A weak battery in the transmitter  The expected life of  the battery is a minimum of three years     2  Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station  tower  airport transmitter  and some mobile or CB radios     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21    DOOR LOCKS    Manual Door Locks  To lock each door  push the door lock plunger on each  door trim panel downward  To unlock each door  pull the  door lock plunger on each door trim panel upward     
24.   The  headlight switch must be used for normal nighttime  driving     Lights on Reminder   If the headlights or parking lights are on after the ignition  is turned OFF  a chime will sound to alert the driver  when the driver s door is opened     Fog Lights     O The front fog light switch is on the headlight  switch below the dimmer control  To activate the  front fog lights  turn on the parking lights or the   low beam headlights and press the fog light switch     An indicator light in the instrument cluster illuminates  when the fog lights are turned on     NOTE  The fog lights will operate with the low beam  headlights or parking lights on  However  selecting the  high beam headlights will turn off the fog lights     Multi Function Lever   The multi function lever controls the operation of the  turn signals  headlight beam selection  and passing  lights  The lever is located on the left side of the steering  column        B1RcaOr32    Multi Function Lever    Turn Signals   Move the Multi Function Lever up or down and the  corresponding turn signal indicator in the instrument  cluster flashes to show proper operation of the front and  rear turn signal lights  You can also signal a lane change    N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 99    by moving the lever partially up or down without  moving beyond the detent  Releasing the lever at the  detent will provide 3 flashes     If either light has a very fast flash rate  check for a  defective outside light bulb  If an 
25.   The KMS1 activates whenever a DVD is in the VES  player  and the radio mode is set to VES  and the video  screen is powered up  The system will go back to stereo  sound automatically if the VES is powered down  or the    176 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    video screen is stowed away  or the radio is set to a mode  other than VES  or if you are using the Aux jacks on the  VES     Your vehicle is equipped with a state of the art digital  audio amplifier that decodes stereo sound inputs into 5 1  formatted surround sound  When in surround sound  mode  the KMS1 automatically sets balance and fade to  provide the optimal surround experience     SATELLITE RADIO     IF EQUIPPED   Satellite radio uses direct satellite to receiver broadcast   ing technology to provide clear digital sound  coast to  coast  The subscription service provider is Sirius   Satel   lite Radio  This service offers over 100 channels of music   sports  news  entertainment  and programming for chil   dren  directly from its satellites and broadcasting studios     System Activation    NOTE  Your vehicle s radio must be on and in satellite  mode when the activation process takes place     To activate your Sirius Satellite Radio service  call the  toll free number 888 539 7474  or visit the Sirius web site    at www sirius com  Please have the following informa   tion available when activating your system     1  The Electronic Serial Number Sirius Identification  Number  ESN SID      2  Credit card
26.   The de   froster automatically turns off after approximately 10  minutes of operation for the first push of the button  and  will turn off after approximately 5 minutes for the second  push of the button     UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 191    CAUTION     To avoid damaging the electrical conductors of the    rear window defroster  do not use scrapers  sharp  instruments  or abrasive window cleaners on the  interior surface of the window     Labels can be peeled off after soaking with warm raad    water           STARTING AND OPERATING    CONTENTS    ll Starting Procedures    O Automatic Transmission    H Normal Starting    D Extremely Cold Weather   Below    20 F Or    29  C     O If Engine Fails To Start    O After Starting    W Engine Block Heater     If Equipped    B Automatic Transmission    O Automatic Transmission      General Information    O Brake Transmission Shift Interlock System        197  197    197  197  198  199  199    200      202    O5 Speed Automatic Transmission  ll AutoStick    o AutoStick   Operation    D AutoStick   General Information             208  H Driving On Slippery Surfaces               209  i PCcClelauiO  pee ga ee eens ee ee M 209  ACUO 25926599  91059 9 JH ho ace OER ae PRED 209  W Parking Brakes is ooste te tes EER EH S RSS 210  M Brake System   os aee daw sede g rei es 2  O Anti Lock Brake System ius ossa 211  IM Power Steering   c cue eus too eer 213       194 STARTING AND OPERATING NN Id    W Electronic Brake Control System   
27.   The passenger seat belts are equipped with either cinch   ing latch plates or automatic locking retractors  which are  designed to keep the lap portion tight around the child  restraint so that it is not necessary to use a locking clip   Pulling up on the shoulder portion of the lap shoulder  belt will tighten the belt  The cinching latch plate will  keep the belt tight  however  any seat belt system will  loosen with time  so check the belt occasionally  and pull  it tight if necessary     Seat belts with an automatic locking retractor have a  distinctive label on the seat belt webbing  The seat belt  must be in the automatic locking mode in order to enable    54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    a child restraint to be tightly installed  Refer to  Auto   matic Locking Mode  in this section for details  A locking  clip should not be necessary once the automatic locking  feature is enabled  Position the shoulder and lap belt on  the child restraint  The automatic locking retractor is  activated by first attaching the child seat  then pulling all  of the webbing out of the retractor  then allowing back in   Tighten webbing  To release  simply unbuckle the seat  belt by depressing the button  allowing the webbing to  retract into the retractor     In the rear seat  you may have trouble tightening the  lap shoulder belt on the child restraint because the  buckle or latch plate is too close to the belt path opening  on the restraint  Disconnect the latch plate fr
28.   and the  ESP BAS  Malfunction Indicator Light  will turn on momentarily  each time the ignition switch is turned ON     e Each time the ignition is turned ON  the ESP System  will be ON even if it was turned off previously     e The ESP Control System will make buzzing or clicking  sounds when it is active  This is normal  the sounds  will stop when ESP becomes inactive following the  maneuver that caused the ESP activation        TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION  Tire Markings              SERVICE MAXIMUM  DESCRIPTION LOAD    ir  j MAXIMUM  SIZE d  DESIGNATION PRESSURE  TREADWEAR   U S  DOT TRACTION  SAFETY AND  STANDARDS TEMPERATURE    GRADES    81154468    ee STARTING AND OPERATING 221    NOTE   e P  Passenger  Metric tire sizing is based on U S  design    e Temporary Spare tires are high pressure compact  spares designed for temporary emergency use only     standards  P Metric tires have the letter  P  molded  into the sidewall preceding the size designation  Ex   ample  P215 65R15 95H     European Metric tire sizing is based on European  design standards  Tires designed to this standard have  the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with  the section width  The letter  P  is absent from this tire  size designation  Example  215 65R15 96H    LT  Light Truck  Metric tire sizing is based on U S   design standards  The size designation for LT Metric  tires is the same as for P Metric tires except for the  letters  LT  that are molded into the sidewall preced   ing the size 
29.   are meant to be used together        NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33    4  Position the lap belt across your thighs  below your WARNING   abdomen  To remove slack in the lap belt portion  pull up    a bit on the shoulder belt  To loosen the lap belt if itis too e A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk of  tight  tilt the latch plate and pull on the lap belt  A snug internal injury in a collision  The belt forces won t  belt reduces the risk of sliding under the belt in a be at the strong hip and pelvic bones  but across your  collision  abdomen  Always wear the lap belt as low as pos     sible and keep it snug     e A twisted belt can t do its job as well  In a  collision  it could even cut into you  Be sure the belt  is straight  If you can t straighten a belt in your  vehicle  take it to your dealer and have it fixed        5  Position the shoulder belt on your chest so that it is  comfortable and not resting on your neck  The retractor  will withdraw any slack in the belt        zum AMO z E E 7 55  6  To release the belt  push the red button on the buckle     ELE  VERRE sees Pn n ee St TE here    j EL    REKE The belt will automatically retract to its stowed position   Removing Slack From Belt If necessary  slide the latch plate down the webbing to  allow the belt to retract fully        34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    WARNING     A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collision  and leave you with no protection  Inspect 
30.   as tire pressures vary with  temperature changes     Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi  7 kPa  per  12   F  7   C  of air temperature change  Keep this in mind  when checking tire pressure inside a garage  especially in  the winter     Example  If garage temperature   68   F  20   C  and the  outside temperature   32   F  0   C  then the cold tire  inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi  21 kPa    which equals 1 psi  7 kPa  for every 12   F  7   C  for this  outside temperature condition     Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi  13 to 40 kPa   during operation  DO NOT reduce this normal pressure  build up or your tire pressure will be too low     Tire Pressures for High Speed Operation   The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds  within posted speed limits  Where speed limits or condi   tions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high  speeds  maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very  important  Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle  loading may be required for high speed vehicle opera   tion  Refer to original equipment or an authorized tire  dealer for recommended safe operating speeds  loading  and cold tire inflation pressures     232 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    Cuts and punctures in radial tires are repairable only in  the tread area because of sidewall flexing  Consult your   High speed driving with your vehicle under maxi  authorized tire dealer for radial tire repairs   mum load is dangerous  The added str
31.   avoid scratching the disc     4  Do not use solvents such as benzine  thinner  cleaners   or antistatic sprays     5  Store the disc in its case after playing   6  Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight     7  Do not store the disc where temperatures may become  too high     N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 183    RADIO OPERATION AND CELLULAR PHONES   Under certain conditions  the cellular phone being On in  your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from  your radio  This condition may be lessened or eliminated  by relocating the cellular phone antenna  This condition  is not harmful to the radio  If your radio performance  does not satisfactorily  clear  by the repositioning of the  antenna  it is recommended that the radio volume be  turned down or off during cellular phone operation     CLIMATE CONTROLS  The Air Conditioning and Heating System is designed to  make you comfortable in all types of weather     Automatic Temperature Control       81350203    Automatic Temperature Controls  Automatic Operation    The Infrared Dual Zone Climate Control System auto   matically maintains the climate in the cabin of the vehicle  at the comfort levels desired by the driver and passenger   To accomplish this  the system gathers information from  the controls on the climate control  from a dual sun   sensor located in the top of the instrument panel  from an  infrared sensor located in the face of the climate control   and from various sensors located throughout th
32.   e Gross Axle Weight Rating  GAWR  front   e Gross Axle Weight Rating  GAWR  rear   e Vehicle Identification Number  VIN    e Type of Vehicle    e Month Day and Hour of Manufacture  MDH     The bar code allows a computer scanner to read the  Vehicle Identification Number  VIN      Gross Vehicle Weight Rating  GVWR   The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle   This includes driver  passengers  and cargo  The total    load must be limited so that you do not exceed the  GVWR     Gross Axle Weight Rating  GAWR   The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rear  axles  Distribute the load over the front and rear axles    evenly  Make sure that you do not exceed either front or  rear GAWR     WARNINCG     Because the front wheels steer the vehicle  it is  important that you do not exceed the maximum front    or rear GAWR  A dangerous driving condition can  result if either rating is exceeded  You could lose  control of the vehicle and have an accident        ee STARTING AND OPERATING 253    Overloading   The load carrying components  axle  springs  tires   wheels  etc   of your vehicle will provide satisfactory  service as long as you do not exceed the GVWR and front  and rear GAWR     The best way to figure out the total weight of your  vehicle is to weigh it when it is fully loaded and ready for  operation  Weigh it on a commercial scale to insure that it  is not over the GVWR     Figure out the weight on the front and rear of the vehicle  separately  It is im
33.   es    ee  ee  ee    Marr   Tex   E   Re ie ee t    ORE RR SE EER RE    Er          erred  Sree  See  Se RR    1    ft    Tee  nao  Te  Ie    ELE TEER  ee  SSNs    Peete eee nn nnn    PERK REKE RR ER EER    BEE pREL ROER EED    uas any   EE kak   Se He Mo Ee ee    oer    es     ee  ee       eveeeesre   wee  pease  pc   EER rd  essel  vvv aid   uS  Dao    B    AR  IMMER    EER EER IE N    TRBSSSBRSSSS      ToLeTTsTPssID    sane  angers          Y  EER RE ER EE ER EEN    PR PERE PER    B1586abe    dh ramum ra  Se DA RA Re       TIREFIT contents       65809    E 1  Air pump hose    815       TIREFIT Locati  ocasion 2  Power plug and cable    3  Air pump switch   4  Pressure gauge   5  TIREFIT sealant bottle  6  TIREFIT sealant hose    NN WHAT TO DO N EMERGENCIES 259    WARNING  Sealing tire with TIREFIT    1  Turn on the hazard warning flashers     Do not attempt to repair a tire on the side of the vehicle  close to traffic  Pull far enough off the road to avoid the  danger of being hit when operating the jack or repairing  a tire     Cuts or punctures larger than approximately 0 16 in   4  mm   tire damage caused by driving with extremely low  tire pressure or on a flat tire  or a damaged wheel can  pose a hazard while driving  TIREFIT should not be  used in such circumstances  Do not drive the vehicle  under such circumstances  Contact your nearest autho   rized dealer for assistance     Take care not to allow the contents of TIREFIT to come  in contact with hair  eyes or clo
34.   or delivery service  commercial ser  NOTE  Under no circumstances should oil change  vice      intervals exceed 6 000 miles  10 000 km  or 6 months    i hi h fi l  e Off road or desert operation  whichever comes first    NOTE  If ANY of these apply to you  then change your   engine oil every 3 000 miles  5 000 km  or 3 months  CAUTION    whichever comes first  and follow the maintenance rec   ommendations in Schedule    B    in this section     NOTE  If ANY of these apply to you  then flush and  replace the engine coolant every 102 000 miles  170 000 Af Fach Stop for Fuel  km  or 60 months  whichever comes first  and follow the    maintenance recommendations in Schedule  B  in this    Check the engine oil level about 5 minutes after a fully  section  warmed engine is shut off  Checking the oil level while    the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accu   md racy of the oil level reading  Add oil only when the  listed for Schedule  B  level is at or below the ADD or MIN mark    Second is Schedule    A     It is for vehicles that are not    operated under any of the conditions listed under Sched   ule  B      Failure to perform the required maintenance items  may result in damage to the vehicle        NOTE  Most vehicles are operated under the conditions       M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8    e Check the windshield washer solvent and add if  reguired     Use the schedule that best describes your driving condi   tions  Where time and mil
35.   position  This feature provides the driver with a better  view of the ground and vehicle in the area of the rear tires  when backing up  The mirrors will move back to their  previous position when the transmission is shifted out of  R  Reverse      The  Tilt in Reverse  feature can be enabled or disabled   For details  refer to  Tilt Mirrors Down in Reverse    under  Personal Settings  Customer Programmable Fea   tures      under  Electronic Vehicle Information Center   EVIC   in Section 4 of this manual     Power Remote Control Mirrors   The power mirror switch is located on the driver s door  trim panel next to the power door lock switch  A rotary  knob selects the left mirror  right mirror  or off position     After selecting a mirror  move the knob in the same  direction you want the mirror to move  Use the center off  position to guard against accidentally moving a mirror  position       To use  ica    ISOT    the sun v    the mirror  rotate the sun visor downward and swing the    1rror 1S On    Illuminated Vanity Mirrors  mirror cover upwar    An illuminated vanity m    p  eee eee  sa ae  pM   To TxTTeS   Mss TSTISS   DOREM  ete ee    ERROREM  To IBM     TEPPEPEERRM  TosTIf 227     EER EER EE    EE ee A  eerie EER  oe eee       DETT annama n    A    NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 65    lly     d  The light turns on automat    ed  Ek Ed   EE cee    rd              TM  ETER EIN  EER EIR     ED sit   terrors  DEOR    MTS                   DEERE SE ee EA Co
36.   the PCV  valve     LO  o X    LO  o X    Replace the air conditioning filter   Rotate the tires        NENNEN    M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8          324 SCHEDULE  B    Kilometers   65 000     70 000     75 000     80 000     85 000     90 000   Change engine oil and engine oil filter  if not BNBBEN X EN  replaced at 3 months    pcm dl ANENE   quired         X    Replace the air cleaner filter  N N N      Inspect the front and rear brake linings and X  rotors     Change the rear axle fluid  ooo           X       J   Replace the air conditioning filter      1o OC X   T  Rotate the tires    XXX       SCHEDULE    B    325    69 000 72 000   115 000     120 000   X    X     Kilometers   95 000     100 000     105 000     110 000      replaced at 3 months      X X    Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re   quired      Replace the air cleaner filter     Inspect the front and rear brake linings and  rotors   Check and Inspect the accessory drive belt   and tensioner  Replace if required     Check and replace  if necessary  the PCV  valve    T    Change the power steering fluid MEE    Change the automatic transmission fluid and m  filter     Replace the air conditioning filter      Flush and replace engine coolant at 60 months EN  if not done at 102 000 miles    Rotate the tires  S o    M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       EE   OX  o   gt  
37.  197  Fuel Requirements   x2 n vira oH 246 313    OW MT  275 313 314  Oil Change JIDISEVAL uedqessasp Pe xr done PPS 276  Oil Eier Cop s ues son Me n quio d qug dre ms ced 277  OM Selecon  Ces vos ie eee eed ee ERE ed  Overheating  Temperature Gauge  Enhanced Accident Response Feature  Ethanol  Event Data Recorder       Exhaust Gas Caution               56 57 248 286  ed ee 2 43 RE EE TE DE 06 286  Extenor Folding MITOS 2x2 rre nr euer SS 64    350 INDEX NEE Id    Exterior Lightne 212x253 RE ER BES ES NR 95  Filters  Air Cleaner  amp  a s  36 3 t T TI TT TT TIT 279  AI COOCMIONING asuwcaas4523250923 r5 159 289  P ne DEUS ies ETA 26 dr not d dea Peer es 279  ERIS Ol uacua ed prix equ Nx dd 278 314  Engine OU IAISpOSal  uvas Fre es  278  Flashers  Hazard Vat 6 4 4a ee aoe ED ER a 256  TUM ier  s os odere ds POS KOERT DRA 98 136  Flash To Pass       SS SS eee ee eens 99  Hooded Engme Starting 22 222999 2 3 197  Floor Console                 leen 127  Elid loculus E ee Hei B15  Fluid Leaks s 454544 RO RAL DERE DRADE RE 58  Fluid Level Checks  BARE OE OE PAGE RARE ESI RE EE 293  OO DIS  Ste goad m dtr ix nod READ ROAD 287  ese MERE RE ver Pe SS 275   ower Ie 2442545454550 KEER ees 284  IC AE AE RE OE EE OE ee Boe 314  Fluids  Lubricants and Genuine Parts          314    es di   ie usas  Ree S Re gees E 98 136  Fols Rear Seal Locsacerigup eden Rd RE oot RES 89  Freep A Sek Velde 36 oce scan deem as ts 265  Front Suspension Ball Joints                 284  Front Wheel Bearings iss i
38.  225  Brake Assist System sni see ghi Re Rhe DR 215  Brake Control System  Electronic             214  Drake  PAKNE    atte ee ee ht d Re er eae 210  Dike cun PL  211 292  Anti Lock  ABS  2219 mhEN REKE 211 214  Fluid Check   ii22 223    bob RO 293 915  ele P  292  Master Cylinder   rssaxirria sdei ER RA eg 293    ke EA PPP  210   Varming LIEDE PPM 138 211  uci  P  211  Brake  Transmission Interlock                202  Break In Recommendations  New Vehicle        55  Bulb Replacement 2 4 246 mi 92 doe eur dde ees 307  Bulbs UI D        46556 ean 307  Calibration Compass coss ados ivy LOER En 149  Capacities PIG  aeo d o ER e HD eda 313  Caps  Filler   Duel 2223292302695 te ee E PRIMER 249   OES NE  sones PRE Y 2 7   Radiator  Coolant Pressure                 289  Car Washes se   0 98 091998 REDES eee a ee 296  Carbon Monoxide Warning               56 248  Cassette Tape and Player Maintenance         181  Catalytic Converter 444 a5444enn ase those ae  CD  Compact Disc  Player  Cellular Phone siet es SEE RES ER 4445 06 e004  Chains  Tire s ona see OE eS RU ES HO Res  Chap Die SIDE a5 s eure cee yes ee aes       348 INDEX NEE   ddeEEN    Check Engine Light     Malfunction Indicator Light                 249  Child Restraint 2 264466 bear Seen ERES 47 49 52 53  Child Restraint Tether Anchors             50 52  Child Safety VOCS 224 4645 TE RES PI REPSES 23  Clean Air Gasoline              0 000000 ee 246  Cleaning   Wheels          0 0    eee 297  Climate Control 1439 dw   a es t
39.  3 months     Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re   Am       Replace the air cleaner filter                        J  X   Inspect the front and rear brake linings and rotors        X J      o   Change the rear axle fluid   X  Replace the air conditioning filter    X  Rotatethetires  XXX      This maintenance is recommended by the manufacture Inspection and service should also be performed anytime  to the owner but is not required to maintain the emis      a malfunction is observed or suspected  Retain all re   sions warranty  ceipts        M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       1 This maintenance is not reguired if previously replaced        SCHEDULE  A  331    SCHEDULE  A     Miles 6 000 12 000 18 000 24 000 30 000 36 000   Kilometers   10 000   20 000     30 000     40 000     50000     60 000    Months        M  A  l  N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8    332 SCHEDULE  A        Miles 42 000 48 000 54 000   Kilometers   70 000   80 000     90 000    Months   42   48   54     Check and replace  if necessary  the PCV       M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8    valve       Replace the air conditioning filter           SCHEDULE    A    333    Miles 78 000 84 000 90 000 96 000 102 000   Kilometers   130 000     140 000     150 000     160 000     170 000    Months   78    Change engine oil and engine oil filter    Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re    quired     Replace the air c
40.  4 2 04009452608 neras 307  o Tail Stop  Tail  Turn Signal Light  And Backup  LIGNE FTT  309  ELieehsee MIG  osa ka teme heure REY LX ES 312  W Fluids And Capacities                    313  W Fluids  Lubricants  And Genuine Parts        314  uli o   eeee ek Ga toe hehe oe eee E oes 314  s WI Pm 315    N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 271    6 1L ENGINE COMPARTMENT                REMOTE JUMP START ee COOLANT Um COOLANT  POSITIVE BATTERY POST CENTER  PRESSURE CAP ACCESS COVER BOTTLE       EER EE  8  EER RE    EER RE EE td       iek id ER    Ra SE RR I I PAL a He    WASHER FLUID ENGINE OIL ENGINE AIR GLEANER POWER STEERING  BOTTLE DIPSTICK OIL FILE FILTER FLUID    E1  12 bd    272 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM     OBD Il   Your vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboard  diagnostic system called OBD II  This system monitors  the performance of the emissions  engine  and automatic  transmission control systems  When these systems are  operating properly  your vehicle will provide excellent  performance and fuel economy  as well as engine emis   sions well within current government regulations     If any of these systems require service  the OBD II system  will turn on the  Malfunction Indicator Light   It will  also store diagnostic codes and other information to  assist your service technician in making repairs  Al   though your vehicle will usually be drivable and not  need towing  see your dealer for service as soon as  possible     CAUTION     Pr
41.  40 or equivalent  For additional information  refer to the  En   gine Oil Selection  and  Engine Oil Viscosity  SAE Grade   in the  Mainte   nance Procedures  section of this manual     Mopar  05281090 or equivalent     Refer to the  Vehicle Emission Control Information  label in the engine com   partment        Fuel Selection  6 1 Liter  Premium Unleaded 91 Octane Only or higher     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 315    Chassis    Fluids  Lubricants  and Genuine Parts  Automatic Transmission Mopar   ATF 4 Automatic Transmission Fluid     Brake Master Cylinder Mopar   DOT 3  SAE J1703 should be used  If DOT 3  SAE J1703 brake  fluid is not available  then DOT 4 is acceptable  Use only recommended  brake fluids     Power Steering Reservoir Mopar   Power Steering Fluid   4  Mopar   ATF 4 Automatic Transmission  Fluid     API Certified GL 5 SAE 75W140 Synthetic Gear Lubricant or equivalent              MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES    CONTENTS  W Emission Control System Maintenance        318 E eliediude ED ip ass    E  Bl Maintenance Schedules                    318 Hoshedule A  iaessatsssheuseR LEER ES RE    M  A  l  N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8    M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       318 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES NN Id    EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM MAINTENANCE  The    Scheduled    maintenance services  listed in bold  type must be done at the times or mileages specified to  assure the continued proper functioning of the emission  control s
42.  BATTERY HEATED MIROR     WINDSHIELD     INSTUMENT PANEL SEAT BELT SLIDANG DOOR     TRUNKTDECK AIR CONDITIONING  CHARGIMG DEFROST ILLUMIMATION RELEASE  i  i      GLOW PLUG PXMVER WINDSHIELD WIPER SIDE AIRBAG AIRBAG SLIDINGDOOR EMERGENCY LIGHTER  STEERING FLUID AND WASHER RELEASE HANDLE  C Y 5  pa E  AIRBAG PA Au inte agit   in um n  MALFUNCTION TRANS ENGINE COOLANT SUPPLEMENTAL     PASSENGER DOOR AJAR CONVERTIBLE     CONVERTIELE  INDICATOR LIGHT     OIL TEMF TEMPERATURE  RESTRAJNT SYSTEM AIRBAG OFF TOR DOWN TOP UP    INTRODUCTION 5    ESP  BAS    ELECTRONIC STABILITY         DOOR LCE ADJUSTABLE ELECTRONK PROGRAM   BRAKE  PEDALS SPEER COMTROL ASSIST SYSTEM  BARAKE  p  I ab  So  BRAKE SYSTEM  WIHDOW LIFT TIRE PRESSURE HILL DESCENT WARMING PARKING  MONITOR CONTROL BRAKE  e Bo   A  ow  CONVERTIBLE TRACTION in  WHEEL FAILURE OF AMTHOEH  4 WINDOW DOWN CONTROL RIVE BRAKING SYSTEM  da M     4WD  BRAKE  ELECTRONIC BRAKE SYSTEM  WIN DOELE LEIER THROTTLE FOUR WHEEL WARMING PARK IMG  CONTROL DRIVE BRAKE  ath  rf i  Di i  Thi   i  VOICE  CHILD SEAT RECOGNITION WARNING  TETHER AMCHOR BUTTON  iN  ty     LOWER ANCHORS   AND TETHER FOR UCONNECT    HAZARD  CHILDREN  LATE RUTTON  HORH BEE OWNER S  MANUAL 0 81316970       6 INTRODUCTION    WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS   This manual contains WARNINGS against operating  procedures  which could result in an accident or bodily  injury  It also contains CAUTIONS against procedures   which could result in damage to your vehicle  If you do  not read this enti
43.  Cellular Phone Names  e Press the    Phone    button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Setup Phone pairing     e When prompted  say  List Phones     e The UConnect    system will play the phone names of  all paired cellular phones in order from the highest to    the lowest priority  To  select  or  delete  a paired  phone being announced  press the    Voice recognition       button and say    Select    or    Delete     Also  see the next  two sections for an alternate way to    select    or    de   lete    a paired phone     Select another Cellular Phone   This feature allows you to select and start using another  phone with the UConnect    system  The phone must  have been previously paired to the UConnect    system  that you want to use it with     e Press the    Phone    button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Setup Select Phone  and follow the prompts     e You can also press the  Voice Recognition  button  anytime while the list is being played  and then choose  the phone that you wish to select     e The selected phone will be used for the next phone  call  If the selected phone is not available  the UCon   nect    system will return to using the highest priority  phone present in or near  approximately with in 30  feet  the vehicle        80 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    Delete UConnect    Paired Cellular Phones 6  e Press the    Phone    button to begi
44.  Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize  the risk of harm from a deploying airbag     1  Children 12 years old and under should ride buckled  up in the rear seat     2  Infants in rear facing child restraints should NEVER  ride in the front seat of a vehicle with a passenger front  airbag  An airbag deployment could cause severe injury  or death to infants in that position     3  Children that are not big enough to wear the vehicle  seat belt properly  refer to information on Child Restraint  in this section  should be secured in the rear seat in child  restraints or belt positioning booster seats     4  Older children who do not use child restraints or  belt positioning booster seats should ride properly buck   led up in the rear seat  Never allow children to slide the  shoulder belt behind them or under their arm     5  If a child from 1 to 12 years old must ride in the front  passenger seat because the vehicle is crowded  move the  seat as far back as possible  and use the proper child  restraint  refer to information on Child Restraint in this  section      6  You should read the instructions provided with your  child restraint to make sure that you are using it properly     7  All occupants should use their seat belts properly     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41    8  The driver and front passenger seats should be moved   back as far as practical to allow the airbags time to inflate    e Relying on the airbags alone could lead to more  seve
45.  No program type or un   defined idi    162 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id      Unassigned       0 0000    By pressing the SEEK button when the PTY icon is  displayed  the radio will be tuned to the next frequency       station with the same selected PTY name  The PTY  function only operates when in the FM mode     If a preset button is activated while in the PTY  Program  Type  mode  the PTY mode will be exited and the radio  will tune to the preset station     NOTE  If you have selected a PTY with the tune knob   simply pressing the tune button in will go directly to a   PTY seek      Buttons 1   6  Radio Mode    These buttons tune the Radio to the stations that you  commit to push button memory  12 AM  12 FM  and 12  Satellite  if equipped  stations      Operating Instructions     Tape Player   Insert the cassette with the exposed tape side toward the  left and the mechanical action of the player will gently  pull the cassette into the play position     NOTE  When subjected to extremely cold temperatures   the tape mechanism may require a few minutes to warm  up for proper operation  Sometimes poor playback may  be experienced due to a defective cassette tape  Clean and  demagnetize the tape heads at least twice a year     E UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 163    Seek Button   Press the SEEK button up for the next selection on the  tape and down to return to the beginning of the current  selection     Press the SEEK button up or down to move the track  numb
46.  O Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make  Outside The Vehicle    NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11    A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS  You can insert the double sided keys into the locks with  either side up         amp 15afal  a    Vehicle Key    The dealer that sold you your new vehicle has the key  code numbers for your vehicle locks  These numbers can  be used to order duplicate keys from your dealer  Ask  your dealer for these numbers and keep them in a safe  place     Ignition Key Removal  The shift lever must be in PARK  Turn the key to the  LOCK posi       e the key        MERE EER EER EE EE IN TER EN ER N DNS    m  n  s  cena  oe    LUREREREEERRERERERE       Ignition Key Positions    NOTE   The power window switches  radio  power  sunroof  if equipped   and power outlets will remain  active for up to 60 minutes after the ignition switch is  turned off  Opening either front door will cancel this  feature  The time for this feature is programmable  For  details  refer to  Delay Power Off to Accessories Until    12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE NN    Exit  under  Personal Settings  Customer Program   mable Features      under  Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this manual     WARNING     Never leave children alone in a vehicle  Leaving  children in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a  number of reasons  A child or others could be  seriously or fatally injured  Don   t leave the keys in  the ignition  A child could o
47.  Occupants  particularly unat   tended children  can become entrapped by the  power sunroof while operating the power sunroof  switch  Such entrapment may result in serious  injury or death     In an accident  there is a greater risk of being  thrown from a vehicle with an open sunroof  You  could also be seriously injured or killed  Always  fasten your seat belt properly and make sure all  passengers are properly secured too     Do not allow small children to operate the sun   roof  Never allow fingers or other body parts  or  any object to project through the sunroof opening   Injury may result        Opening Sunroof   Express   Press the switch rearward and release  and the sunroof  will open automatically from any position  The sunroof  will open fully and then stop automatically  This is called  Express Open  During Express Open operation  any  movement of the sunroof switch will stop the sunroof     Closing Sunroof   Express   Press the switch forward and release  and the sunroof  will close automatically from any position  The sunroof  will close fully and stop automatically  This is called  Express Close  During Express Close operation  any  movement of the switch will stop the sunroof     Pinch Protect Feature   This feature will detect an obstruction in the opening of  the sunroof during Express Close operation  If an ob   struction in the path of the sunroof is detected  the  sunroof will automatically retract  Remove the obstruc   tion if this occurs  Next  press 
48.  Programmable Features   under  Electronic Ve   hicle Information Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this  manual     Child Protection Door Lock   To provide a safer environment for small children riding  in the rear seats  the rear doors are equipped with a child  protection door lock system     To Engage the Child Protection Door Lock  1  Open the rear door     2  Insert the tip of the vehicle s ignition key or alike into  the child lock control and pull it upward   h      raa aca    ici       LA  DEED    Child Lock Control    24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    3  Repeat Steps 1 and 2 on the opposite rear door     NOTE  When the child lock system is engaged  the door  can be opened only by using the outside door handle  even though the inside door lock is in the unlocked  position     WARNING     Avoid trapping anyone in a vehicle in a collision     Remember that the rear doors can only be opened  from the outside when the child protection locks are  engaged     NOTE    e After engaging the child protection door lock system   always test the door from the inside to make certain it  is in the desired position     e For emergency exit with the system engaged  move  the door lock switch to the UNLOCK position  roll  down the window and open the door with the outside  door handle        To Disengage the Child Protection Door Lock  1  Open the rear door     2  Insert the tip of the vehicle   s ignition key or alike into  the child lock control and pull it downward  
49.  Radiator Cap  Coolant Pressure Cap           289  Radio Broadcast Signals 4 4 essc Rs 158  Radio  Navigati  n  sesasi enesesse SR SO ds 170  Radio Operation 664 sp ERA atau e go dee 159 183  Radio Remote Controls 361s  64 09 lm 4 179  Radio  Satellite 2524 2243 34r EE DRR EE 171 176  Radio  Sound Systems  i 2 rope rete ede 159  Rain Sensitive Wiper System                102  Rear Park Assist System 2a ded dob de WERE HE 112  Reor Seat Folding 12 22 9 990522 532999955 89  Rear Window Defroster       ss ss se 191       356 INDEX NEE NNNM NN    Rear Window Features use ms 191  Reclining Front ci MP King ang oe BE 86  Recorder  Event Data   v2 Bo 6554 5 Ts 46  Recreational Towing 4 369 desc ee cee Sk oed ds 254  Reformulated Gasoline    ii  9x RE ER 246  Keltiese oa              DE DE 283  Reminder  Seat Belt            0        00  35  Remote Keyless Entry  RKE                  17  Remote Sound System  Radio  Controls        179  Remote Trunk Release si ea se aes edn 28  Replacement Parts 4 saa  see RR siiri 274  Replacement Dei  aie 94948 MAYA EUR 234  Reporting Satety Defects 2 tauciadcaondesd 341  Restraint  Head                   eee 87  Restraints  Child uso dos umm HE Rn Igor cds 47  Restraints  QccUpani aoa fete 24345504 30  Rocking Vehicle When Stuck                265  Rotation  Tires 444694 44s See ER EER ood ER 237  Safety Checks Inside Vehicle                 57  Safety Checks Outside Vehicle                58  Safety Defects  Reporting                   341    Safe
50.  They  know you and your vehicle best  and are most concerned  that you get prompt and high quality service  The  manufacturer s dealers have the facilities  factory trained  technicians  special tools  and the latest information to  assure your vehicle is fixed correctly and in a timely  manner     This is why you should always talk to your dealer s  service manager first  Most matters can be resolved with  this process     N  FYOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 339    e  f for some reason you are still not satisfied  talk to the  general manager or owner of the dealership  They  want to know if you need assistance     e If your dealership is unable to resolve the concern  you  may contact the Manufacturer s Customer Center     Any communication to the Manufacturer s Customer  Center should include the following information     e Owner s name and address   e Owner s telephone number  home and office   e Dealership name   e Vehicle identification number   e Vehicle delivery date and mileage    DaimlerChrysler Motors Corporation Customer  Center   P O  Box 21 8004   Auburn Hills  MI 48321 8004   Phone   800  992 1997    DaimlerChrysler Canada Inc  Customer Center  P O  Box 1621   Windsor  Ontario N9A 4H6   Phone     800  465 2001    In Mexico contact    Av  Prolongacion Paseo de la Reforma  1240  Sante Fe C P  05109   Mexico  D  F    In Mexico  915  729 1248 or 729 1240  Outside Mexico  525  729 1248 or 729 1240    Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech  Impaired  TDD TTY    
51.  To make your selection  press and release the FUNC   TION SELECT button until  US  or    METRIC    appears     To Reset The Display   Reset will only occur while a resettable function is being  displayed  Press and release the FUNCTION SELECT  button once to clear the resettable function being dis   played  To reset all resettable functions  press and release  the FUNCTION SELECT button a second time within 3  seconds of resetting the currently displayed function    gt Reset ALL will display during this 3 second window         Compass Display  The compass readings indicate the direction  Q the vehicle is facing  Press and release the  compass button to display one of eight com   CoM  pass readings and the outside temperature   PASS  Button    Automatic Compass Calibration   This compass is self calibrating  which eliminates the  need to set the compass manually  When the vehicle is  new  the compass may appear erratic and the EVIC will  display    CAL    until the compass is calibrated  You may  also calibrate the compass by completing one or more  360   turns  in an area free from large metal or metallic  objects  until the    CAL    message displayed in the EVIC  turns off  The compass will now function normally     Manual Compass Calibration   If the compass appears erratic and the    CAL    message  does not appear in the EVIC display  you must put the  compass into the Calibration Mode manually as follows     1  Turn on the ignition switch     UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUM
52.  a  e Do not exceed 55 mph  90 km h  until the tire has start from another vehicle  This type of start can be danger   been inspected  ous if done improperly  so follow this procedure carefully     Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution  do not allow  battery fluid to contact eyes  skin  or clothing  Don t lean  over battery when attaching clamps or allow the clamps to  touch each other  If acid splashes in eyes or on skin  flush  contaminated area immediately with large quantities of  water     A battery generates hydrogen gas  which is flammable and  explosive  Keep flame or spark away from the vent holes     Do not use a booster battery or any other booster source  with an output that exceeds 12 volts     The battery in this vehicle has a vent hose that should not  be disconnected and should only be replaced with a battery  of the same type  vented         NN WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 263    NOTE   The battery is stored under an access cover in  the trunk  Remote battery terminals are located in the  engine compartment for jump starting     1  Wear eye protection and remove any metal jewelry  such as watchbands or bracelets that might make an  inadvertent electrical contact     2  When boost is provided by a battery in another  vehicle  park that vehicle within booster cable reach  but  do not allow the vehicles to touch one another     WARNING     Do not permit vehicles to touch each other as this    could establish a ground connection and personal  injury could resul
53.  air conditioning filter replacement  intervals     Power Steering     Fluid Check   Checking the power steering fluid level at a defined  service interval is not required  The fluid should only be  checked if a leak is suspected  abnormal noises are  apparent  and or the system is not functioning as antici   pated  Coordinate inspection efforts through a certified  DaimlerChrysler Dealership     WARNING     Fluid level should be checked on a level surface and  with the engine off to prevent injury from moving    parts and to insure accurate fluid level reading  Do  not overfill  Use only manufacturer   s recommended  power steering fluid        If necessary  add fluid to restore to the proper indicated  level  With a clean cloth  wipe any spilled fluid from all    surfaces  Refer to    Fluids  Lubricants  and Genuine  Parts    in this section for the correct fluid type     Front  amp  Rear Suspension Ball Joints   The suspension ball joints should be inspected for exter   nal leakage or damage when other maintenance is per   formed     Steering Linkage   The tie rod end ball joints should be inspected for  external leakage or damage when other maintenance is  performed     Body Lubrication   Locks and all body pivot points  including seat tracks   door hinges  trunk hinges  and hood hinges  should be  lubricated periodically to assure quiet  easy operation  and to protect against rust and wear  Prior to the appli   cation of any lubricant  the parts concerned should be  wipe
54.  closure  If this happens  pull the switch lightly to the  first detent and hold to close window manually     WARNING     There is no anti pinch protection when the window    is almost closed  Be sure to clear all objects from the  window before closing        NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27    Window Lockout Switch   The window lockout switch on the driver s door allows  you to disable the window controls on the passenger  doors  When the switch is pressed  the window controls  on the passenger doors will not illuminate and the  passenger windows will be disabled        Reset   Any time the vehicle battery is disconnected  or goes  dead  the auto up function will be disabled  To reactivate  the auto up feature  perform the following steps after  vehicle power is restored     1  Pull the window switch up to close window com   pletely and continue to hold the switch up for an  additional two seconds after the window is closed     2  Push the window switch down firmly to the second  detent to open the window completely and continue to  hold the switch down for an additional two seconds after  the window is fully open     Wind Buffeting   Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of  pressure on the ears or a helicopter type sound in the  ears  Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the  windows down  or the sunroof  if equipped  in certain  open or partially open positions  This is a normal occur   rence and can be minimized  If the buffeting occ
55.  delayed upshifts depending on engine and transmission  temperature as well as vehicle speed  This feature im   proves warm up time of the engine and transmission to  achieve maximum efficiency     Temporary Transmission Limp Home Mode   The transmission is monitored for abnormal conditions   If a condition is detected that could result in transmission  damage  the transmission will engage Limp Home Mode   If vehicle acceleration worsens  or the transmission no  longer shifts  the transmission is most likely operating in  the Limp Home Mode  In this mode  the transmission       will remain in the current gear until the vehicle is  brought to a stop  After the vehicle has stopped  P  Park    R  Reverse   and N  Neutral  will continue to operate   Second gear will operate in the D  Drive  shifter position   The Malfunction Indicator Light may be illuminated     A reset feature is available to allow the vehicle to be  driven to a dealer for service  To reset the transmission   use the following procedure     1  Stop the vehicle    2  Move the selector lever to the P  Park  position   3  Turn off the engine    4  Wait approximately 10 seconds    5  Restart the engine     6  Move the selector lever to the desired range  If the  problem is no longer detected  the transmission will  return to normal operation     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 207    NOTE  Even if the transmission can be reset  we  recommend that you visit a dealer at your earliest  possible convenience  Your dealer has 
56.  e Depress the brake pedal     e Push the speed control lever away from you   CAN   CEL         Pushing and releasing the lever     ON OFF     or turning  off the ignition erases the set speed from memory     To Resume Speed    If you deactivated the speed control without erasing the  set speed from memory and your vehicle speed is above  20 mph  32 km h  you can resume the previous set    NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 111    speed  To do so  push the lever up and release  RES   ACCEL   and then remove your foot from the accelerator  pedal     To Vary the Speed Setting    When the speed control is set  you can increase speed by  pushing the lever up and holding     RES ACCEL       When the lever is released  a new set speed will be  established     Pushing the lever up and releasing   RES  ACCEL     once  will result in a 1 mph  1 6 km h  speed increase  Each  time the lever is pushed up and released  speed increases  so that pushing the lever up and releasing three times  will increase speed by 3 mph  4 8 km h   etc     To decrease speed while speed control is set  push the  lever down and hold   SET DECEL    Release the lever  when the desired speed is reached  and a new set speed  will be established     Pushing down and releasing the lever     SET DECEL      once will result in a 1 mph  1 6 km h  speed decrease   Each time the lever is pushed down and released  speed  decreases     To Accelerate For Passing   Depress the accelerator as you would normally  
57.  for the name of the phonebook  entry that you wish to edit     e Next  choose the number designation  home  work   mobile  or pager  that you wish to edit     e When prompted  recite the new phone number for the  phonebook entry that you are editing     After you are finished editing an entry in the phonebook   you will be given the opportunities to edit another entry  in the phonebook  call the number you just edited  or  return to the main menu      Phonebook Edit  can be used to add another phone  number to a name entry that already exists in the  phonebook  For example  the entry John Doe may have a  mobile and a home number  but you can add John Doe s  work number later using the  Phonebook Edit  feature     Delete Entries in the UConnect    Phonebook    NOTE  Editing phonebook entries is recommended  when vehicle is not in motion     e Press the  Phone  button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Phonebook Delete      e After you enter the Phonebook Delete menu  you will  then be asked for the name of the entry that you wish  to delete  You can either say the name of a phonebook  entry that you wish to delete or you can say  List  Names  to hear a list of the entries in the phonebook       72 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    from which you choose  To select one of the entries  from the list  press the  Voice Recognition  button  while the UConnect    system is playing the desired  entry and say  Delete      After you ente
58.  fuel in case the engine is flooded     CAUTION     To prevent damage to the starter  do not crank the    engine for more than 15 seconds at a time  Wait 10 to  15 seconds before trying again        198 STARTING AND OPERATING NN Id    WARNING     e Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into  the throttle body air inlet opening in an attempt to  start the vehicle  This could result in flash fire  causing serious personal injury     Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get  it started  Vehicles equipped with an automatic  transmission cannot be started this way  Un     burned fuel could enter the catalytic converter and  once the engine has started  ignite and damage the  converter and vehicle  If the vehicle has a dis   charged battery  booster cables may be used to  obtain a start from a booster battery or the battery  in another vehicle  This type of start can be  dangerous if done improperly  See section 6 of  this manual for the proper jump starting proce   dures and follow them carefully        If the engine is flooded  it may start to run  but not have  enough power to continue running when the key is  released  If this occurs  continue cranking up to 15  seconds with the accelerator pedal pushed all the way to  the floor  Release the accelerator pedal and the key once  the engine is running smoothly  Do not overspeed the  engine    If the engine shows no sign of starting after two 15   second periods of cranking with the accelerator pedal    held to the flo
59.  have 1 number to represent the year in  which the tire was manufactured  Example  031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991           STARTING AND OPERATING 225    Tire Loading and Tire Pressure Tire and Loading Information Placard    Tire Placard Location    N qu  EER 8  EI    D    v ARA  Pr    NOTE  The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed    SEATING CAPACITY  on either the face of the driver s door or the driver s side    T125 70D15      200KPa 420kPa  GOPSI      AAPsl  SEE OWNER S MANUAL FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION  Ti  4M1D3268        amp 11bh5ada    Tire and Loading Information    This placard tells you important information about  the     1  number of people that can be carried in the vehicle  2  the total weight your vehicle can carry  3  the tire size designed for your vehicle    4  the cold tire inflation pressures for the front  rear  and spare tires        B11ad0do    Tire Placard Location    226 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    Loading   The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed  the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle  You  will not exceed the tire s load carrying capacity if you  adhere to the loading conditions  tire size  and cold tire  inflation pressures specified on the  Tire and Loading  Information  placard and in the  Vehicle Loading  sec   tion of this manual     NOTE  Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition   gross axle weight ratings  GAWR s  for the front and rear  axles must not be exceeded  For further in
60.  hose surfaces nearest  to high heat sources  such as the exhaust manifold     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 293    Insure nylon tubing in these areas has not melted or WARNING   collapsed       Worn brake hoses can burst and cause brake failure   Inspect all hose connections such as clamps and cou     plings to make sure they are secure and no leaks are  present     NOTE    e Often  fluid such as oil  power steering fluid  and  brake fluid are used during assembly plant operations  to facilitate the assembly of hoses to couplings  There   fore  oil wetness at the hose coupling area is not  necessarily an indication of leakage  Actual dripping  of hot fluid when systems are under pressure  during Check the fluid level in the master cylinder when per   vehicle operation   should be noted before a hose is forming underhood services   replaced based on leakage     You could have an accident  If you see any signs of  cracking  scuffing  or worn spots  have the brake  hoses replaced immediately        Master Cylinder   Brake Fluid Level Check   Check the fluid level in the master cylinder immediately  if the brake system warning light indicates system fail   ure        Clean the top of the master cylinder area before removing  Inspect the brake hoses whenever the brake system is the cap  Add fluid to bring the level up to the top of the  serviced and at every engine oil change  Inspect hy     FULL    mark on the side of the master cylinder reservoir   draulic brake hoses for surface 
61.  in Section 4 of this manual  To turn ESP on  again  momentarily depress the  ESP OFF Button      NOTE  The  ESP OFE    or    ESP System Deactivated     message will display and the audible chime will sound  when the gear selector is moved into the PARK position  from any position other than PARK and then moved out  of the PARK position  This will occur when the message  was previously cleared     WARNING     In the ESP Full Off mode  the engine torque reduc     tion and stability features are cancelled  Therefore   the enhanced vehicle stability offered by ESP is  unavailable        NOTE  When the ESP is switched off a feature of the  system remains active  This feature controls wheel spin  across an axle quite similarly to a limited slip differential   If one wheel on an axle is spinning faster than the other   the system will apply the brake of the spinning wheel  and allow more engine torque to be applied to the wheel  that is not spinning  To improve the vehicle   s traction  when driving with tire chains  or when starting off in  deep snow  sand  or gravel  it may be desirable to switch  to the    Partial Off    mode by momentarily depressing the     ESP OFF  button     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 219    WARNING     With the ESP switched off  the enhanced vehicle  stability offered by ESP is unavailable  In an emer     gency evasive maneuver  the ESP system will not  engage to assist in maintaining stability  The    Full  Off    ESP mode is intended for off highway or off
62.  information   3  Your Vehicle Identification Number     Electronic Serial Number Sirius Identification  Number  ESN SID    The Electronic Serial Number Sirius Identification Num   ber is needed to activate your Sirius Satellite Radio  system  To access the ESN SID  refer to the following  steps     ESN SID Access With REF Radios   With the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY position and  the radio OFF  press the CD Eject and Time buttons  simultaneously for 3 seconds  The first four digits of the  twelve digit ESN SID number will display  Press the  SEEK UP button to display the next four digits  Continue  to press the SEEK UP button until all twelve ESN SID  digits display  The SEEK DOWN will page down until  the first four digits display  The radio will exit the    ee UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 177    ESN SID mode when any other button is pushed  the  ignition is turned OFF  or 5 minutes has passed since any  button was pushed     ESN SID Access With RAO and RAK Radios   With the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY position and  the radio OFF  press the CD Eject and TIME buttons  simultaneously for 3 seconds  All twelve ESN SID num   bers will display  The radio will exit the ESN SID mode  when any other button is pushed  the ignition is turned  OFF  or 5 minutes has passed since any button was  pushed     ESN SID Access With REC Navigation Radios  Please refer to your Navigation User s Manual     With the ignition in the ACCESSORY position and the  radio off  press th
63.  is provided  with a four digit PIN number  This number is required  for dealer replacement of keys  Duplication of keys may  be performed at an authorized dealer or by using the  Customer Key Programming procedure  This procedure       14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE NN    consists of programming a blank key to the vehicle  electronics  A blank key is one  which has never been  programmed     NOTE  When having the Sentry Key Immobilizer  System serviced  bring all vehicle keys with you to the  dealer     Customer Key Programming   If you have two valid sentry keys  you can program new  sentry keys to the system by performing the following  procedure     1  Cut the additional Sentry Key Transponder blank s  to  match the ignition switch lock cylinder key code     2  Insert the first valid key into the ignition switch and  turn the ignition switch ON for at least 3 seconds but no  longer than 15 seconds  Turn the ignition switch OFF and  remove the first key     3  Insert the second valid key and turn the ignition  switch ON within 15 seconds  After ten seconds  a chime  will sound and the Vehicle Security Alarm Indicator  Light will begin to flash  Turn the ignition switch OFF  and remove the second Key     4  Insert a blank Sentry Key into the ignition switch and  turn the ignition switch ON within 60 seconds  After 10  seconds  a single chime will sound and the Vehicle  Security Alarm Indicator Light will stop flashing  turn on  again for 3 seconds  and then 
64.  light monitors the electrical system volt   age  The light should turn on momentarily as   the engine is started  If the light stays on or turns on   while driving  it indicates a problem with the charging   system  Immediate service should be obtained        24  Malfunction Indicator Light   This light is part of an onboard diagnostic  Cw system called OBD  The OBD system monitors   engine and automatic transmission control sys   tems  The light will turn on when the key is in the ON  position before engine start  If the light does not come  on when turning the key from OFF to ON  have the  condition checked promptly     Certain conditions such as a loose or missing gas cap   poor fuel quality  etc  may illuminate the light after  engine start  The vehicle should be serviced if the light  stays on through several of your typical driving cycles  In  most situations  the vehicle will drive normally and will  not require towing     UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 143    The Malfunction Indicator Light flashes to alert you to  serious conditions that could lead to immediate loss of  power or severe catalytic converter damage  The vehicle  should be serviced as soon as possible if this occurs   See  page 272 for more information      25  Oil Pressure Warning Light   i This light shows low engine oil pressure  The  light should turn on momentarily when the   engine is started  If the light turns on while driving    stop the vehicle  and shut off the engine as soon as   possib
65.  lubrication or oil change  Replace as required        N E NN MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 287    Cooling System    WARNING     e When working near the radiator cooling fan  dis   connect the fan motor lead or turn the ignition  switch to the OFF position  The fan is temperature  controlled and can start at any time the ignition  switch is in the ON position     You or others can be badly burned by hot coolant  or steam from your radiator  If you see or hear  steam coming from under the hood  don t open  the hood until the radiator has had time to cool   Never try to open a cooling system pressure cap  when the radiator is hot     Coolant Checks   Check engine coolant  antifreeze  protection every 12  months  before the onset of freezing weather  where  applicable   If coolant is dirty or rusty in appearance  the  system should be drained  flushed and refilled with fresh  coolant  Check the front of the A C condenser for any       accumulation of bugs  leaves  etc  If dirty  clean by gently  spraying water from a garden hose vertically down the  face of the condenser     Check the coolant recovery bottle tubing for brittle rub   ber  cracking  tears  cuts  and tightness of the connection  at the bottle and radiator  Inspect the entire system for  leaks     With the engine at normal operating temperature  but  not running   check the cooling system pressure cap for  proper vacuum sealing by draining a small amount of  coolant from the radiator drain cock  If the cap is sealing  pr
66.  panel  When the Hazard Warn   ing is activated  all directional turn signals will flash on  and off to warn oncoming traffic of an emergency  Push  the switch a second time to turn off the flashers        This is an emergency warning system and it should not  be used when the vehicle is in motion  Use it when your  vehicle is disabled and it is creating a safety hazard for  other motorists     When you must leave the vehicle to seek assistance  the  Hazard Warning Flashers will continue to operate even  though the ignition switch is OFF     NOTE  With extended use  the Hazard Warning Flash   ers may wear down your battery     IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS   In any of the following situations  you can reduce the  potential for overheating by taking the appropriate ac   tion     e On the highways     Slow down     e In city traffic     While stopped  put transmission in  neutral  but do not increase engine idle speed     NN WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 257    NOTE  There are steps that you can take to slow down WARNING   an impending overheat condition  If your air conditioner    is on  turn it off  The air conditioning system adds heat to A hot engine cooling system is dangerous  You or  the engine cooling system and turning off the A C others could be badly burned by steam or boiling  removes this heat  You can also turn the Temperature coolant  You may want to call a service center if your  control to maximum heat  the Mode control to floor  and vehicle overheats  If you decide to 
67.  prevent moisture and dirt from entering the valve  stem  which could damage the Tire Pressure  Monitoring Sensor     NOTE  Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire  pressure  and the TPMS will monitor the actual tire  pressure in the tire        ee STARTING AND OPERATING 241    NOTE    e The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire care  and maintenance  or to provide warning of a tire  failure or condition     e The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure gauge  while adjusting your tire pressure     e Driving on a significantly under inflated tire causes  the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure   Under inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire  tread life  and may affect the vehicle   s handling and  stopping ability     e The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire mainte   nance  and it is the driver   s responsibility to maintain  correct tire pressure  even if under inflation has not  reached the level to trigger illumination of the Tire  Pressure Monitoring Telltale light     Base System     If Equipped  The Tire Pressure Monitor System  TPMS  uses wireless  technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to    monitor tire pressure levels  Sensors  mounted to each  wheel as part of the valve stem  transmit tire pressure  readings to the Receiver Module     NOTE  It is particularly important for you to check the  tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle regularly  and to maintain the proper pressure     The TPMS consists of th
68.  proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed either on  the face of the driver s door or on the driver s side  B   pillar     Some vehicles may have Supplemental Tire Pressure  Information for vehicle loads that are less than the  maximum loaded vehicle condition  These pressure con   ditions will be found in the  Supplemental Tire Pressure  Information  section of this manual        811ad0dO    Tire Placard Location    The pressure should be checked and adjusted as well as  inspecting for signs of tire wear or visible damage at least  once a month  Use a good quality pocket type gauge to  check tire pressure  Do not make a visual judgement  when determining proper inflation  Radial tires may look  properly inflated even when they are under inflated     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 231    CAUTION     After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure  al     ways reinstall the valve stem cap  if equipped   This  will prevent moisture and dirt from entering the  valve stem  which could damage the valve stem        Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always     cold tire inflation pressure     Cold tire inflation pressure  is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not  been driven for at least 3 hours  or driven less than 1 mile   1 km  after a 3 hour period  The cold tire inflation  pressure must not exceed the maximum inflation pres   sure molded into the tire sidewall     Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range  of outdoor temperatures
69.  provides greater control  of available braking forces applied to the rear axle     212 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    When the vehicle is driven over 7 mph  11 km h   you  may also hear a slight clicking sound as well as some  related motor noises  These noises are the system per   forming its self check cycle to ensure that the ABS system  is working properly  This self check occurs each time the  vehicle is started and accelerated past 7 mph  11 km h      ABS is activated during braking under certain road or  stopping conditions  ABS inducing conditions can in   clude ice  snow  gravel  bumps  railroad tracks  loose  debris  or panic stops     You also may experience the following when the brake  system goes into Anti lock     e The ABS motor running  it may continue to run for a  short time after the stop      e the clicking sound of solenoid valves   e brake pedal pulsations     e anda slight drop or fall away of the brake pedal at the  end of the stop     These are all normal characteristics of ABS     WARNING     The Anti Lock Brake System contains sophisticated  electronic equipment that may be susceptible to inter   ference caused by improperly installed or high output  radio transmitting equipment  This interference can  cause possible loss of anti lock braking capability  In   stallation of such equipment should be performed by  qualified professionals     Pumping of the Anti Lock Brakes will diminish their  effectiveness and may lead to an accident  Pumping  mak
70.  single chime   Refer to  information on  Tire Pressure  and  Tire Pressure  Monitor  in the  Starting And Operating  section of  this manual     Left Rear Low Pressure  with a single chime   Refer to  information on  Tire Pressure  and  Tire Pressure  Monitor  in the  Starting And Operating  section of  this manual     NE UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 147    Right Front Low Pressure  with a single chime   Refer  to information on  Tire Pressure  and  Tire Pressure  Monitor  in the  Starting And Operating  section of  this manual     Right Rear Low Pressure  with a single chime   Refer  to information on  Tire Pressure  and  Tire Pressure  Monitor  in the  Starting And Operating  section of  this manual     Check TPM System  with a single chime   Refer to  information on  Tire Pressure Monitor  in the    Start   ing And Operating  section of this manual     Check Gascap  refer to  Adding Fuel  in Section 5 of  this manual for more details     Service Park Assist System  with a single chime     Upshift    Trip Functions  Press and release the MENU button until one of the  following Trip Functions displays in the EVIC     Average Fuel Economy    Distance To Empty   Trip A   Trip B   Elapsed Time   Display Units of Measure in    Press the SCROLL button to cycle through all the Trip  Computer functions     The Trip Functions mode displays the following informa   tion     e Average Fuel Economy   Shows the average fuel economy since the last reset   When the fuel economy is 
71.  system clock  you can manually adjust the time by  choosing the  User Defined Clock  option     1  At the Clock Setup screen highlight  Displayed  Clock  User Defined Clock         FM 925 On  C    81990 ef    2  To increase the clock by hours  make sure    HR      is  highlighted and press ENTER  Press ENTER again to  increase the clock by another hour  You will see on the     User Defined Time    display the number of hours you  have increased the clock by     3  To decrease the clock by one hour  use the Select  Encoder to highlight the         sign  Press ENTER  Press  ENTER again to decrease the clock by another hour     1  When you are at an audio screen  quickly press the    Select this option to change the size of the clock on the  TIME button on the navigation faceplate     Audio Clock Display  audio screens     use the Select    Encoder to highlight the     sign  Press ENTER  Press    J    inute  minutes    the clock by another m    To decrease the clock by    Increase    5    m UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 173    4  To increase the clock by minutes  make sure    MIN       is highlighted and press ENTER  Press ENTER again to       wee NEN  re RR RR ony  ee a a   To pope    FEES  EM   ER  peime  peee  pine  BERGE  sent  ER    neces  tes    RC te re    ee eee    ee  I  ETTE ee    eee ee    t    RR RR EES N Re He Re EE  MERE EDE EE EER ERG    MERE ERE ER  Seen est RE    wee  M  Be nnau nAaR nanan    DRR REEN N ee N Me  RR ORE DAD N AA Re Ho Re Ao    re  hk ke ii
72.  the first call  refer  to  Togeling Between Calls   To combine two calls  refer  to  Conference Call      Place Retrieve a Call from Hold   To put a call on hold  press the  Phone  button until you  hear a single beep  This indicates that the call is on hold   To bring the call back from hold  press and hold the   Phone  button until you hear a single beep     74 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    Toggling Between Calls   If two calls are in progress  one active and one on hold    press the  Phone  button until you hear a single beep  indicating that the active and hold status of the two calls  have switched  Only one call can be placed on hold at one  time     Conference Call   When two calls are in progress  one active and one on  hold   press and hold the  Phone  button until you hear a  double beep indicating that the two calls have been  joined into one conference call     Three Way Calling   To initiate three way calling  press the  Voice Recogni   tion  button while a call is in progress and make a second  phone call as described under  Making a Second Call  while Current Call in Progress   After the second call has  established  press and hold the  Phone  button until you  hear a double beep indicating that the two calls have  been joined into one conference call     Call Termination   To end a call in progress  momentarily press the    Phone     button  Only the active call s  will be terminated and if  there 1s a call on hold  it will become the new ac
73.  triggers the alarm  and no action is taken to  disarm it  the system will turn off the horn after 3  minutes  turn off all of the visual signals after 15 minutes   and then the system will rearm itself     To Arm the System    Remove the key from the ignition switch and either press  a power door lock switch while the driver or passenger  door is open or press the LOCK button on the keyless  entry transmitter  After the last door is closed  or if all  doors are closed  the system will arm itself in about 16  seconds  During that time  the Vehicle Security Alarm  Indicator light will flash  If it does not illuminate  the  system is not arming  Also  if you open a door during the  arming period  the system will cancel the arming process   If you wish to rearm the system after closing the door   you must repeat one of the previously described arming  sequences        16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE NN    To Disarm the System    Either press the UNLOCK button on the remote keyless  entry transmitter or insert a valid sentry key into the  ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON START  position     NOTE    e The driver s door key cylinder and the trunk button on  the keyless entry transmitter cannot arm or disarm the  system     e The system remains armed during trunk entry  Press   ing the trunk button will not disarm the system  If  someone enters the vehicle through the trunk and  opens any door the alarm will sound     e When the system is armed  the i
74.  under  Electronic  Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this  manual     NE UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 159    SALES CODE RAK   AM FM CASSETTE CD Operating Instructions   Radio Mode    6 DISC  RADIO WITH OPTIONAL SATELLITE EMEN l l   RADIO  HANDS FREE PHONE  VIDEO  MP3  and NOTE  The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC  WMA CAPABILITIES position to operate the radio     NOTE  The radio sales code is located on the lower  right side of your radio faceplate     Power Switch Volume Control  Rotary   Press the ON VOL control to turn the radio ON  Press  the ON VOL a second time to turn OFF the radio  mm    Electronic Volume Control  The electronic volume control turns continuously  360  degrees  in either direction without stopping  Turning the      volume control to the right increases the volume and to  OF the left decreases it             When the audio system is turned on  the sound will be  set at the same volume level as last played     Mode Button  Radio Mode    Press the mode button repeatedly to select between the  CD player  Cassette  Satellite  or Vehicle Entertainment  RAK Radio System  VES   if equipped      SEEK Button  Radio Mode   Press and release the SEEK button to search for the next  station in either AM FM or Satellite  if equipped  mode        E13224 35    160 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    Press the right side of the button to seek up and the left  side to seek down  The radio will remained tuned to the  new statio
75.  under inflated tire causes the tire to over   heat and can lead to tire failure  Under inflation also    reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life  and may affect  the vehicle s handling and stopping ability        142 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper  tire maintenance  and it is the driver s responsibility to  maintain correct tire pressure  even if under inflation has  not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS  low tire pressure telltale     The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will illumi   nate in the instrument cluster  and an audible chime will  be activated when one or more tire pressures is low  The  Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will flash on and  off for 60 seconds when a system fault is detected  The  flash cycle will repeat every ten minutes or until the fault  condition is removed and reset   See page 239 for more  information      CAUTION     The TPMS has been optimized for the original  equipment tires and wheels  TPMS pressures and  warning have been established for the tire size  equipped on your vehicle  Undesirable system op     eration or sensor damage may result when using  replacement equipment that is not of the same size   type  and or style  After market wheels can cause  sensor damage  Do not use tire sealant from a can  or  balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with a  TPMS  as damage to the sensors may result        23  Voltage Light   This
76.  underfilling will cause oil aeration or  loss of oil pressure  This could damage your engine        Change Engine Oil   Road conditions and your kind of driving affect the  interval at which your oil should be changed  Check the  following list to see if any apply to you        e Day or night temperatures are below 32  F  0  C    e Stop and Go driving    e Extensive engine idling    e Driving in dusty conditions    e Short trips of less than 10 miles  16 km      e More than 5076 of your driving is at sustained high  speeds during hot weather  above 90  F  32  C      e Trailer towing   e Taxi  Police  or delivery service  commercial service    e Off Road or desert operation     NOTE  If ANY of these apply to you  then change your  engine oil every 3 000 miles  5 000 km  or 3 months   whichever comes first  and follow schedule    B    in the   Maintenance Schedules    in this manual     If none of these applies to you  then change your engine  oil at every interval shown on schedule  A  in the   Maintenance Schedules    in this manual     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 277    ENGINE OIL VISCOSITY CHART    NOTE  Under no circumstances should oil change  intervals exceed 6 000 miles  10 000 km  or 6 months   whichever comes first     Engine Oil Selection   For best performance and maximum protection under all  types of operating conditions  the manufacturer only  recommends full synthetic engine oils that meet the  American Petroleum Institute  API  categories of SM or  SM CE  and m
77.  will cause  decreased performance  Larger luggage items should be  placed as far forward as possible  Do not place items  directly on or above the antenna     Reception Quality  Satellite reception may be interrupted due to one of the  following reasons     e The vehicle is parked in an underground parking  structure or under a physical obstacle     e Dense tree coverage may interrupt reception in the  form of short audio mutes     e Driving under wide bridges or along tall buildings can  cause intermittent reception     e Placing objects over or too close to the antenna can  cause signal blockage     REMOTE SOUND SYSTEM CONTROLS   The remote sound system controls are located on the  surface of the steering wheel at the 3 and 9 o clock  positions         amp 1B8c9c36    Electronic Vehicle Information Center  Vehicles equipped with steering wheel mounted buttons  are also equipped with the Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC   The EVIC features a driver interactive  display  This is located in the upper part of the instru   ment cluster between the speedometer and tachometer     180 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL         VOL   UME  Button    J    AUDIO  MODE  Button    The VOLUME button controls the sound level  of the sound system  Press the top of the  VOLUME button to increase the sound level   Press the bottom of the VOLUME button to  decrease the sound level     Press the AUDIO MODE button to select the  Compass Temp Audio screen  This screen  displays radi
78.  work for which you    have the knowledge and the proper equipment  If  you have any doubt about your ability to perform a  service job  take your vehicle to a competent me   chanic     MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES   The pages that follow contain the required maintenance  services determined by the engineers who designed your  vehicle     Besides the maintenance items for which there are fixed  maintenance intervals  there are other items that should  operate satisfactorily without periodic maintenance   However  if a malfunction of these items does occur  it  could adversely affect the engine or vehicle performance   These items should be inspected if a malfunction is  observed or suspected        Engine Oil    Checking Oil Level   To assure proper engine lubrication  the engine oil must  be maintained at the correct level  Check the oil level at  regular intervals  such as every fuel stop     The best time to check the engine oil level is about 5  minutes after a fully warmed engine is shut off or before  starting the engine after it has sat overnight     Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will  improve the accuracy of the oil level readings  Maintain  the oil level in the    SAFE    range  Adding 1 0 quart  1 0L   of oil when the reading is at the bottom of the    SAFE     range will result in an oil level at the top of the    SAFE     range on these engines        276 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE       8131e255    Engine Oil Dipstick    CAUTION     Overfilling or
79. 0  x 000  ET 000  ox 000  a 000     Change engine oil and engine oil filter  if not re   placed at 3 months     Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re   quired      Replace the air cleaner filter  Eo EE EE ee X ee       AX    Inspect the front and rear brake linings and rotors        X               1  X      Check and replace  if necessary  the PCV valve       Change the automatic transmission fluid and filter       EX  Replace the air conditioning filter     X        Feri asked   1 1  L    if not replaced at 102 000 miles     Rotate the tires  LX        X      X    AX    my    AX           AX    M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8          SCHEDULE  B  329    Miles 123 000 126 000 129 000 132 000 135 000   Kilometers    000  x 000  a 000  a 000  Ux  000     Change engine oil and engine oil filter  if not re   placed at 3 months     Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re   quired      Replace the air cleaner filter  o T S S S E i  Inspect the front and rear brake linings and rotors  dd ES    Check and Inspect the accessory drive belt and ten   LE Replace if reguired     Replace the air conditioning filter        the air conditioning filter     Rotate the tires  L    1 z 1     T       M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       330 SCHEDULE  B     Miles 138 000 141 000 144 000 147 000 150 000   Kilometers  a 000  a 000  a 000  Ux 000  Ux 000     Change engine oil and engine oil filter  if not re   placed at
80. Board Diagnostic  system is ready  for testing     Normally  the OBD system will be ready  The OBD  system may not be ready if your vehicle was recently  serviced  if you recently had a dead battery  or a battery  replacement  If the OBD system should be determined  not ready for the I M test  your vehicle may fail the test     Your vehicle has a simple ignition key actuated test   which you can use prior to going to the test station  To  check if your vehicle s OBD system is ready  you must do  the following     1  Insert your ignition key into the ignition switch     2  Turn the ignition to the ON position  but do not crank  or start the engine     3  If you crank or start the engine  you will have to start  this test over     4  As soon as you turn your key to the ON position  you  will see your MIL symbol come on as part of a normal  bulb check     5  Approximately 15 seconds later  one of two things will  happen     a  The MIL will flash for about 10 seconds and then  return to being fully illuminated until you turn off  the ignition key or start the engine  This means that  your vehicle s OBD system is not ready and you  should not proceed to the I M station        274 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    b  The MIL will not flash at all and will remain fully  illuminated until you turn off the ignition key or  start the engine  This means that your vehicle s OBD  system is ready and you can proceed to the I M  station     If your OBD system is not ready  you should see yo
81. Button  CD Mode for MP3 Play   Switches back to Radio mode        170 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id     RND PTY Button  CD Mode for MP3 Play   Pressing this button plays files randomly     SET DIR Button  CD Mode for MP3 Play    Press the SET DIR Button to display folders  when  playing an MP3 discs that have a file folder structure   Turn the TUNE control to display available folders or  move through available folders  Press the TUNE control  to select a folder     Buttons 1   6  CD Mode for MP3 Play   Selects disc positions 1   6 for Play Load Eject     Operating Instructions   Hands Free Phone  If  Equipped    Refer to  Hands Free Phone  in Section 3 of the Owner s  Manual     Operating Instructions   Satellite Radio Mode  If  Equipped    Refer to the  Satellite Radio  section of the Owner s  Manual     Operating Instructions   Video Entertainment  System  VES   If Equipped    Refer to separate  Video Entertainment System  VES   Guide      SALES CODE REC     AM FM CD  6 DISC  RADIO  WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM       1256256       REC Radio  Satellite Navigation Radio with CD Player with MP3  Capability  REC    combines a  Global Positioning  System based navigation system with an integrated color    NE UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 171    screen to provide maps  turn identification  selection  menus and instructions for selecting a variety of destina   tions and routes  AM FM stereo radio and six disc CD  changer with MP3 capability     Mapping information fo
82. ENT PANEL 149    2  Press and hold the compass button for approximately  2 seconds     3  Press the SCROLL button until    Calibrate Compass     displays in the EVIC     4  Press and release the FUNCTION SELECT button to  start the calibration  The message    CAL    will display in  the EVIC     5  Complete one or more 360   turns  in an area free from  large metal or metallic objects  until the    CAL    message  turns off  The compass will now function normally     Compass Variance   Compass Variance is the difference between magnetic  North and Geographic North  In some areas of the  country  the difference between magnetic and geographic  North is great enough to cause the compass to give false  readings  If this occurs  the compass variance must be set  using the following procedure     NOTE  Magnetic materials should be kept away from  the overhead console  This is where the compass sensor is  located           150 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  1  Turn the ignition switch ON     2  Press and hold the compass button for approximately  2 seconds     3  Press the SCROLL button until  Compass Variance   message and the last variance zone number displays in  the EVIC     4  Press and release FUNCTION SELECT button until  the proper variance zone is selected according to the  map    5  Press and release the compass button to exit   Telephone     If Equipped    Press and release the MENU button until  Telephone   displays in the EVIC     When the appropriate conditions 
83. ETRAS CERES S RITE 171  PREG bete TE Glock siese thes HNP RAD val  o Audio Clock Display                 0   179  W Video Entertainment System  Sales Code XRV       li EQUIO ed  eridi sd aad ED ear ahs oe 4 174  D Kicker Mobile Surround  Kms1              175  W Satellite Radio     If Equipped               176    ELO U Ste TA CUVODIOE sgae era sure dou Da 176    ee UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 133    O Electronic Serial Number Sirius Identification    Number  ESN SID     2644260264464 EE rs 176  D Selecting Satellite Mode In REF  RAQ  And   BRAK Kades RP  177  EIDE ecu a     hiannel sai m be bere hoes 4 177  O Storing And Selecting Pre Set Channels        178    o Using The PTY  Program Type  Button  If    Edtipped ME P         DE 178  OPIY B  tton BE  4444764 2232 92 952 4459 25 3 178  ETT Button Soek ae eon wed we x aree Yir 178  Pi Satelite Antenna    2 14 niesde tos SPR OER RE 179  Ei Reception Ouali iss dtes ERO EA ERE 179   ll Remote Sound System Controls             179    Radio Operation sd os aeaoe a eae em ye a 180  D lape Thayer Ope oi aac opu bete irn DRA 181  E CD Player Operation x    624 4244 6694 eR 181  O Satellite Radio Operation   6 0 6 0 eder e  181    W Cassette Tape And Player Maintenance  B CD DVD Disc Maintenance                   W Radio Operation And Cellular Phones         183  B Climate Controls                   00   183  D Automatic Temperature Control             183  Opes MOS exor geecbd s Hae ARE RR HER 188  ll Rear Window Features    
84. Firmly press and release the  learn  or  smart  button    The name and color of the button may vary by manu   facturer      NOTE  You will have 30 seconds in which to initiate  Step 8     8  Return to the vehicle and firmly press  hold for two  seconds  and release the programmed HomeLink button   Repeat the  press hold release  sequence a second time   and  depending on the brand of the garage door opener     or other rolling code equipped device   repeat this  sequence a third time to complete the programming     HomeLink should now activate your rolling code  equipped device     NOTE  To program the remaining two HomeLink but   tons  begin with  Programming  Step 2  Do not repeat  Step 1  For questions or comments  please contact  HomeLink at www homelink com or 1 800 355 3515     Canadian Programming Gate Programming  Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter sig   nals to  time out   or quit  after several seconds of  transmission  which may not be long enough for  HomeLink to pick up the signal during programming   Similar to this Canadian law  some U S  gate operators are  designed to  time out  in the same manner     If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties  programming a gate operator by using the  Program   ming  procedures  regardless of where you live   replace   Programming HomeLink  Step 3 with the following        120 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  NN Id    NOTE  If programming a garage door opener or gate  operator  it is advis
85. G COLUMN  This feature allows you to tilt the steering column  upward or downward  It also allows you to lengthen or  shorten the steering column  The power tilt telescoping  steering column lever is located below the multi function  lever on the steering column   MEE EE ENE       Power Tilt Telescoping Steering  To tilt the steering column  move the lever up or down as  desired  To lengthen or shorten the steering column  pull  the lever toward you or push the lever away from you as  desired         NOTE  For vehicles equipped with Driver Memory  Seat  you can use your remote keyless entry transmitter  or the memory switch on the driver s door panel to  return the tilt telescopic steering column to pre   programmed positions  Refer to  Driver Memory Seat   in this section for details     WARNINCG     Moving the steering column while the vehicle is  moving is dangerous  Without a stable steering col     umn  you could lose control of the vehicle and have  an accident  Adjust the column only while the ve   hicle is stopped           108 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    ADJUSTABLE PEDALS  The adjustable pedals system is designed to allow a  greater range of driver comfort for steering wheel tilt and  seat position  This feature allows both the brake and  accelerator pedal to move toward or away from the  driver to provide improved position with the steering  wheel  The switch is located on the front side of the  driver s seat cushion side shield     LIE       Adj
86. I HA 279  EL ESSO OE diet 4 gat eet ee ae a ee dra 278    O Drive Belts     Check Condition And Tension    278  ub udin oo P hee OE VET 278    O Engine Air Cleaner Filter   4 3444 ea  iode s 279  uso PHC PE 29  BE al Uc Converter 42344944 ORR AE DE 279    Ol Maintenance PFree Dattery  s seo ace kn d    O Air Conditioner Maintenance    o A C Air Filter     If Equipped              283  D Power Steering     Fluid Check      sw   0s ea  94 284  O Front  amp  Rear Suspension Ball Joints          284  Steere ISIN dO s aus ss dower ee MES RA DE 284  O Body LUDICO uos d eue iek DEP US  amp  idu 284  3 Windshield Wiper Blades                  285       270 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    D Windshield Washers Headlight Washers    EE dust ele  ves aco o 2 nitide  E Coollig SvSIeBt syki e RAAR ER PER ees  O Hoses And Vacuum  Vapor Harnesses      Elf ie  Sys lei  is ee der dor oe PRES  O Drake SYSteR cas coax n ER HER HEERS  O Automatic Transmission                O Front And Rear Wheel Bearings           D Appearance Care And Protection From    COMOSIOM 6 2 Houta a done dw oe oe  amp   O Cleaning The Center Console Cup Holders        Bl Fuses  Power Distribution Centers          O Fuses  Front Power Distribution Center     296    oo     300    D Fuses  Rear Power Distribution Center         302  IM Vehicle Storage eoe in HER PR RES 306  B Replacement Bulbs                       307  B Bulb Replacement        EE EE ee 307  O Low Beam Headlight  High Beam Headlight   And Park  Tus Light
87. MISCOSWY  V T              P 217 319  Onboard Diagnostic System              d DO  Opener  Garage Door  HomeLink              116  Operating Precautions seine EIERS DE 272  Outside Rearview Mirrors      sesse ss see 63    N INDEX 355    Overhead Console                  lees  115  Overhealino  ENOI so oie mi i SORIA eae oo 256  Owner s Manual  Operator Manual            341  Pame Ee ET AA AE EE ES ES 19  Park Assist System  Rear 22402004 bi dd RR ER 112  Parkins Drake dorsscctsmx es REID RE e dede 210  Parking On HI  xs 22a vara on dx 4 oa 210  Passie Ment soos ses mace d iura Pg red URE 99  Pedals Adj  sfable sess doe dee Ab ER RED des 108  Personal eties sa  esas 20 een das eS 153  ee ee er ee ee ee ee ee ee 55  Phone  Cellular 4 522    es 66  Phone  Hands Free  UConnect                  66  Placard  Tire and Loading Information         225  Power  Drake AC  211  Distribution Center  Fuses                 300  Door LOCKS serei scio phe d Oc dod cd apd owe 21  MO 53559929 3 84 ba S ee ee aoe E Id 64  Outlet  Auxiliary Electrical Outlet           124  wj  rr  85  vulg  A PC      213 284    Steering Checking qsxJaeug ees t PEE EE 284   ibis MT  121   Tilt Telescoping Steering Column           107   lij AMT   m 25  Pregnant Women and Seat Belts 2345454244445 37  Pretensioners   Beat DEUS gw ETE EIE a E 35  Programmable Electronic Features       117 120 153  Programming Transmitters   Remote Keyless Entry                19 117 120  Radial Ply Ties  ass asses ihtar BE WEE P3 232 
88. N                                                                 p    i  i Lu  EE EEREN i  HE PEPEES E WI  EER EdE EER  EIE VM  HE ER HR EE  ER EE EE SEES DIMBIISS  EES er reed HINIU  INELENINEIDNIEMINIEINIZ MIILILILII  ER EE DEE Ee EED  EE GESEDEER DERE DERE DE TEE  EE IDEE DEE DEE EF  7 RR ee ee WE Ee mM Pe Pe Pi Pi Pe Pe Pe Pe Pe BR Re ri LEA  MINIS PEE BILE SIS  SE EER EER DORRE Sad de TESE GE ESE EEE EER EER SERE DESIRE   M  3    Eer eer sut  EET GED EE GEE ED ee ed EE EE SUMI  BETREE EE Oe oe ee ee oo AE SIM  E IIIA DISSES   i iH  RED ni en MOOD EER z aa rac  i     SLLLN   SIRIUS SEE  ui  i   VOETE oe rede BEE IINGIZMMIZWMNZI Si  i   VEREER ETE EED A   e  ININZININ ui  i   DIUINO INIM ININZINIM Si     EE RE REDE ilr  i  ae  i  iind  I  Hint  Hn  Nim  ui  WI       Front Seat Cup Holders    Rear Seat Cup Holders   The rear seat cup holders are located in the center armrest  between the rear seats  The cup holders are positioned  forward in the armrest and side by side to provide  convenient access to beverage cans or bottles while  maintaining a resting place for the rear occupants  el   bows     Se  p oor  sae ee  ee   Se   Sas   ens   as   as   Ss   Se RE Re   ee   MR RE RE   soos   Sue   ee   sae    ee    oe I  GEE EP PER ne eh errer   BEERE  EERTE  zoffTl   pr  Torr s  feet  EER  ere Ee  FERRE  Sees  peer   Settee  renee  Sate  zefIs2s   Tee   Toss Is   kid    wee DOL    TL  PEPE  TN  LE eee erence rene    B12cb856    iei eom  mS       Rear Seat Cup Holders    N UNDE
89. N position     NOTE  Broken  muddy  or obstructed headlights and  taillights of vehicles in the field of view will cause  headlights to remain on longer  closer to the vehicle    Also  dirt  film  and other obstructions on the windshield  or camera lens will cause the system to function improp   erly     Headlight Time Delay   This feature provides the safety of headlight illumination  for 90 seconds  programmable  when leaving your ve   hicle in an unlighted area     To activate the delay feature  turn off the ignition switch  while the headlights are still on  Then  turn off the  headlights within 45 seconds  The delay interval begins  when headlight switch is turned off     If you turn the headlights  park lights  or ignition switch  on again  the system will cancel the delay     If you turn the headlights off before the ignition  they will  turn off in the normal manner     NOTE  The lights must be turned off within 45 seconds  of turning the ignition off to activate this feature    The Headlight delay time is programmable  For details   refer to  Delay Turning Headlights Off     under  Personal  Settings  Customer Programmable Features   under   Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in Sec   tion 4 of this manual        98 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  xe    Daytime Running Lights  Canada Only    The high beam headlights will come on as Daytime  Running Lights  whenever the ignition switch is on  the  headlights are off  and the parking brake is off
90. OCIO CI ce ek ER RE Ee Ar RE EE m ate Serer RE  watts   zero    1          ae    Door Lock Plunger  If the door lock plunger is down when you shut the door   the door will lock  Therefore  make sure the keys are not    inside the vehicle before closing the door         WARNING     e For personal security and safety in the event of an  accident  lock the vehicle doors as you drive as  well as when you park and leave the vehicle     When leaving the vehicle always remove the key  from the ignition lock  and lock your vehicle   Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may  cause severe personal injuries and death     Never leave children alone in a vehicle  Leaving  children in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for  a number of reasons  A child or others could be  seriously or fatally injured  Don   t leave the keys  in the ignition  A child could operate power  windows  other controls  or move the vehicle        Power Door Locks  A power door lock switch is on each front door trim  panel  Use this switch to lock or unlock the doors     22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M       Power Door Lock Switch    If you press the power door lock switch while the key is  in the ignition  and any front door is open  the power  locks will not operate  This prevents you from acciden   tally locking your keys in the vehicle  Removing the key  or closing the door will allow the locks to operate  A  chime will sound if the key is in the LOCK or ACC  position and a door is open  as a re
91. Operation is subject to the  following conditions     e This device may not cause harmful interference     e This device must accept any interference received   including interference that may cause undesired op   eration        246 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    The tire pressure sensors are covered under one of the  following licenses     United States    6 vans ere ENS KR55S120123  Canada AE AR ARE AAS OK 2671 S120123  FUEL REQUIREMENTS   6 1L Engine    The 6 1L engine is designed to meet all  emissions regulations and provide excel   lent fuel economy and performance when  using high quality premium unleaded   00dfat   gasoline with an octane rating of 91 or  higher        Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to  your engine  However  continued heavy spark knock at  high speeds can cause damage and immediate service is  required     Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard  starting  stalling  and hesitations  If you experience these  symptoms  try another brand of  premium  gasoline  before considering service for the vehicle     Over 40 automobile manufacturers around the world  have issued and endorsed consistent gasoline specifica   tions  the World Wide Fuel Charter  WWFC  which  define fuel properties necessary to deliver enhanced  emissions  engine performance  and durability for your  vehicle  The manufacturer recommends the use of gaso   lines that meet the WWFC specifications if they are  available     Reformulated Gasoline  Many 
92. REA RSS 140  minated POU 2029 ede acea we Rp qrie tens 17  Instrument Cluster 1 5    22 5 vs 95 136   sies vie    au sor 4t  e Ed xu REGE REA 100 115  8 aci PDC  912  Lights On Reminde    x 35 2292 3 ae ER RR Eer 98  ss Ao RR TEE OE EE ET d 136  LOW Tie gn sok Es enue Ee AR RE HORE 141  Malfunction Indicator  Check Engine         143  OIl Pregs  te  Cm 143  Fase peake EER IR AE ET EE 99  IKE li ORR ED E PU XE S PER ES 115  beat Belt Reminder 4nd aed e PER oed 140  vij POET 307  Service Engine Soon    Malfunction Indicator                     143       SmartBeams ee 446465240845 684604584 96    Tire Pressure Monitoring  TPMS          141 239  TraChOM Cono ou pce ae ee oa ED ore 219  TUE SISAL vss guetta eee ad eet 98 136  NODI EGOLI an va gee eee doe oo doe aes 65  p hoo  m 142  Warning  Instrument Cluster Description      136  Load Leveling System x uoa gei 9a d ere 3 os 129  Loading Velde oorde RR dedos d tasn 252 258  Epiese PURO AR EE ENS ae 253  TMCS  eE OE TE EE Ed 225  LOCKS 2999s Dor denar a E UIN RR S ACER 21  Ato Unlock iis ER RED RES Bind P E HG 23  Child Eroieelio    S244 si RR VREDE PRO toa ae 23  WOOP RE EE AS EER EE EE EEN SE EF 21  Power DOO ss kata AE VEERA OT DA ED BEE 21  Low Due Pressure System 34  ase ERR Mes BR 239    Lower Anchors and Tether for  CHildren  LATCH   Lubrication  Body    Dumbar Pe 2545 2 9 9 hA S REED ERU E ANS  Maintenance Pree  Battery si  sie vu ke RR ES 281  Maintenance Procedures                    275       354 INDEX M    Maintenance 
93. RSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 127    STORAGE    Console Features   The center console contains a large storage bin  The  storage bin contains a four slot coin holder  designed to  hold various size coins  and a rubber mat at the bottom of  the bin for noise control  The bin is large enough to hold  a portable AC DC converter to power laptops  games  or  other electrical equipment  Two slots at the top right side  of the bin provide clearance for power cords to pass  conveniently out of the bin with the lid closed  This  feature is ideal for games  laptops  cell phones  or other  electrical equipment  The console s front opening lid  allows for easy access to the storage bin for the both the  driver and the front passenger  The inside portion of the  arm rest lid contains a penholder  a tissue holder  and a  tire gauge holder     In addition to the internal storage  the console contains  two shift bezel cubby bins with rubber mats for holding  small items  For vehicles not equipped with navigation  radio  the console also contains an extra storage bin  located below the climate control  which holds up to four  CD jewel cases     Cargo Area   The 60 40 split folding rear seat provides cargo carrying  versatility  The seatbacks fold down easily by pulling  nylon tabs between the seatbacks and the bolsters  When  the seats are folded down  they provide a continuous   nearly flat extension of the load floor     When the seatback is folded to the upright position  make  su
94. STARTING AND OPERATING 227    manual to determine how this reduces the available  cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle     NOTE  The following table shows examples on how to  calculate total load  cargo luggage  and towing capaci   ties of your vehicle with varying seating configurations  and number and size of occupants  This table is for    illustration purposes only and may not be accurate for  the seating and load carry capacity of your vehicle     NOTE  For the following example  the combined  weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed 865  Ibs   392 Kg         228 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    _ Occupants          Combined weight of AVAILABLE    occupants and cargo Combined Occupant s Cargo Luggage and  from Tire Placard weight Trailer Tongue   Occupant 1  200 Ibs Weight   LJ E   EXAMPLE 1 Occupant 2   30 ibaa    Occupant 4  HD tbs  git i    865 lbs s am 1  a   NERA C mM  EXAMPLE 2   3 3 dem    TOTAL WEIGHT  540 Ibs    ML N zs pom    Occupant 1  210 Ibs    Rum ONS   E Oecupant 2  t 50 fos  i   E u a   E    540 Ibs 320 Ibs  EXAMPLE 3  Occupant 1  200 Ibs    Occupant e  200 Ibs  TOTAL WEIGHT  A00 les    869 lbs 400 Ibs 465 Ibs       811a4d11    ee STARTING AND OPERATING 229    WARNING  1  Safety     WARNING     e Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can  cause accidents     Overloading of your tires is dangerous  Overloading  can cause tire failure  affect vehicle handling  and    increase your stopping distance  Use tires of the  recommended l
95. Schedule 244246544 3s memes 318  Sehedale A    baud died xd Io EROS s es 331  chede B  20i sd rat S P ors EE Rr 921   Malfunction Indicator Light    Check Engine  soe ke ASA OE V 143 273   Manual  Service 422a oae s 341   Memory Feature  Memory Seat                90   Memoty DEAE CX 90   Memory Seats and Radio      ess dm 90   lelie EEE EE EET 247   Mini  Tup Computer   6  vor ae 646 revistas 147   NOTOS MC  a ae din 9 BEE 63  AULOMANG DINE de 2e949 990b d pi RARR 63  Electric IOBIOES ai dass Rr MRK c ded RE 64  Exterior FORIO 4 5 x sant Ee SE TER ED GED oN 64  Pleated  PT  65  aco RE EE EE OE EE 63  bon ZA Pr  TED OE ES IT 65   Modifications  Alterations  Vehicle              7   Monitor  Tire Pressure System               299   Mopar OMS Eie rts Oe oo 4 Ga ee EE 274 340   MIEE EIDE  52530 2E 899 n 299 RH IOS S e 247    Multi Function Control Lever                 98    Navigation Radio ss dde x e oe ond eee oa A 170  INGVISaU OD SIS vas en mut sc a d d Ret Rd 170  New Vehicle Break In Period             LLL 55  Occupant Beslis  viu sop sco De 0 9 ER RE RR 30  Octane Rating  Gasoline  Fuel                246  eren  REED EE PET OE EIE 140  Tp  rr  140  Oil ELE 922 9 Re we ERIS ADRES NOR 275 314  dorus v            DS 313  Change lied  oa ame S HOE HE 276  ellus APP  275  IIS NP 275  Disposal segra ees RR dn HERE RR HELE ees 278  Inl A rrr 278 314  Filter Disposal  1454 33 Das RR AD 278  Materials Added l   ss sa po aree et pesa 24  Recommendation                    277 313  
96. See www chrysler com uconnect  for supported phones     To complete the pairing process  you will need to refer   ence your cellular phone owner   s manual  One of the  following vehicle specific websites may also provide  detailed instructions for pairing with the brand of phone  that you have     NOTE   e www chrysler com uconnect    e www dodge com uconnect    NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 69    www jeep com uconnect    The following are general phone to UConnect    System  pairing instructions     Press the    Phone    button to begin     After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Setup Phone Pairing  and follow the audible prompts     When prompted  after the voice on beep  say  Pair a  Phone  and follow the audible prompts     You will be asked to say a four digit pin number   which you will later need to enter into your cellular   You can enter any four digit pin number  You will not  need to remember this pin number after the initial  pairing process     For identification purposes  you will be prompted to  give the UConnect    system a name for your cellular  phone  Each cellular phone that is paired should be  given a unique phone name     You will then be asked to give your cellular phone a  priority level between 1 and 7  1 being the highest  priority  You can pair up to seven cellular phones to    your UConnect    system  However  at any given time   only one cellular phone can be in use  connected to  your UConnect    System  The prio
97. Selecting  the OFF position on the fan control stops the system  completely and closes the outside air intake     72  F  22  C  is the recommended setting for maximum  comfort for the average person  however  this may vary     NOTE  The temperature setting can be adjusted at any  time without affecting automatic operation   Air conditioning in this system is automatic   Pressing the Air Conditioning Control button  while in AUTO mode will cause the LED in the  control button to flash three times and then turn off   This indicates that the system is in AUTO mode and  requesting the air conditioning is not necessary     N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 185    The system will automatically control recir   culation  However  pressing the Recircula   tion Control button will temporarily put the  system in recirculation mode  ten minutes    This can be used when outside conditions such as  smoke  odors  dust  or high humidity are present   Activating recirculation will cause the LED in the  control button to illuminate  After ten minutes  the  system will return to normal AUTO mode function  and the LED will turn off     NOTE    e The surface of the climate control panel and the top  center of the instrument panel should be kept free of  debris due to the location of the climate control  sensors  Mud on the windshield may also cause poor  operation of this system     CER    e Extended use of recirculation may cause the windows  to fog  If the interior of the windows begins to 
98. Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions    1  Enter the vehicle and close the door  Sit back and    It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area  adjust the front seat   inside or outside of a vehicle  In a collision  people    riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously 2  The seat belt latch plate is above the back of your seat   injured or killed  Grasp the latch plate and pull out the belt  Slide the latch    Do not allow people to ride in any area of your plate up the webbing as far as necessary to make the belt  vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts  go found your lap     MM o a aaa Tu UM MM M  EER N PEE GE PE EE  i EE    ER    e Rast  Mee e EE ET EE MUR I  EER EE EE WE EED ser ESTA rrr EE    Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and  using a seat belt properly     EE cae REEN ee EE  EE EE ME HE    EH    Wearing a seat belt incorrectly is dangerous  Seat  belts are designed to go around the large bones of    your body  These are the strongest parts of your body  and can take the forces of a collision the best     Wearing your belt in the wrong place could make  your injuries in a collision much worse  You might  suffer internal injuries  or you could even slide out  of part of the belt  Follow these instructions to wear  your seat belt safely and to keep your passengers  safe  too     EE ad pu z   PH EM       liiiifiiir re LEX   MEE ee xus i lii    Two people should never be belted into a single seat NA  belt  People belted together 
99. THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    Add Names to Your UConnect    Phonebook    NOTE  Adding names to phonebook is recommended  when vehicle is not in motion     Press the  Phone  button to begin     After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Phonebook New Entry      When prompted  say the name of the new entry  Use of  long names helps the voice recognition and is recom   mended  For example  say  Robert Smith  or  Robert   instead of  Bob      When prompted  enter the number designation  e g     Home    Work    Mobile   or  Pager    This will allow  you to store multiple numbers for each phonebook  entry  if desired     When prompted  recite the phone number for the  phonebook entry that you are adding     After you are finished adding an entry into the phone   book  you will be given the opportunity to add more  phone numbers to the current entry or to return to the  main menu     NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 71    The UConnect    system will allow you to enter up to 32  names in the phonebook with each name having up to  four associated phone numbers and designations  Each  language has a separate 32 name phonebook accessible  only in that language     Edit Entries in the UConnect    Phonebook    NOTE  Editing phonebook entries is recommended  when vehicle is not in motion     e Press the    Phone    button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Phonebook Edit      e You will then be asked
100. TPMS when a system fault is detected  The flash cycle will  will not monitor the pressure in the compact spare tire    repeat every ten minutes  without an audible chime  until  However  if you install the compact spare tire in place the fault condition no longer exists  In addition to the  telltale and chime  the Electronic Vehicle Information    ee STARTING AND OPERATING 245    Center  EVIC  will display a  CHECK TPM SYSTEM   message for 3 seconds when a system fault is detected  In  the event that a fault occurs because the system did not  receive a pressure value from one or more Tire Pressure  Monitoring Sensors  the EVIC will display the  CHECK  TPM SYSTEM  message and then display dashes       in  place of the pressure value to indicate which sensor is not  being received        81979401    NOTE  You can change the pressure units to display in  PSI  KPA  or BAR  Refer to  Language   under  Personal  Settings  Customer Programmable Features   under   Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in Sec   tion 4 of this manual for details     If the ignition Key is cycled  this sequence will repeat   providing the system fault still exists  If the system fault  no longer exists  the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale  Light will no longer flash  and the  CHECK TPM SYS   TEM  message will no longer display  and a pressure  value will display in place of the dashes     General Information   This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and  RSS 210 of Industry Canada  
101. The transmission will not automatically shift up when  maximum engine speed is reached while Autostick  is  engaged     Transmission shifting will be more noticeable when  Autostick  is engaged     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 209    DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES    Acceleration   Rapid acceleration on snow covered  wet  or other slip   pery surfaces may cause the rear wheels to pull errati   cally to the right or left  This phenomenon occurs when  there is a difference in the surface traction under the rear   driving  wheels     WARNING     Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces is danger   ous  Unequal traction can cause sudden pulling of    the rear wheels  You could lose control of the vehicle  and possibly have an accident  Accelerate slowly and  carefully whenever there is likely to be poor traction   ice  snow  wet mud  loose sand  etc          Traction   When driving on wet or slushy roads  it is possible for a  wedge of water to build up between the tire and road  surface  This is known as hydroplaning and may cause  partial or complete loss of vehicle control and stopping  ability  To reduce this possibility  the following precau   tions should be observed     1  Slow down during rainstorms or when the roads are  slushy     2  Slow down if road has standing water or puddles     3  Replace tires when tread wear indicators first become  visible     4  Keep tires properly inflated     5  Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle and  the vehicle in front to avoid 
102. To assist customers who have hearing difficulties  the  manufacturer has installed special TDD  Telecommuni   cation Devices for the Deaf  equipment at its Customer  Center  Any hearing or speech impaired customer who  has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter   TTY  in the United States can communicate with the  manufacturer by dialing 1 800 380  CHRY        340 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE NN Id    Service Contract   You may have purchased a service contract for your  vehicle to help protect you from the high cost of unex   pected repairs after your manufacturer s new vehicle  limited warranty expires  The manufacturer stands be   hind only the manufacturer s Service Contracts  If you  purchased a manufacturer s Service Contract  you will  receive Plan Provisions and an Owner Identification Card  in the mail within three weeks of your vehicle delivery  date  If you have any questions about your service  contract  call the manufacturer s Service Contract Na   tional Customer Hotline at 1 800 521 9922     The manufacturer will not stand behind any service  contract that is not the manufacturer s Service Contract  It  is not responsible for any service contract other than the  manufacturer s Service Contract  If you purchased a  service contract that is not a manufacturer s Service  Contract  and you require service after your manufactur   er s new vehicle limited warranty expires  please refer to  your contract documents  and contact the person listed in  those 
103. UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 161    AM FM Button  Radio Mode   Press the button to select AM or FM Modes     Setting the Tone  Balance  and Fade   Press the rotary TUNE control and BASS will display   Turn the TUNE control to the right or left to increase or  decrease the Bass tones     Press the rotary TUNE control a second time and MID  will display  Turn the TUNE control to the right or left to  increase or decrease the Mid Range tones     Press the rotary TUNE control a third time and TREBLE  will display  Turn the TUNE control to the right or left to  increase or decrease the Treble tones     Press the rotary TUNE control a fourth time and BAL will  display  Turn the TUNE control to the right or left to  adjust the sound level from the right or left side speakers     Press the rotary TUNE control a fifth time and FADE will  display  Turn the TUNE control to the right or left to  adjust the sound level between the front and rear speak   ers        Press the rotary TUNE control again to exit setting tone   balance  and fade     RND PTY Button  Radio Mode    Pressing this button once will turn on the PTY mode for  5 seconds  If no action is taken during the 5 second time  out  the PTY icon will turn off  Turning the tune knob  within 5 seconds will allow the program format type to  be selected  Many radio stations do not currently broad   cast PTY information     Turn the tune knob to select the following format types     Program Type 16 Digit Character Dis     play 
104. Vehicles Only     340 ELI GEORGIE sor schebd s 61d 10 raare    M Mopar  iuc PPP 340 O Temperature Grades       338 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE C    SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR  YOUR VEHICLE    Prepare For The Appointment   If you re having warranty work done  be sure to have the  right papers with you  Take your warranty folder  All  work to be performed may not be covered by the  warranty  discuss additional charges with the service  manager  Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle s  service history  This can often provide a clue to the  current problem     Prepare A List   Make a written list of your vehicle s problems or the  specific work you want done  If you ve had an accident   or work done that is not on your maintenance log  let the  service advisor know     Be Reasonable With Requests   If you list a number of items  and you must have your  vehicle by the end of the day  discuss the situation with  the service advisor and list the items in order of priority   At many dealers you may obtain a rental vehicle at a    minimal daily charge  If you need a rental  it is advisable  to make these arrangements when you call for an ap   pointment     IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE   The manufacturer and its dealers are vitally interested in  your satisfaction  We want you to be happy with our  products and services     Warranty service must be done by an authorized  Chrysler  Dodge  or Jeep dealer  We strongly recommend  that you take your vehicle to your selling dealer 
105. When the  pedal is released  the vehicle will return to the set speed     NOTE  The speed control system maintains speed up  and down hills  A slight speed change on moderate hills  is normal     Four speed automatic transmissions will experience a  downshift to 3rd gear while climbing uphill or descend   ing downhill  This downshift to 3rd gear is necessary to  maintain vehicle set speed     On steep hills  a greater speed loss or gain may occur so  it may be preferable to drive without speed control     WARNING     Speed Control can be dangerous where the system  can   t maintain a constant speed  Your vehicle could    go too fast for the conditions  and you could lose  control  An accident could be the result  Don   t use    Speed Control in heavy traffic or on roads that are  winding  icy  snow covered  or slippery           112 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE Se    REAR PARK ASSIST SYSTEM   The Rear Park Assist System is a driver aid that senses for  obstacles behind the vehicle  Refer to the Warnings   Cautions  and Notes in this section for system limitations  and usage recommendations     The Rear Park Assist System is active when the driver  shifts the transmission into the R  Reverse  position  and  the parking brake is not applied  and the vehicle speed is  less than 10 mph  16 km h      The system can be turned on or off when the vehicle is in  PARK through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center   EVIC   For details  refer to  Personal Settings  Cust
106. a chime will still sound  each ignition key cycle  Once you repair or replace the  original road tire  and reinstall it on the vehicle in place of  the compact spare  the TPMS will update automatically  and the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will turn  OFF  as long no tire pressure is below the low pressure  warning limit in any of the four active road tires  The    vehicle may need to be driven for up to 10 minutes above  15 mph  25 km h  in order for the TPMS to receive this  information     Check TPMS Warning   The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will flash on  and off for 60 seconds and an audible chime will sound  when a system fault is detected  The flash cycle will  repeat every ten minutes  without an audible chime  until  the fault condition no longer exists  If the ignition key is  cycled  this sequence will repeat  providing the system  fault still exists     Premium System     If Equipped   The Tire Pressure Monitor System  TPMS  uses wireless  technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to  monitor tire pressure levels  Sensors  mounted to each  wheel as part of the valve stem  transmit tire pressure  readings to the Receiver Module     NOTE  It is particularly important for you to check the  tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle regularly  and to maintain the proper pressure     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 243    The TPMS consists of the following components   e Receiver Module  e 4 Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors    e 3 Trig
107. a collision in a sudden stop        210 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE    PARKING BRAKE  The parking brake should always be applied when the  driver is not in the vehicle     WARNING     Never use Park position on an automatic transmis   sion as a substitute for the parking brake  Always    apply parking brake fully when parked to guard  against vehicle movement and possible injury or  damage     When parking on a flat surface  place the gear selector in  the P  Park  position first  and then apply the parking  brake     When parking on a hill  it is important to apply the  parking brake before placing the gear selector in P  Park    otherwise the load on the transmission locking mecha   nism may make it difficult to move the selector out of  park  As an added precaution  turn the front wheels  toward the curb on a downhill grade and away from the  curb on an uphill grade        The foot operated parking brake is positioned below the  lower left corner of the instrument panel  To apply the  parking brake  push the parking brake pedal down and  then remove your foot from the pedal  To release the  parking brake  push down on the parking brake pedal  and then    eR p GE GE EE ge GE at DOM Se hi Staaten tana GE GE DEER SESDE EE mass pr i i    Parking Brake  The brake light in the instrument cluster will turn on  when the parking brake is applied and the ignition  switch is on     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 211    NOTE  This light only shows that the parking brake is BRAKE SYSTEM  app
108. ack in the trunk of the vehicle   Replace the sealant bottle at your nearest authorized  MOPARS parts dealership     30  Have the tire inspected at the earliest opportunity at  an authorized dealer or tire service center     NOTE    e If a pressure of at least 19 psi  1 3 bar  cannot be  maintained in the tire  the tire is too badly damaged   Do not attempt to drive the vehicle further  Call for  assistance        262 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES M    e Do not operate the electric air pump for more than JUMP STARTING PROCEDURES  eight minutes to avoid overheating  The air pump may    be used again once it has cooled down  WARNING     e Replace the TIREFIT sealant bottle  5  once every four    i Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever the  years to assure optimum operation of the system     hood is raised  It can start anytime the ignition switch is on   SE l You can be hurt by the fan   e  f TIREFIT is liquid  clean water and a damp cloth will d    f i Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it started   remove the material from the vehicle or tire and wheel Vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission cannot  components  Once TIREFIT sealing material has dried  be started this way  Unburned fuel could enter the catalytic          converter and once the engine has started  ignite and  it can easily be peeled off and properly discarded  damage the converter and vehicle  If the vehicle has a        discharged battery  booster cables may be used to obtain
109. adlight washers  when the ignition switch is in the ON position and the  headlights are ON  The multi function lever is located on  the left side of the steering column        To use the headlight washers  push the multi function  lever inward  toward the steering column  to the second  detent and release it  The headlight washers will spray a  timed high pressure spray of washer fluid onto each  headlight lens  In addition  the windshield washers will  spray the windshield and the windshield wipers will  cycle     B18c3c1b       Headlight Washer    NOTE  The headlight washers will operate on the first  spray of the windshield washer and then every fourth  spray after that     106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN  Adding Washer Fluid    WARNING   The headlight washer and windshield washer share the    same fluid reservoir  The reservoir is located in the front Commercially available windshield washer solvents  of the engine compartment on the passenger side of the are flammable  They could ignite and burn you  Care  vehicle  Be sure to check the fluid level in the reservoir at must be exercised when filling or working around  regular intervals  Fill the reservoir with windshield the washer solution        washer solvent  not radiator antifreeze  and operate the  system for a few seconds to flush out the residual water   mus un n       Washer Fluid Reservoir    N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107    POWER TILT TELESCOPING STEERIN
110. ain on your    Tire Spinning  When stuck in mud  sand  snow  or ice conditions  do not  spin your vehicle s wheels above 35 mph  55 km h      tires could cause them to fail  You could have a  serious accident  Don t drive a vehicle loaded to the  maximum capacity at continuous speeds above 75  mph  120 km h   Refer to the paragraph on  Freeing A Stuck Vehicle  in  Section 6 of this manual     Radial Ply Tires  WARNING   WARNING     Combining radial ply tires with other types of tires  on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle       Fast spinning tires can be dangerous  Forces gener   ated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire dam   age or failure  A tire could explode and injure    someone  Do not spin your vehicle   s wheels faster  than 30 mph  48 km h  for more than 30 seconds  continuously when you are stuck  and don   t let  anyone near a spinning wheel  no matter what the  speed     poorly  The instability could cause an accident  Al   ways use radial ply tires in sets of four  or 6  in case  of trucks with dual rear wheels   Never combine  them with other types of tires        ee STARTING AND OPERATING 233    Tread Wear Indicators Life of Tire   Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying  to help you in determining when your tires should be factors including but not limited to    replaced     e Driving style        e Tire pressure    e Distance driven    WARNING     Tires and spare tire shou
111. allow it to retract completely to disengage the automatic  locking mode and activate the vehicle sensitive  emer   gency  locking mode     Seat Belts and Pregnant Women   We recommend that pregnant women use the seat belts  throughout their pregnancy  Keeping the mother safe is  the best way to keep the baby safe     Pregnant women should wear the lap part of the belt  across the thighs and as snug across the hips as possible   Keep the belt low so that it does not come across the  abdomen  That way the strong bones of the hips will take  the force if there is a collision     Seat Belt Extender   If a seat belt is too short  even when fully extended  and  when the adjustable upper shoulder belt anchorage  if so  equipped  is in its lowest position  your dealer can  provide you with a seat belt extender  This extender  should be used only if the existing belt is not long  enough  When it is not required  remove the extender   and store it     WARNINCG     Using a seat belt extender when not needed can  increase the risk of injury in a collision  Only use    when the seat belt is not long enough when it is  worn low and snug  and in the recommended seating  positions  Remove and store the extender when not  needed        38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    Driver and Front Passenger Supplemental  Restraint System  SRS    Airbag   This vehicle has front airbags for both the driver and  front passenger as a supplement to the seat belt restraint  systems  The drive
112. ally  after 30 minutes     NOTE  Once a heat setting is selected  heat will be felt  within two to five minutes     WARNING     Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin  because of advanced age  chronic illness  diabetes   spinal cord injury  medication  alcohol use  exhaus   tion or other physical condition must exercise care    when using the seat heater  It may cause burns even  at low temperatures  especially if used for long  periods     Do not place anything on the seat that insulates  against heat  such as a blanket or cushion  This may  cause the seat heater to overheat        N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 89    Folding Rear Seat WARNING     x    pr        Be certain that the seatback is securely locked into  position  If the seatback in not securely locked  into position the seat will not provide the proper  stability for child seats and or passengers  An  improperly latched seat could cause serious in   jury    The cargo area in the rear of the vehicle  with the  rear seatbacks in the locked up or folded down  position  should not be used as a play area by  children when the vehicle is in motion  They  un could be seriously injured in an accident  Chil     Folding Rear Seat dren should be seated and using the proper re   The rear seatbacks can be folded forward to provide an straint system     additional storage area  Pull on the loops shown in the  illustration to fold down either or both seatbacks  These  loops can be tucked away when not in 
113. am Light  sp This light will turn on when the high beam          headlights are ON  Push the Multi Function       lever away from the steering wheel to switch the  headlights to high beam   See page 98 for more  information      17  Transmission Range Indicator  This display indicator shows the automatic transmission  gear selection     18  Seat Belt Reminder Light   This light will turn on for 5 to 8 seconds as a   bulb check when the ignition switch is first   turned ON  A chime will sound if the driver s  seat belt is unbuckled during the bulb check  The Seat  Belt Warning Light will flash or remain on continu   ously if the driver s seat belt remains unbuckled after  the bulb check or when driving   See page 35 for more  information      19  Vehicle Security Alarm  VSA  Indicator Light      If Equipped   The VSA indicator Light flashes rapidly when the VSA is  arming  and slowly when the VSA is armed   See page 15  for more information         20  Fuel Gauge  The pointer shows the level of fuel in the fuel tank when  the ignition switch is in the ON position     21  Electronic Throttle Control  ETC  Light  This light will turn on briefly as a bulb check  ly   when the ignition switch is turned ON  This  light will also turn on while the engine is    running if there is a problem with the Elec   tronic Throttle Control system     If the light comes on while the engine is running  safely  bring the vehicle to a complete stop as soon as possible   place the gear selector in 
114. an  Aulo  Set blower knob ta  either Bi er Lo Auto  Set    lemperature knobs for comfort     Nel Hower knob 10 ans  desired airtley Jove  ether  than Hi or Jas Autos Set mede  knob to any desired air  delivers poani other than  Aute  Set temperature knobs  Far gomfur     Blinver Contrul     um mulie    Loser selectable  Io ume speed     ALupmalttc    Loser selectable   o unmy speed     Mode Control    AVL    Automatic    User selectable  lo ny air  delivery point     User selectable  lo dny air  delivery point        The system will       Air Temperature   Air Recirculation  Cunt ril Control AMC Operation    ANIL Augue bul van AA UELMT ad IG  he overridden  lor 169 minutes  dia ume     Aumale but can Aurmatic  be overridden  Tor 10 minutes    UL up MITE     A UNIE ie     ser selectable    AC on or ed     liser selee tahle  GUST  or  rev ulateu     Automatic    Loser selectable  AJ on or edt     liser selectahle  outside or  reca ule     A ui MIELIE       81341de7       The operator can override the AUTO mode setting to  change airflow distribution by rotating the Mode Control  knob  on the right  to one of the following positions     e Defrost   Q7 Air is directed to the windshield through the  outlets at the base of the windshield  Air is   also directed to the front door windows through the   side window demister grilles     e DefrostlFloor  TY Air flows through the front and rear floor  x outlets and the outlets at the base of the  windshield  Air is also directed to the f
115. ar os ox 14  Key Replacement 3432s  0A RUE E Rd RARE 13  Key  Sentry  Immobilizer  24  xe deut s 12  ke ln denne  3 o2 d ee FORCE ARE CREAR 12  Keyless Entry Systemi isca aaide 17  ET AO EE EO EER NE ee ee eee 11  Id eic C  D         38  Lane Change and Turn Signals 4 2 e ree 98    Lap Shoulder Belts 2230939 othe aaaea 30   LATCH    Lower Anchors and Tether for CHildren      50 52   Late Pale  ados Gee eee IE qo aR 31   lE Pr STE EK IE OE EIE SIEK 58  HOOL                     3   Lead Free GasolNE ds as tie   dor dias AD DS ars 246   Lie Ob ies ACE 299   eru DR EO OR EE ET AE N 58 95  POO  ou douaue udo Seo BERDE 43 46 58 137  wi bod 44264046452 Qm 157213  Automatic Headliglits     22 sitini itii 95  Drake Assist Warning sis pace yams doe 219  Drake Wafni  g 2 458455 ah toe degrees 138 211  Bulb Replacement   ue oe Eg d door t 307  Courtesy Reading  asses 92493 29 115  C 155753 3 30258 509 9 EE UR ER 136  Day tiie Running ues oe os REESE ERES 98  Dimmer Switch  Headlight 22 4  Mid s  28 99  Electronic Stability Program    ESP  Indicator n  uu ox oe be DRR HR ERA DEL 84 219  Electronic Throttle Control Warning         141  Engine Temperature Warning iss sad nun 157    N INDEX 353    LOS asse See AD RE RED d ES 98 136  Hazard Warning Flasher    uid odere ros 256  Headlight Switch 42224 59   De Eod ir os 95  Heade DI   nu ah Ve Mk e ded NUR RE SOR ee 95 307  Headlights On With Wipers             96 102  Hea Deal    obec EER oop age pees ER 99 140  Higa Beam   Indicator sae n EE 
116. areas of the country require the use of cleaner  burning gasoline referred to as  Reformulated Gasoline      Reformulated gasolines contain oxygenates  and are spe   cifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and im   prove air quality     The manufacturer supports the use of reformulated gaso   lines  Properly blended reformulated gasolines will pro   vide excellent performance and durability of engine and  fuel system components     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 247    Gasoline Oxygenate Blends   Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxy   genates such as 10  ethanol  MTBE  and ETBE  Oxygen   ates are required in some areas of the country during the  winter months to reduce carbon monoxide emissions   Fuels blended with these oxygenates may be used in  your vehicle     CAUTION     DO NOT use gasolines containing Methanol or E85    Ethanol  Use of these blends may result in starting  and driveability problems and may damage critical  fuel system components        Problems that result from using methanol gasoline or  E85 Ethanol blends are not the responsibility of the  manufacturer  While MTBE is an oxygenate made from  Methanol  it does not have the negative effects of Metha   nol     MMT In Gasoline   MMT is a manganese containing metallic additive that is  blended into some gasoline to increase the octane num   ber  Gasolines blended with MMT offer no performance  advantage beyond gasolines of the same octane number  without MMT  Gasolines blended with MMT have 
117. as for broken   damaged  deteriorated  or mispositioned parts  Open  seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes  to seep into the passenger compartment  In addition   inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised  for lubrication or oil change  Replace as required     WARNING     e Exhaust gases can injure or kill  They contain  carbon monoxide  CO  which is colorless and  odorless  Breathing it can make you unconscious  and can eventually poison you  To avoid breath     ing  CO  follow the safety tips below     If you are required to drive with the trunk open   make sure that all windows are closed  and the  climate control blower switch is set at high speed   DO NOT use the recirculation mode        Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The  Vehicle    Seat Belts   Inspect the belt system periodically  checking for cuts   frays  and loose parts  Damaged parts must be replaced  immediately  Do not disassemble or modify the system     58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a  collision  Rear seat belt assemblies must be replaced after  a collision if they have been damaged  bent retractor  torn  webbing  etc  If there is any question regarding belt or  retractor condition  replace the belt     Airbag Warning Light   The light should come on and remain on for 6 to 8  seconds as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first  turned ON  If the light is not lit during starting  see you  authori
118. ator Light in the in   strument cluster may turn on if the gas cap is not  secured properly  Make sure that the gas cap is tight   ened each time the vehicle is refueled     e When the fuel nozzle    clicks    or shuts off  the fuel  tank is full        Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message   If the vehicle diagnostic system determines that the fuel  filler cap is loose  improperly installed  or damaged  a     Check Gascap    message will display in the Electronic  Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   If this occurs  tighten  the fuel filler cap properly and press the odometer reset  button to turn off the message  If the problem continues   the message will appear the next time the vehicle is  started     A loose  improperly installed  or damaged fuel filler cap  may also turn on the Malfunction Indicator Light  MIL    Refer to    Onboard Diagnostic System    in Section 7 of this  manual for more information        252 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE    VEHICLE LOADING   The load carrying capacity of your vehicle is shown on  the  Vehicle Certification Label  This information  should be used for passenger and luggage loading as  indicated     If the seatbacks are folded for carrying cargo  do not  exceed the specified GVWR and GAWR     Vehicle Certification Label  Your vehicle has a certification label attached to the rear  of the driver s door     The label contains the following information   e Name of manufacturer   e Month and year of manufacture   e Gross Vehicle Weight Rating  GVWR  
119. ay from direct sunlight  heat   and magnetic fields such as the radio speakers     4  Before inserting a tape  make sure that the label is  adhering flatly to the cassette        182 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    5  Aloose tape should be corrected before use  To rewind  a loose tape  insert the eraser end of a pencil into the tape  drive gear and twist the pencil in the required directions     Maintain your cassette tape player  The head and capstan  shaft in the cassette player can pick up dirt or tape  deposits each time a cassette is played  The result of  deposits on the capstan shaft may cause the tape to wrap  around and become lodged in the tape transport  The  other adverse condition is low or  muddy  sound from  one or both channels  as if the treble tone control were  turned all the way down  To prevent this  you should  periodically clean the head with a commercially available  WET cleaning cassette     As preventive maintenance  clean the head about every  30 hours of use  If you wait until the head becomes very  dirty  noticeably poor sound   it may not be possible to  remove all deposits with a simple WET cleaning cassette     CD DVD DISC MAINTENANCE  To keep the CD DVD discs in good condition  take the  following precautions     1  Handle the disc by its edge  avoid touching the  surface     2  If the disc is stained  clean the surface with a soft cloth   wiping from center to edge     3  Do not apply paper  paper CD labels  or tape to the  disc
120. benefits of Anti Lock  brakes  If the ABS light does not come on when the  Ignition switch is turned to the ON position  have the  bulb repaired as soon as possible     If both the Brake Warning Light and the ABS Light  remain on  the Anti Lock brakes  ABS  and Electronic    STARTING AND OPERATING 213    Brake Force Distribution  EBD  systems are not function   ing  Immediate repair to the ABS system is required     POWER STEERING   The standard power steering system will give you good  vehicle response and increased ease of maneuverability  in tight spaces  The system will provide mechanical  steering capability if power assist is lost     If for some reason the power assist is interrupted  it will  still be possible to steer your vehicle  Under these condi   tions  you will observe a substantial increase in steering  effort  especially at very low vehicle speeds and during  parking maneuvers     NOTE  Increased noise levels at the end of the steering  wheel travel are considered normal and do not indicate  that there is a problem with the power steering system     Upon initial start up in cold weather  the power  steering pump may make noise for a short amount of  time  This is due to the cold  thick fluid in the steering  system  This noise should be considered normal  and  does not in any way damage the steering system        214 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    WARNING     Continued operation with reduced power steering    assist could pose a safety risk to yourself and 
121. can crash into one an      other in an accident  hurting one another badly  Bane oar EE ne  Never use a lap shoulder belt or a lap belt for more   than one person  no matter what their size        32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    3  When the belt is long enough to fit  insert the latch  plate into the buckle until you hear a  click    a me iow  VAM e A belt that is buckled into the wrong buckle will     AC NE not protect you properly  The lap portion could ride  too high on your body  possibly causing internal    injuries  Always buckle your belt into the buckle  nearest you        e A belt that is too loose will not protect you as well   In a sudden stop  you could move too far forward   increasing the possibility of injury  Wear your seat  belt snugly     EID    T       e A belt that is worn under your arm is very  dangerous  Your body could strike the inside sur   faces of the vehicle in a collision  increasing head  a c E and neck injury  A belt worn under the arm can cause  Connecting Latch Plate To Buckle internal injuries  Ribs aren t as strong as shoulder  bones  Wear the belt over your shoulder so that your  strongest bones will take the force in a collision        E    M   So    nu  aaa ua E zo Ts pop DUM GEM    n Ro P ME ur  re EEE  LICET    e A shoulder belt placed behind you will not protect  you from injury during a collision  You are more  likely to hit your head in a collision if you do not  wear your shoulder belt  The lap and shoulder belt
122. combinations of normal  CD audio tracks and computer files  including MP3 files    Discs created with an option such as  keep disc open after  writing    are most likely multisession discs  The use of  multisession for CD audio or MP3 playback may result in  longer disc loading times        Supported MP3 File Formats   The radio will recognize only files with the   mp3 exten   sion as MP3 files  Non MP3 files named with the   mp3  extension may cause playback problems  The radio is  designed to recognize the file as an invalid MP3 and will  not play the file     When using the MP3 encoder to compress audio data to ru  an MP3 file  the bit rate and sampling frequencies in the  following table are supported  In addition  variable bit   rates  VBR  are also supported  The majority of MP3 files   use a 44 1 kHz sampling rate and a 192  160  128  96 or   VBR bit rates     MPEG Specifi    Sampling Fre     quency lun   Be mie ps    320  256  224   192  160  128   112  96  80  64   56  48  40  32  160  128  144   112  96  80  64   56  48  40  32  24   16  8    MPEG 1 Audio  Layer 3    48  44 1  32    MPEG 2 Audio    Layer 3 24  22 05  16    168 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    ID3 Tag information for artist  song title  and album title  are supported for version 1 ID3 tags  ID3 version 2 is not  supported by the radios     Playlist files are not supported  MP3 Pro files are not  supported     Playback of MP3 and WMA Files   When a medium containing MP3 data is loaded  th
123. cracking  scuffing  or  worn spots  If there is any evidence of cracking   scuffing  or worn spots  the hose should be replaced  immediately  Eventual deterioration of the hose can Add enough fluid to bring the level up to the require   take place resulting in a possibility of a burst failure  ments described on the brake fluid reservoir  With disc    Overfilling of fluid is not recommended because it may  cause leaking in the system     294 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    brakes  fluid level can be expected to fall as the brake  pads wear  However  low fluid level may be caused by a  leak and a checkup may be needed     Use only manufacturer s recommended brake fluid  Re   fer to  Fluids  Lubricants  and Genuine Parts    for the  correct fluid type     WARNING     e Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in  spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and the  brake fluid catching fire     Use of a brake fluid that has a lower initial boiling  point than the recommended MOPAR  DOT 3  product or a brake fluid that is unidentified as to  FMVSS specification may result in sudden brake  failure during hard prolonged braking  You could  have an accident     Use only brake fluid that has been in a tightly closed  container to avoid contamination from foreign matter or  moisture        CAUTION     Do not allow petroleum base fluid to contaminate    the brake fluid  all brake seal components could be  damaged causing partial or complete brake failure        Automatic Transm
124. ctane enhancers  are not recommended  Most of these    products contain high concentrations of methanol   Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems  resulting from the use of such fuels or additives are not  the responsibility of the manufacturer     NOTE  Intentional tampering with emissions control  systems can result in civil penalties being assessed  against you     Carbon Monoxide Warnings    WARNING     Carbon monoxide  CO  in exhaust gases is deadly     Follow the precautions below to prevent carbon  monoxide poisoning        e Do not inhale exhaust gases  They contain carbon  monoxide  a colorless and odorless gas  which can kill   Never run the engine in a closed area  such as a  garage  and never sit in a parked vehicle with the  engine running for an extended period  If the vehicle is  stopped in an open area with the engine running for    ee STARTING AND OPERATING 249    more than a short period  adjust the ventilation system  to force fresh  outside air into the vehicle     e Guard against carbon monoxide with proper mainte   nance  Have the exhaust system inspected every time  the vehicle is raised  Have any abnormal conditions  repaired promptly  Until repaired  drive with all side  windows fully open     e Keep the trunk closed when driving your vehicle to  prevent carbon monoxide and other poisonous ex   haust gases from entering the vehicle        ADDING FUEL    Fuel Filler Cap  Gas Cap    The gas cap is located behind the fuel filler door on the  l
125. d  hold the PANIC button on the transmitter for at least one  second and release  When the panic alarm is on  the  headlights and park lights will flash  the horn will pulse  on and off  and the interior lights will turn on     The panic alarm will stay on for 3 minutes unless you  turn it off by either pressing the PANIC button a second  time or drive the vehicle at a speed of 15 mph  24 km h   or greater     NOTE    e The interior lights will turn off if you turn the ignition  switch to the ACC or ON position while the panic  alarm is activated  However  the exterior lights and  horn will remain on     e You may need to be less than 23 feet  7 meters  from  the vehicle when using the transmitter to turn off the  panic alarm due to the radio frequency noises emitted  by the system     Programming Additional Transmitters  Refer to SENTRY KEY  Customer Key Programming     See page 14 for more information      If you do not have a programmed transmitter  contact  your dealer for details     Battery Replacement  The recommended replacement battery is CR2032     NOTE  Do not touch the battery terminals that are on  the back housing or the printed circuit board     1  With the transmitter buttons facing downward  re   move the small screw  if equipped      2  Separate the two halves of the transmitter with a flat  blade tool  Do not damage the rubber seal during re   moval        20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M       g1i  2cT2    Separating Transmitter Halves    3
126. d clean to remove dust and grit  after lubricating  excess oil and grease should be removed  Particular  attention should also be given to hood latching compo   nents to insure proper function  When performing other  underhood services  the hood latch  release mechanism   and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 285    The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a  year  preferably in the fall and spring  Apply a small  amount of a high quality lubricant such as Mopar  Lock  Cylinder Lubricant or equivalent directly into the lock  cylinder     Windshield Wiper Blades   The rubber edges of the wiper blades and the windshield  should be cleaned periodically with a sponge or soft cloth  and a mild nonabrasive cleaner  This will remove accu   mulations of salt or road film     Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods  may cause deterioration of the wiper blades  Always use  washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt  from a dry windshield     Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice from  the windshield  Keep the blade rubber out of contact with  petroleum products such as engine oil  gasoline  etc     Windshield Washers Headlight Washers   The windshield washer and the headlight washer share  the same fluid reservoir  The fluid reservoir is located in  the front of the engine compartment on the passenger  side of the vehicle  Be sure to check the fluid level in the  reservoir at regular int
127. d control lever  located on the left side of the     3     CANCEL  steering column  operates the system  4     ON OFF       110 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Ed    To Activate   The indicator light in the lever  and in the  turn the system OFF  push the lever inward  toward the  WARNING     Push the speed control lever inward  toward  O the steering column  and release     ON OFF       instrument cluster on some models  will illu   minate to show that the speed control system is ON  To  steering column  again and release  At this time  the  system and the indicator light will turn off   Leaving the Electronic Speed Control system on  when not in use is dangerous  You could accidentally    set the system or cause it to go faster than you want   You could lose control and have an accident  Always  leave the system OFF when you aren t using it        To Set At A Desired Speed   When the vehicle reaches the speed desired  push the  lever down and release   SET DECEL    Remove your  foot from the accelerator pedal and the vehicle will  operate at the selected speed     NOTE   e Speed control will only function in third  fourth  or  fifth gear when in the Autostick  Mode  if equipped      e The speed control may not engage if a different size  tire is installed on one wheel  such as the compact  spare tire     To Deactivate   The system will disable Electronic Speed Control without  erasing the memory if you     e Softly tap the brake pedal  
128. d there are other CD s in the radio   the radio will play the next CD after a 2 minute timeout   If the CD is removed and there are no other CD s in the  radio  the radio will remain in CD mode and display   INSERT DISC  for 2 minutes  After 2 minutes  the radio  will go to the previous tuner mode     The disc can be ejected with the radio and ignition OFF     TIME Button  CD MODE for CD Audio Play   Press this button to change the display from a large CD  playing time display to a small CD playing time display     166 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    RW FF  CD MODE for CD Audio Play    Press and hold FF  Fast Forward  and the CD player will  begin to fast forward until FF is released or RW or  another CD button is pressed  The RW  Reverse  button  works in a similar manner     TUNE Control  CD MODE for CD Audio Play   Pressing the TUNE control allows the setting of the Tone   Fade  and Balance  See Radio Mode     AM FM Button  CD MODE for CD Audio Play   Switches the Radio to the Radio mode     RND PTY Button  Random Play Button   CD  MODE for CD Audio Play    Press this button while the CD is playing to activate  Random Play  This feature plays the selections on the  compact disc in random order to provide an interesting  change of pace     NOTE  MP3 and WMA Random Play are for file folders  only     Press the SEEK button to move to the next randomly  selected track     Press and hold the FF button to fast forward through the  tracks  Release the FF button to s
129. damage the cata   lytic converter  For proper type of replacement spark  plugs  refer to the  Vehicle Emission Control Informa   tion  label in the engine compartment     ee MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 279    Engine Air Cleaner Filter   For normal driving conditions  inspect and replace the  engine air cleaner filter at the intervals shown on Sched   ule    A     For vehicles driven frequently in dusty or under  severe conditions  inspect and replace the engine air  cleaner filter at the intervals shown on Schedule  B      WARNING     The air induction system  air cleaner  hoses  etc  can  provide a measure of protection in the case of engine  backfire  Do not remove the air induction system  air  cleaner  hoses  etc  unless such removal is necessary    for repair or maintenance  Make sure that no one is  near the engine compartment before starting the  vehicle with the air induction system  air cleaner   hoses  etc  removed  Failure to do so can result in  serious personal injury        Fuel Filter   A plugged fuel filter can cause stalling  limit the speed at  which a vehicle can be driven or cause hard starting   Should an excessive amount of dirt accumulate in the  fuel tank  filter replacement may be necessary  See your  local dealer for service     Catalytic Converter   The catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuel  only  Leaded gasoline will destroy the effectiveness of the  catalyst as an emission control device     Under normal operating conditions  the cata
130. dding Coolant   Your vehicle has been built with an improved engine  coolant that allows extended maintenance intervals  This  coolant can be used up to 5 Years or 100 000 miles  160  000 km  before replacement  To prevent reducing this  extended maintenance period  it is important that you  use the same coolant throughout the life of your vehicle   Please review these recommendations for using Hybrid  Organic Additive Technology  HOAT  coolant     When adding coolant     e The manufacturer recommends using Mopar   Antifreeze Coolant 5 Year 100 000 Mile Formula  HOAT  Hybrid Organic Additive Technology      e Mix a minimum solution of 50  HOAT engine coolant  and distilled water  Use higher concentrations  not to  exceed 70   if temperatures below    34 F     37 C  are  anticipated     e Use only high purity water such as distilled or deion   ized water when mixing the water engine coolant  solution  The use of lower quality water will reduce  the amount of corrosion protection in the engine  cooling system     Please note that it is the owner s responsibility to main   tain the proper level of protection against freezing ac   cording to the temperatures occurring in the area where  the vehicle is operated     NOTE  Mixing coolant types will decrease the life of the  engine coolant and will require more frequent coolant  changes     Cooling System Pressure Cap   The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of  coolant  and to insure that coolant will return to the  radiato
131. de properly buck   led up in a rear seat  if available  According to crash  statistics  children are safer when properly restrained in  the rear seats rather than in the front     48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE Se    WARNING     In a collision  an unrestrained child  even a tiny  baby  can become a missile inside the vehicle  The  force required to hold even an infant on your lap    could become so great that you could not hold the  child  no matter how strong you are  The child and  others could be badly injured  Any child riding in  your vehicle should be in a proper restraint for the  child   s size     There are different sizes and types of restraints for  children from newborn size to the child almost large  enough for an adult safety belt  Always check the child  seat Owner   s Manual to ensure you have the correct seat  for your child  Use the restraint that is correct for your  child     Infants and Child Restraints    e Safety experts recommend that children ride  rearward facing in the vehicle until they are at least       one year old and weigh at least 20 lbs  9 kg   Two types  of child restraints can be used rearward facing  infant  carriers and  convertible  child seats     The infant carrier is only used rearward facing in the  vehicle  It is recommended for children who weigh up  to about 20 lbs  9 kg    Convertible  child seats can be  used either rearward facing or forward facing in the  vehicle  Convertible child seats often have a higher  w
132. designation  Example  LT235 85R16     Tires designed to this standard have the letter  T   molded into the sidewall preceding the size designa   tion  Example  T145 80D18 103M     High Flotation tire sizing is based on U S  design  standards and it begins with the tire diameter molded  into the sidewall  Example  31x10 5 R15 LT        222 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    Tire Sizing Chart    EXAMPLE     Size Designation   P   Passenger car tire size based on U S  design standards       blank       Passenger car tire based on European design standards  LT   Light Truck tire based on U S  design standards  T   Temporary Spare tire  31   Overall Diameter in Inches  in   215   Section Width in Millimeters  mm   65   Aspect Ratio in Percent  76        Ratio of section height to section width of tire   10 5   Section Width in Inches  in   R   Construction Code       R    means Radial Construction         D  means Diagonal or Bias Construction        15   Rim Diameter in Inches  in     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 223    EXAMPLE     Service Description     95   Load Index     A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry     H   Speed Symbol     A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding  to its load index under certain operating conditions        The maximum speed corresponding to the Speed Symbol should only be achieved un   der specified operating conditions   i e  tire pressure  vehicle loading  road conditions   and 
133. diagnosis     Improper alignment will not cause vehicle vibration   Vibration may be a result of tire and wheel out of   balance  Proper balancing will reduce vibration and  avoid tire cupping and spotty wear     TIRE CHAINS  If driving conditions require tire chains for your vehicle   use only chains that meet SAE type  Class S  specifica   tions  In addition  only install tire chains on 245 45ZR20  size tires  Contact you local dealership or tire dealer for  these size tires     236 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    CAUTION     To avoid damage to your vehicle or tires  observe the  following precautions     e Because of restricted chain clearance between tires  and other suspension components  it is important  that only chains in good condition are used  Broken  chains can cause serious damage  Stop the vehicle  immediately if noise occurs that could indicate chain  breakage  Remove the damaged parts of the chain  before further use     Install chains on the rear wheels as tightly as pos   sible and then retighten after driving about    mile   0 8 km     Do not exceed 30 mph  48 km h     Drive cautiously and avoid severe turns and large  bumps  especially with a loaded vehicle     Use on Rear Wheels only     Do not drive for prolonged period on dry pavement     Observe the tire chain manufacturer s instructions  on the method of installation  operating speed  and  conditions for use  Always use the lower suggested  operating speed of the chain manufacturer if differ   ent fr
134. diagnostic equip   ment to determine if the problem could recur     Have the transmission checked at your authorized dealer  as soon as possible     If the problem has been momentary  the transmission can  be reset to regain all forward gears     Permanent Transmission Limp Home Mode  Permanent Limp Home Mode will be activated if the  transmission enters temporary Limp Home Mode three  times  Follow the reset procedure described under    Tem   porary Transmission Limp Home Mode  in this section   In Permanent Limp Home Mode  P  Park   R  Reverse    and N  Neutral  will continue to operate  Second gear  will operate in the D  Drive  shifter position  The mal   function indicator light may illuminate     AUTOSTICK     Autostick   is a driver interactive transmission that offers  manual gear shifting to provide you with more control of  the vehicle  Autostick   allows you to maximize engine  braking  eliminate undesirable upshifts and downshifts   and improve overall vehicle performance  This system  can also provide you with more control during passing   city driving  cold slippery conditions  mountain driving   trailer towing  and many other situations     Autostick   Operation   By placing the selector lever in the D  Drive  position  it  can be moved from side to side  This allows the driver to  select a higher or lower range of gears  Moving the  selector lever to the Left     triggers a downshift and to  the Right     an upshift  The gear position will display in  the inst
135. documents     We appreciate that you have made a major investment  when you purchased your new vehicle  Your dealer has  also made a major investment in facilities  tools  and  training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with  your ownership experience  You ll be pleased with their  sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related  concerns     WARRANTY INFORMATION  U S  Vehicles Only   See the Warranty Information Booklet for the terms and  provisions of DaimlerChrysler s warranties applicable to  this vehicle     MOPAR   PARTS   Mopar  fluids  lubricants  parts  and accessories are  available from your dealer  They will help you keep your  vehicle operating at its best     N F YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 341    REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS   In the 50 United States and Washington D C   If you  believe that your vehicle has a defect  which could cause  a crash or cause injury or death  you should immediately  inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administra   tion  NHTSA  in addition to notifying the manufacturer     If NHTSA receives similar complaints  it may open an  investigation  and if it finds that a safety defect exists in  a group of vehicles  it may order a recall and remedy  campaign  However  NHTSA cannot become involved in  individual problems between you  your dealer  and the  manufacturer     To contact NHTSA  you may either call the Auto Safety  Hotline toll free at 1 888 327 4236  TTY  1 800 424   9153   or go to http   www NHTSA gov  or 
136. e  fluid and filter should be changed     Special Additives   Automatic Transmission Fluid  ATF  is an engineered  product and its performance may be impaired by supple   mental additives  Therefore  do not add any fluid addi   tives to the transmission  The only exception to this  policy is the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid  leaks  In addition  avoid using transmission sealers as  they may adversely affect seals     Front and Rear Wheel Bearings   Front and rear wheel bearings are permanently sealed   No regular maintenance is required for these compo   nents        2906 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE M    Appearance Care and Protection from Corrosion    Protection of Body and Paint from Corrosion  Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geo   graphic locations and usage  Chemicals that make roads  passable in snow and ice  and chemicals that are sprayed  on trees and road surfaces during other seasons  are  highly corrosive to the metal in your vehicle  Outside  parking  which exposes your vehicle to airborne contami   nants  road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated   extreme hot or cold weather and other extreme condi   tions will have an adverse effect on paint  metal trim  and  underbody protection     The following maintenance recommendations will enable  you to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion  resistance built into your vehicle     What Causes Corrosion   Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of  paint and protective coa
137. e  or if the vehicle is to be towed more than 30 miles   48 km   the vehicle must be transported using a flat bed  truck     NN WHAT TO DO N EMERGENCIES 267    If you must use the accessories  wipers  defrosters  etc      y pers     id while being towed  the key must be in the ON position   e Do not attempt to tow this vehicle from the front not the ACCESSORY position  Make certain the transmis   with sling type towing eguipment  Damage to the sion remains in NEUTRAL   front fascia will result  TOWING THIS VEHICLE BEHIND ANOTHER  If the transmission is not operative  or if the VEHICLE WITH A TOW DOLLY    vehicle is to be towed more than 30 miles  48 km   The manufacture does not recommend that you tow this  then the only approved method of towing is with vehicle on a tow dolly  Vehicle damage may occur     a flat bed truck  Damage to the transmission may  result     Do not tow the vehicle from the rear  Damage to  2  the rear sheet metal  and fascia will occur     Do not push or tow this vehicle with another  vehicle as damage to the bumper fascia and trans   mission may result           MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE    CONTENTS    B 6 1L Engine Compartment                 271  ll Onboard Diagnostic System     OBD II        272  doos Duel Filer Cap eicere hers HEK 272  N Emissions Inspection And Maintenance  OES RTT 273  B Replacement Parts        ss se de 274  W Dealer Service       SEE SS ss ee ee  274  Mi Maintenance Procedures                   275  Apice sed ELE eee HO READ H
138. e  radio checks all files on the medium  If the medium  contains a lot of folders or files  the radio will take more  time to start playing the MP3 files     Loading times for playback of MP3 and WMA files may  be affected by the following     e Media   CD RW media may take longer to load than  CD R media    e Medium formats   Multisession discs may take longer  to load than non multisession discs    e Number of files and folders   Loading times will  increase with more files and folders    To increase the speed of disc loading  it is recommended  to use CD R media and single session discs  To create a  single session disc  enable the Disc at Once option before  writing to the disc     Operation Instructions    CD Mode for MP3 and  WMA Audio Play     SEEK Button  CD Mode for MP3 and WMA Play   Pressing the right side of the SEEK button plays the next  file  Pressing the left side of the SEEK button plays the  beginning of the file  Pressing the button within the first  ten seconds plays the previous file     LOAD EJECT Button  CD Mode for MP3 and WMA  Play     LOAD EJT   Load  Press the LOAD EJT button and the push     button with the corresponding number where  LOAD the CD is being loaded  The radio will display  PLEASE WAIT and prompt when to INSERT  DISC  After the radio displays  INSERT DISC     insert the  CD into the player     N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 169    The radio display will show  LOADING DISC  when the  disc is loading     LOAD EJT   Eject   Press t
139. e CD Eject and Set buttons simulta   neously until the 12 digits of the ESN SID appear on the  screen     Selecting Satellite Mode in REF  RAQ  and RAK  Radios    Selecting Satellite Mode     REF Radio  Press the MODE button repeatedly until the word  SAT   appears in the display     A CD may remain in the radio while in the Satellite radio  mode     Selecting Satellite Mode     RAO and RAK Radio  Press the MODE button repeatedly until the word  SAT   appears in the display     These radios will also display the current station name  and program type  For more information  such as song  title and artist press the MSG or INFO button     A CD or tape may remain in the radio while in the  Satellite radio mode     Selecting a Channel  Press and release the SEEK or TUNE knob to search for  the next channel  Press the top of the button to search up       178 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    and the bottom of the button to search down  Holding the  TUNE button causes the radio to bypass channels until  the button is released     Press and release the SCAN button  if equipped  to  automatically change channels every 7 seconds  The  radio will pause on each channel for 7 seconds before  moving on to the next channel  The word  SCAN  will  appear in the display between each channel change  Press  the SCAN button a second time to stop the search     NOTE  Channels that may contain objectionable con   tent can be blocked  Contact Sirius Customer Care at  888 539 7474 to disc
140. e Epod 183  CIOCK obo AA PA 282239243 157 160 171  Compact Disc  CD  Maintenance             182  COMPASS x ass eu bee S oe PH RUE ABD EE Ms 149  Compass C  al bEa OB  secreten ermesi es rgis 149  Compass  Valance  mas sce diac essed woe 149  Computer  THp Travel  sue sordos SERE v poe 147  Console x sexa uri 2054 PEE PAR EE SERE 127  Console  Floor cuiua dtr H   EERS ER oS oe 127  Console  Overhead                    e  115  Contract  Service                eee 340  Coolant Pressure Cap  Radiator Cap           289  CODI vlei  sed vx eee bu ED Rd 287    Adding Coolant  Antifreeze                289  Coolant Capacity    Coolant Level 1542 3249 x sa 287 290  Disposal of Used Coolant                 290  Drain  Flush  and Refill                   287  Mis Deel o POTEFT 290  Points to Remember                     290  Pressure Cap see ER Bowe dod hes 289  Radiator GE ia eu ux yey eae 6 6 ED on 289  Selection of Coolant  Antifreeze       288 313 314  Cruise Control  Speed Control                109  Crise Licht gee deb uo acta d ae eee We eae ews 136  Cup Olde  Ganesan EA Wm quar DEAL O A 126 299  Customer Assistance                      338  Data Recorder  Event             llle 46  Davinie Runmne Lihis 22s ime ra de ERE 98  Dealer Service                 llle  274  Defroster  Rear Window                    191  Defroster  Windshield                    58 187  Delay  Intermittent  Wipers                 101  Diagnostic System  Onboard                 2 02  Dimmer Switch  Headligh
141. e LOCK position     NOTE    e None of the courtesy lights will operate if the dimmer  control is in the  defeat  position  extreme downward  position   unless the overhead map  reading lights are  turned on manually     NOTE  Inserting the key into the ignition switch dis   ables all buttons on that transmitter  however  the but   tons on the remaining transmitters will continue to work   Shifting the vehicle out of PARK disables all transmitter  buttons for all keys          15afat  a    Keyless Entry Transmitter    18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE y    To unlock the doors    Press and release the UNLOCK button on the transmitter  once to unlock the driver s door  or twice to unlock all  doors  The turn signal lights will flash to acknowledge  the unlock signal  The illuminated entry system will also  turn on     Remote Key Unlock  Driver Door All Doors First  This feature lets you program the system to unlock either  the driver s door or all doors on the first press of the  UNLOCK button on the transmitter  For details on how  to change the current setting  refer to  Remote Key  Unlock     under  Personal Settings  Customer Program   mable Features      under  Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this manual     Flash Lights with Remote Key Lock   This feature will cause the turn signal lights to flash when  the doors are locked or unlocked with the transmitter   This feature can be enabled or disabled  For details on  how to change t
142. e ahead  Rotate    NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 103    the end of the multi function lever to one of the six  intermittent wiper settings to activate this feature     JJ    Features   under    Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this manual     The sensitivity of the system is adjustable from the  multi function lever  Wiper delay position 1 is the least  sensitive and wiper delay position 6 is the most sensitive   Choose setting 3 or 4 for normal rain conditions  Choose    The rain sensing system has protective features for the  wiper blades and arms  It will not operate under the  following conditions        e Low Temperature Wipe Inhibit     The rain sensing    setting 2 or 1 if you desire less wiper sensitivity  Choose  setting 5 or 6 if you desire more sensitivity  Place the lever  in the OFF position when not using the system     NOTE     The rain sensing feature will not operate when the  wiper speed is in the LOW or HIGH position     The rain sensing feature may not function properly  when ice or dried salt water is present on the wind   shield     Use of Rain X  or products containing wax or silicone  may reduce rain sensor performance     The Rain Sense feature can be enabled or disabled  For  details  refer to  Rain Sensing Intermittent Wipers    under  Personal Settings  Customer Programmable    feature will not operate when the ignition is first  switched ON  and the vehicle is stationary  and the  outside temperature i
143. e can be enabled or  disabled  For details  refer to  Headlights On with Wip   ers   under  Personal Settings  Customer Programmable  Features   under    Electronic Vehicle Information Cen   ter  in Section 4 of this manual     SmartBeams     If Equipped   The SmartBeam system provides increased forward light   ing at night by automating high beam control through  the use of a digital camera mounted on the inside  rearview mirror  This camera detects vehicle specific light  and automatically switches from high beams to low  beams until the approaching vehicle is out of view     To Activate     1  Select  Automatic High Beams     ON  through the  Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   For details   refer to  Automatic High Beams   under  Personal Set   tings  Customer Programmable Features    under    Elec   tronic Vehicle Information Center  in Section 4 of this  manual     2  Rotate the headlight switch counter clockwise to the  AUTO  A  position     NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 97    3  Push the Multi Function Lever away from you to  switch the headlights to the HIGH BEAM position     NOTE  This system will not activate until the vehicle is  at or above 25 mph  40 km h      To Deactivate   Perform either of the following steps to deactivate the  omartBeam system     1  Pull the Multi Function Lever toward you to switch  the headlights from the HIGH BEAM to the LOW BEAM  position     2  Rotate the headlight switch clockwise from the AUTO   A  to the O
144. e cell phone has  network coverage and stays paired to the UConnect     system     Towing Assistance  If you need towing assistance     e Press the  Phone  button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Iowing Assistance      NOTE  The Towing Assistance number dialed is based  on the Country where the vehicle is purchased  1 800   528 2069 for USA  1 877 213 4525 for Canada  55 14 3454  for Mexico city and 1 800 712 3040 for outside Mexico  city in Mexico      Please refer to the 24 Hour  Towing Assistance  cover   age details in the Warranty information booklet and on  the 24 Hour Towing Assistance Card     Paging   To learn how to page  refer to  Working with Automated  Systems     Paging works properly except for pagers of  certain companies which time out a little too soon to  work properly with the UConnect    system     Voice Mail Calling  To learn how to access your voice mail  refer to  Working  with Automated Systems      Working with Automated Systems   This method is designed to be used in instances where  one generally has to press numbers on the cellular phone  keypad while navigating through an automated tele   phone system     N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 77    You can use your UConnect    system to access a voice   mail system or an automated service  such as  paging  service or automated customer service  Some services  require immediate response selection  in some instances   that may be too quick for use of UCon
145. e failure   excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure  The  grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all  passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor  Vehicle Safety Standard No  109  Grades B and A repre   sent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test  wheel than the minimum required by law        INDEX       346 INDEX NEE Id    ABS  Anti Lock Brake System                211  Adding Engine Coolant  Antifreeze            289  POG Bue 22s  9443 OE OR EE 249  Adding Washer Fluid                104 106 285  Adjustable Pedals 3 533535 sd 50 9 2  92 kiras 108  Air Cleaner  Engine    Engine Air Cleaner Filter  ass bo oon 279  Air Conditioner Maintenance                282  Air Conditioning Filter   24 5 va arbo 189 283  Air Conditioning  Operating Tips             190  Air Conditioning Refrigerant             282 283  Air Conditioning System                183 282  Air Pressure  Tires                ssn  141 230  ino catokenod agenda eh Gea m 38  Albae Deploy MENT jes oo dies Sex ee keds bes 42 44  Airbag LIN  ies Gos  RE RE P S aiaa 43 46 58 137  Airbag Maintenance asse 3 oe xU e ear og 45  ie Ao 155  9 22 x09  EIE de ET ST 43  Airbag  Window  Side Curtain              38 43  Alarm  Security Alarm  s ex 2929 eiss 140  Alarm System  Security Alarm                15  Alignment and Balance 229 25 esa bees 235  Alterations  Modifications  Vehicle              7    Antenna  Satellite Radio                    179  Antifreeze  Engine Coolant   
146. e following components   e Receiver Module   e 4 Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors   e Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light    Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings   1  The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will  ref illuminate in the instrument cluster and an audible  chime will sound when tire pressure is low in one  or more of the four active road tires  The audible chime  will sound once every ignition cycle for each condition  that it detects  Should this occur  you should stop as soon  as possible  check the inflation pressure of each tire on  your vehicle  and inflate each tire to the vehicle s recom   mended cold placard pressure value  Once the system    242 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    receives the updated tire pressures  the system will  automatically update and the Tire Pressure Monitoring  Telltale Light will turn off  The vehicle may need to be  driven for up to 10 minutes above 15 mph  25 km h  in  order for the TPMS to receive this information  Low  pressure in the spare tire will not cause the Tire Pressure  Monitoring Telltale Light to illuminate or the chime to  sound     NOTE  The compact spare tire  if so equipped  does not  have a tire pressure monitoring sensor  Therefore  the  TPMS will not monitor the pressure in the compact spare  tire  However  if you install the compact spare tire in  place of a road tire that has a pressure below the  low pressure warning limit  the Tire Pressure Monitoring  Telltale Light will remain ON and 
147. e if required        X       X            Replace the air cleaner filter     0   X O   Inspect the front and rear brake linings and rotors      X  J Y     Replace the air conditioning filter      X     Rotate the tires  o    Rotate the tires       This maintenance is recommended by the manufacturer  to the owner but is not required to maintain the emis   sions warranty     1 This maintenance is not required if previously replaced     Inspection and service should also be performed anytime  a malfunction is observed or suspected  Retain all re   ceipts     WARNING     You can be badly injured working on or around a  motor vehicle  Only do service work for which you  have the knowledge and the right equipment  If you  have any doubt about your ability to perform a  service job  take your vehicle to a competent me   chanic        M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8          IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE    CONTENTS    W Suggestions For Obtaining Service For Your ll Reporting Safety Defects                   341  el CP                  TO EE EA 338 GARAGE en 341  O Prepare For The Appointment   vec ss di W Publication Order Forms                  341  OPP 3  DISE soas see ee ee ER RENS ne te aes 338 lll Department Of Transportation Uniform Tire  3 Be Reasonable With Requests               338 Suri atcur P cht oe ees ede eee ea  343  W if You Need Assistance ies sa vga SERE Ed 338 E Troad wed sos 2 pd AAS HEES C eR SIE 343  W Warranty Information  U S  
148. e of the SEEK button for the next  selection on the CD  Press the left side of the button to  return to the beginning of the current selection  or return  to the beginning of the previous selection if the CD is  within the first 5 seconds of the current selection     N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 165    SCAN Button  CD MODE for CD Audio Play   Press the Scan button to scan through each track on the  CD currently playing     LOAD EJECT Button  CD Mode for CD Audio  Play     LOAD EJECT   Load   Press the LOAD EJI button and the push   button with the corresponding number where  the CD is being loaded  The radio will display  PLEASE WAIT and prompt when to INSERT  DISC  After the radio displays  INSERT DISC     insert the  CD into the player     Radio display will show  LOADING DISC  when the disc  is loading and  READING DISC  when the radio is  reading the disc     LOAD EJT   Eject  Press the LOAD EJT button and the push   A button with the corresponding number where  LOAD the CD was loaded and the disc will unload  and move to the entrance for easy removal     LOAD    Radio display will show  EJECTING DISC  when the disc  is being ejected and prompt the user to remove the disc     Press and hold the LOAD EJT button for 5 seconds and  all CDs will be ejected from the radio     If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within  15 seconds  it will be reloaded  If the CD is not removed   the radio will continue to play the non removed CD  If  the CD is removed an
149. e system is sounding an audio tone        114 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  ee    WARNING  CAUTION     e Drivers must be careful when backing up even e The Rear Park Assist System is only a parking aid    when using the Rear Park Assist System  Always  check carefully behind your vehicle  look behind  you  and be sure to check for pedestrians  animals   other vehicles  obstructions  and blind spots be   fore backing up  You are responsible for safety  and must continue to pay attention to your sur   roundings  Failure to do so can result in serious  injury or death     Before using the Rear Park Assist System  it is  strongly recommended that the ball mount and  hitch ball assembly is disconnected from the  vehicle when the vehicle is not used for towing     and it is unable to recognize every obstacle  in   cluding small obstacles  Parking curbs might be  temporarily detected or not detected at all  Ob   stacles located above or below the sensors will not  be detected when they are in close proximity     The vehicle must be driven slowly when using the  Rear Park Assist System to be able to stop in time  when the obstacle is detected  It is recommended  that the driver looks over his her shoulder when       using the Rear Park Assist System     NOTE   e Ensure that the rear bumper is free of dirt and debris  to keep the system operating properly     Failure to do so can result in injury or damage to  vehicles or obstacles because the hitch ball will be  much cl
150. e tire pressure will vary with temperature by about  1 psi  6 9 kPa  for every 12  F  6 5  C   This means that  when the outside temperature decreases  the tire pres   sure will decrease  Tire pressure should always be set  based on cold inflation tire pressure  This is defined as  the tire pressure after the vehicle has not been driven  for at least 3 hours  or driven less than 1 mile  1 km   after a 3 hour period  The cold tire inflation pressure  must not exceed the maximum inflation pressure  molded into the tire sidewall  Refer to the    Tires      General Information    in this section for information  on how to properly inflate the vehicle   s tires  The tire  pressure will also increase as the vehicle is driven   this  is normal and there should be no adjustment for this  increased pressure     temperature effects     The TPM System will continue to warn the driver of  low tire pressure as long as the condition exists  and  will not turn off until the tire pressure is at or above  the recommended cold placard pressure  Once the low  tire pressure warning  Tire Pressure Monitoring Tell   tale Light  illuminates  you must increase the tire  pressure to the recommended cold placard pressure in  order for the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light to  turn off  The system will automatically update and the  Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will turn off  once the system receives the updated tire pressures   The vehicle may need to be driven for up to 10 minutes  ab
151. e to clear off road mist or spray from a passing  vehicle  The wipers will continue to operate until you  release the lever     Windshield Washers   To use the washer  push the multi function lever inward   toward the steering column  to the second detent and  hold it for as long as washer spray is desired     If you activate the washer while the windshield wiper  control is in the delay range  the wipers will operate for       two wipe cycles after releasing the lever and then resume  the intermittent interval previously selected     If you activate the washer while the windshield wiper is  turned OFF  the wipers will operate for two wipe cycles  and then turn OFF     Headlights On with Wipers   When this feature is active  the headlights will turn on  approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on  if the headlight switch is placed in the AUTO position  In  addition  the headlights will turn off when the wipers are  turned off if they were turned on by this feature     The Headlights On With Wipers feature can be enabled  or disabled  For details  refer to    Headlights On with  Wipers     under    Personal Settings  Customer Program   mable Features      under    Electronic Vehicle Information  Center    in Section 4 of this manual     Rain Sensing Wipers   This feature senses moisture on the windshield and  automatically activates the wipers for the driver  This  feature is especially useful for road splash or over spray  from the windshield washers of the vehicl
152. e vehicle     184 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    The controls on the climate control provide the system  with operator input  The dual sun sensor monitors sun  load coming through the windshield  The infrared sensor  independently measures the surface temperature of the  driver and passenger  Other sensors take account of  vehicle speed  A C pressure  outside temperature  and  engine cooling temperature  Using all of these inputs  the  system automatically adjusts airflow temperature  air   flow distribution  airflow volume  and the amount of  outside air recirculation  This maintains a comfortable  temperature even under changing conditions     Operation of the system is quite simple  Begin by turning  the Mode Control knob  on the right  to AUTO  and place  the Blower Control knob  on the left  to either LO AUTO  or HI AUTO  The LO AUTO position should be used for  front seat occupants only  The HI AUTO position should  be used when more airflow is desired  or when rear seat  occupants are present  Then  dial in the temperature you  would like the system to maintain by rotating the driver  or passenger Temperature Control knob  Once the com   fort level is selected  the system will maintain that level    automatically using the heating system  Should the de   sired comfort level require air conditioning  the system  will automatically make the adjustment     You will experience the greatest efficiency by simply  allowing the system to function automatically  
153. eage are listed  follow the  interval that occurs first     M  A  l  N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       320 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES M    Once a Month At Each Oil Change    e Check tire pressure and look for unusual wear or e Change the engine oil filter     d  amage e Inspect the exhaust system     e Inspect the battery  and clean  and tighten the termi        I h hoses    malas ede ed  e Inspect the brake hoses   e Inspect the CV joints and front and rear suspension    e Check the fluid levels of coolant reservoir and brake  components     master cylinder  and add as needed     e Check all lights and all other electrical items for correct e Check the coolant level  hoses  and clamps     operation     e Check rubber seals on each side of the radiator for  proper fit     N SCHEDULE B  321    SCHEDULE  B   Follow Schedule  B  if you usually operate your vehicle  under one or more of the following conditions     Change the automatic transmission fluid and filter every  60 000 miles  100 000 km  if the vehicle is usually  operated under one or more of the conditions marked  with an        e Day or night temperatures are below 32  F  0  C    e Stop and go driving    e Extensive engine idling    e Driving in dusty conditions    e Short trips of less than 10 miles  16 km      e More than 50  of your driving is at sustained high  speeds during hot weather  above 90  F  32  C      e Trailer towing        e Taxi  police or delivery service  commercial ser   vices 
154. ean cloth and  wipe the mirror clean        Outside Mirrors   To receive maximum benefit  adjust the outside mirror s   to center on the adjacent lane of traffic and a slight  overlap of the view obtained from the inside mirror     NOTE  The passenger side convex outside mirror will  give a much wider view to the rear  and especially of the  lane next to your vehicle     64 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    WARNING     Vehicles and other objects seen in the passenger side  convex mirror will look smaller and farther away  than they really are  Relying too much on your    passenger side convex mirror could cause you to  collide with another vehicle or other object  Use your  inside mirror when judging the size or distance of a  vehicle seen in the passenger side convex mirror        Exterior Mirrors Folding Feature     If Equipped  Some models have exterior mirrors that are hinged  The  hinge allows the mirror to pivot forward and rearward to  resist damage  The hinge has three detent positions  full  forward  full rearward  and normal     Driver s Side Outside Mirror Auto Dimmer   This mirror automatically adjusts for annoying headlight  glare from vehicles behind you  You can turn this feature  on or off by pressing the button at the base of the Inside  Rearview Mirror     Tilt in Reverse Feature   The  Tilt in Reverse  feature tilts the outside rearview  mirrors downward when the ignition switch is in the ON  position and the transmission is in the R  Reverse 
155. ection 3 of this  manual for more information      Sound Horn with Remote Key Lock    When ON is selected  a short horn sound will occur when  the remote keyless entry  Lock  button is pressed  This  feature may be selected with or without the flash lights  on lock unlock feature  To make your selection  press  and release the FUNCTION SELECT button until  ON   or  OFF  appears      Rain Sensing Intermittent Wipers    When ON is selected  the system will automatically  activate the windshield wipers if it senses moisture on  the windshield  To make your selection  press and release    N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 155    the FUNCTION SELECT button until  ON  or  OFF   appears  When OFF is selected  the system reverts to the  standard intermittent wiper operation       Automatically Move Seat Back on Exit      If  Equipped   This feature provides automatic driver seat positioning to  enhance driver mobility when entering and exiting the  vehicle  To make your selection  press and release the  FUNCTION SELECT button until  ON  or  OFF  ap   pears     NOTE  The seat will return to the memorized seat  location  if Recall Memory with Remote Key Unlock is set  to ON  when the remote keyless entry transmitter is used  to unlock the door  Refer to  Easy Entry   Exit Seat  under   Driver Memory Seat  in Section 3 of this manual for  more information      Flash Lights with Remote Key Lock    When ON is selected  the front and rear turn signals will  flash when the doors are loc
156. ed to unplug the device during the   cycling  process to prevent possible overheating    3  Continue to press and hold the HomeLink button  while you press and release your hand held transmitter  every two seconds until the frequency signal is accepted  successfully by HomeLink  The EVIC will display  Chan   nel X Trained   where X is Channel 1  2  or 3   Proceed  with  Programming  Step 4 to complete the procedure     Using HomeLink   To operate  simply press and release the programmed  HomeLink button  Activation will now occur for the  trained device  ie  garage door opener  gate operator   security system  entry door lock  home office lighting   etc    For convenience  the hand held transmitter of the  device may also be used at any time  In the event that  there are still programming difficulties or questions   contact HomeLink at  www homelink com or 1 800 355   3515     Erasing HomeLink Buttons   To erase programming from the three buttons  individual  buttons cannot be erased but can be  reprogrammed     note below   follow the step noted     e Press and hold the two outer HomeLink buttons   Release the buttons only when the EVIC displays   Channels Cleared   after 20 seconds   however  do  not hold the buttons for longer than 30 seconds   HomeLink is now in the train  or learning  mode and  can be programmed at any time beginning with  Pro   gramming  Step 2     Reprogramming a Single HomeLink Button  To program a device a previously trained HomeLink  button  follow 
157. ed with any Hands   Free Profile certified Bluetooth    cellular phone  See  www chrysler com uconnect for supported phones  If  your cellular phone supports a different profile  e g    Headset Profile   you may not be able to use any UCon   nect    features  Refer to your cellular service provider or  the phone manufacturer for details     The UConnect    system is fully integrated with the  vehicle s audio system  The volume of the UConnect       system can be adjusted either from the radio volume  control knob  or from the steering wheel radio control   right switch   if so equipped     The radio display will be used for visual prompts from  the UConnect    system such as  CELL  or caller ID on  certain radios     Operations   Voice commands can be used to operate the UConnect     system and to navigate through the UConnect    menu  structure  Voice commands are required after most  UConnect    system prompts  You will be prompted for a  specific command and then guided through the available  options     e Prior to giving a voice command  one must wait for  the voice on beep  which follows the  Ready  prompt  or another prompt     e For certain operations  compound commands can be  used  For example  instead of saying  Setup  and then   Phone Pairing     the following compound command  can be said   Setup Phone Pairing         68 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    e For each feature explanation in this section  only the  combined form of the voice command is g
158. ed with side curtain airbags   NOTE  Airbag covers may not be obvious in the do not have any accessory items installed which will    _     E alter the roof  including adding a sunroof to your  eri EY DURES va opsie an Owe ap CCP 10  vehicle  Do not add roof racks that require perma     nent attachments  bolts or screws  for installation on  the vehicle roof  Do not drill into the roof of the  vehicle for any reason     Do not drill  cut or tamper with the knee bolster in  any Way     Do not mount any accessories to the knee bolster  such as alarm lights  stereos  citizens band radios etc        40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    NOTE  Do not use a clothing bar mounted to the coat  hooks in this vehicle  A clothing bar will impede the  proper performance of the curtain airbags     Along with the seat belts  front airbags work with the  instrument panel knee bolsters to provide improved  protection for the driver and front passenger  Side Cur   tain Airbags also work with seat belts to improve occu   pant protection     The seat belts are designed to protect you in many types  of collisions  The front airbags deploy in moderate to  severe frontal collisions     If your vehicle is so equipped  the Side Curtain Airbag on  the crash side of the vehicle is triggered in moderate to  severe side collisions  However  even in collisions where  the airbags deploy  you need the seat belts to keep you in  the correct position for the airbags to protect you prop   erly    
159. edge of the headliner out of the way and  covers the window  The airbag inflates in about 30  milliseconds  about one quarter of the time that it  takes to blink your eyes  with enough force to injure  you if you are not belted and seated properly  or if  items are positioned in the area where the side curtain  airbag inflates  This especially applies to children  The  side curtain airbag is only about 3 1 2 inches  9 cm   thick when it is inflated        44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    e The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees of  the driver and the front passenger  and position every   one for the best interaction with the front airbag     If A Deployment Occurs   The airbag system is designed to deploy when the ACM  detects a moderate to severe collision  to help restrain the  driver and front passenger  and then to immediately  deflate     NOTE  A frontal collision that is not severe enough to  need airbag protection will not activate the system  This  does not mean something is wrong with the airbag  system     If you do have a collision  which deploys the airbags  any  or all of the following may occur     e The nylon airbag material may sometimes cause abra   sions and or skin reddening to the driver and front  passenger as the airbags deploy and unfold  The  abrasions are similar to friction rope burns or those  you might get sliding along a carpet or gymnasium  floor  They are not caused by contact with chemicals   They are not permanent a
160. eet the requirements of DaimlerChrysler  Material Standard MS 10725     The manufacturer recommends the use of a full synthetic  engine oil  such as Mobil 19 SAE 0W 40 or equivalent     Engine Oil Viscosity  SAE Grade    The proper SAE viscosity grade of engine oil should be  selected based on the following recommendation and be  within the operating temperature shown in the engine oil  viscosity chart      20 10 20 327 BU    BO    100     297  148    12   Tr 0   167 27  38    Temperature range anticipated before next oil changa       The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended  engine oil viscosity for your engine  For information on  engine oil filler cap location  refer to the  Engine Com   partment  illustration in this section     Materials Added to Engine Oil   The manufacturer strongly recommends against the ad   dition of any additives  other than leak detection dyes  to  the engine oil  Engine oil is an engineered product and its  performance may be impaired by supplemental addi   tives     7       278 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    Disposing of Used Engine Oil and Oil Filters   Care should be taken in disposing of used engine oil and  oil filters from your vehicle  Used oil and oil filters   indiscriminately discarded  can present a problem to the  environment  Contact your dealer  service station  or  governmental agency for advice on how and where used  oil and oil filters can be safely discarded in your area     Engine Oil Filter  The engine oil filte
161. eft side of the vehicle  Push in on the left side  near the  edge  of the fuel filler door to access the fuel filler cap  If  the gas cap is lost or damaged  be sure the replacement  cap is for use with this vehicle     a nrc    Shiites rs       e Bie A 81268080    Fuel Filler Door       250 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    NOTE  When removing the fuel filler cap  lay the cap       tether in the hook  located on the fuel filler cap door DEON  reinforcement  E Damage to the fuel system or emission control  od system could result from using an improper fuel  tank filler tube cap  gas cap    A poorly fitting gas cap could let impurities into  the fuel system     A poorly fitting gas cap may cause the Malfunc   tion Indicator Light to turn on     To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling  do not  top  off    the fuel tank after filling  When the fuel  nozzle    clicks    or shuts off  the fuel tank is full        Gas Cap Tether Hook    ee STARTING AND OPERATING 251    WARNING     e Never have any smoking materials lit in or near  the vehicle when the gas cap is removed or the  tank filled     Never add fuel to the vehicle when the engine is    running     A fire may result if gasoline is pumped into a  portable container that is inside of a vehicle  You  could be burned  Always place gas containers on  the ground while filling     NOTE    e Tighten the gas cap until you hear a    clicking    sound   This is an indication that the gas cap is tightened  properly  The Malfunction Indic
162. eight limit in the rearward facing direction than  infant carriers do  so they can be used rearward facing  by children who weigh more than 20 lbs  9 kg  but are  less than one year old  Both types of child restraints are  held in the vehicle by the lap shoulder belt or the  LATCH child restraint anchorage system  Refer to   LATCH     Child Seat Anchorage System  Lower  Anchors and Tether for CHildren   in this section     Rearward facing child seats must NEVER be used in  the front seat of a vehicle with the front passenger  airbag unless the airbag is turned off  An airbag  deployment could cause severe injury or death to  infants in this position     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49    Older Children and Child Restraints   Children who weigh more than 20 lbs  9 kg  and who are  older than one year can ride forward facing in the  vehicle  Forward facing child seats and convertible child  seats used in the forward facing direction are for children  who weigh 20 to 40 Ibs  9 to 18 kg  and who are older  than one year  These child seats are also held in the  vehicle by the lap shoulder belt or the LATCH child  restraint anchorage system  Refer to  LATCH     Child  Seat Anchorage System  Lower Anchors and Tether for  CHildren   in this section     The belt positioning booster seat is for children weighing  more than 40 lbs  18 kg   but who are still too small to fit  the vehicle s seat belts properly  If the child cannot sit  with knees bent over the vehicle s 
163. elerate quickly forward or in re   verse  You could lose control of the vehicle and hit    someone or something  Only shift into gear when  the engine is idling normally and when your right  foot is firmly on the brake pedal        Automatic Transmission     General Information    The automatic transmission selects individual gears au     tomatically  dependent upon     Altitude   Vehicle Loading  Driving Style   Selector lever position  Accelerator position    Vehicle speed    The gear shifting process is continuously adapted  de   pendent on the driving style  the driving situation and  the road characteristics     NOTE    e After selecting any driving position  wait a moment to  allow the gear to engage fully before accelerating   especially when the engine is cold     e If there is a need to restart the engine  be sure to cycle  the key to the LOCK position before restarting  Trans   mission engagement may be delayed up to 10 seconds  after restart if the key is not cycled to the LOCK  position first     e The electronically controlled transmission provides a  precise shift schedule  The transmission electronics are  self calibrating  Therefore  the first few shifts on a new  vehicle may be somewhat abrupt or soft until after the  break in period  This is a normal condition  and pre   cision shifts will develop within a few shift cycles     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 201    The selector lever is automatically locked while in the P   Park  position  To move the selector lev
164. ellular service plan  For example  if your cellular service  plan provides three way calling  this feature can be  accessed through the UConnect    system  Check with  your cellular service provider for the features that you  have     Answer or Reject an Incoming Call   No Call  Currently in Progress   When you receive a call on your cellular phone  the  UConnect    system will interrupt the vehicle audio  system  if on  and will ask if you would like to answer the  call  To reject the call  press and hold the    Phone    button  until you hear a single beep indicating that the incoming  call was rejected     Answer or Reject an Incoming Call   Call  Currently in Progress   If a call is currently in progress and you have another  incoming call  you will hear the same network tones for  call waiting that you normally hear when using your cell  phone  Press the  Phone  button to place the current call    on hold and answer the incoming call  NOTE  The  UConnect    system compatible phones in market today  do not support rejecting an incoming call when another  call is in progress  Therefore  the user can only either  answer an incoming call or ignore it     Making a Second Call while Current Call in  Progress   To make a second call while you are currently in a call   press the  Voice Recognition  button and say  Dial  or   Call  followed by the phone number or phonebook entry  you wish to call  The first call will be on hold while the  second call is in progress  To go back to
165. en ON is selected  all doors will unlock when the  vehicle is stopped and the transmission is in the P  Park   or N  Neutral  position and the driver s door is opened   To make your selection  press and release the FUNC   TION SELECT button until  ON  or  OFF  appears      Remote Key Unlock    When Driver Door 1st Press is selected  only the driver s  door will unlock on the first press of the remote keyless  entry unlock button  When Driver Door 1st Press is  selected  you must press of the remote keyless entry  unlock button twice to unlock the passenger s doors   When All Doors 1st Press is selected  all of the doors will  unlock on the first press of the remote keyless entry  unlock button  To make your selection  press and release  the FUNCTION SELECT button until  Driver Door 1st  Press  or  All Doors 1st Press  appears      Recall Memory with Remote Key Unlock      If  Equipped   When ON is selected  you can use your Remote Keyless  Entry Transmitter to recall one of two pre programmed  memory profiles  Each memory profile contains desired    position settings for the driver seat  side mirror  adjust   able pedals  if equipped   and power tilt and telescopic  steering column  if equipped   and a set of desired radio  station presets  When OFF is selected  only the memory  switch on the driver s door panel will recall memory  profiles  To make your selection  press and release the  FUNCTION SELECT button until  ON  or  OFF  ap   pears  Refer to  Driver Memory Seat  in S
166. ent track or to listen to the beginning of the  previous track if it is within 5 seconds after the current  track begins to play     Press either the top or bottom of the SCROLL button  twice to listen to the second track on the tape  three times  to listen to the third track  and so forth     Press the FUNCTION SELECT button to change the side  of the tape being played     CD Player Operation   Press the top of the SCROLL button once to listen to the  next track on the CD  Press the bottom of the SCROLL  button once either to listen to the beginning of the current  track or to listen to the beginning of the previous track if  it is within one second after the current track begins to    play     Press either the top or bottom of the SCROLL button  twice to listen to the second track on the CD  three times  to listen to the third track  and so forth     Satellite Radio Operation   Press the top of the SCROLL button once to SEEK the  next listenable station up from the current setting  Press  the bottom of the SCROLL button once to SEEK the next  listenable station down from the current setting     CASSETTE TAPE AND PLAYER MAINTENANCE  To keep the cassette tapes and player in good condition   take the following precautions     1  Do not use cassette tapes longer than C 90  otherwise   sound quality and tape durability will be greatly dimin   ished     2  Keep the cassette tape in its case to protect from  slackness and dust when it is not in use     3  Keep the cassette tape aw
167. er for service     308 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    WARNINCG     A transient high tension occurs at the bulb sockets of  High Intensity Discharge  HID  headlights when the    headlight switch is turned ON  It may cause serious  electrical shock or electrocution if not serviced prop   erly  See your authorized dealer for service        NOTE  When HID headlights are turned on  there is a  blue hue to the lights  This diminishes and becomes more  white after approximately 10 seconds  as the system  charges     1  Open the hood     NOTE  Removal of the air cleaner filter housing may be  necessary prior to replacing bulbs in the headlight assem   bly on the driver side of the vehicle     2  Twist the appropriate bulb and socket assembly  counter clockwise  and then pull it out of the headlight  assembly     3  Pull the bulb out of the socket assembly     4  Push the replacement bulb into the socket assembly     5  Reinstall the bulb and socket assembly into the head   light assembly  and then turn it clockwise        DTE    818dbur3    1     Low Beam Headlight Bulb  2     High Beam Headlight Bulb    N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 309       ER EE ER Tail Stop  Tail  Turn Signal Light  and Backup       7 M aa ve tme TrsT  BAR  j rene  dd eee al      Light  1  Open the Trunk           2  Remove two fasteners from the back of the tail light  assembly     ve aa MH Re SA Re Aa Ry Te  I MENS       a18db120    3     Park Turn Light Bulb       CAUTION     Do not touch the new bulb with yo
168. er out of the P    Park  position  the brake pedal must be firmly depressed Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure  before the shift lock will release  those in and near the vehicle  As with all vehicles   you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is    running  Before exiting a vehicle  you should always  shift the vehicle into P  Park   remove the key from    Shift the selector lever to the desired position only when  the engine is idling normally and the brake pedal is  applied  Do not release the brake until ready to drive  The  vehicle may otherwise accelerate quickly when the selec   tor lever is in D  Drive  or R  Reverse  position     the ignition  and apply the parking brake  Once the  key is removed from the ignition  the transmission  selector lever is locked in the P  Park  position   securing the vehicle against unwanted movement   Furthermore  you should never leave children unat   tended inside a vehicle        Over Temperature Mode   The transmission electronics constantly monitor the  transmission oil temperature  If the transmission exceeds  normal operating temperature  the transmission will  change the way it shifts to help control the condition   This may result in a slightly different feeling or response  during normal operation in D  Drive  position  After the  transmission cools down  it will return to normal opera   tion     202 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    Brake Transmission Shift Interlock System   This vehicle is equipped with a b
169. er party will not be able to hear you  In  order to mute the UConnect    system     e Press the  Voice Recognition  button     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Mute      In order to un mute the UConnect    system   e Press the  Voice Recognition    button     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Mute off      Information Service   When using AT amp T Wireless Service  dialing to phone  number   121   you can access voice activated automated  system to receive news  weather  stocks  traffic  etc   related information     Advanced Phone Connectivity    Transfer Call to and from Cellular Phone   The UConnect    system allows on going calls to be  transferred from your cellular phone to the UConnect     system without terminating the call  To transfer an ongo   ing call from your UConnect    paired cellular phone to  the UConnect    system or vice versa  press the    Voice  Recognition    button and say  Transfer Call      N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 79    Connect or Disconnect Link Between the  UConnect    System and Cellular Phone   Your cellular phone can be paired with many different  electronic devices  but can only be actively  connected   with one electronic device at a time     If you would like to connect or disconnect the Blue   tooth   connection between a UConnect    paired cellular  phone and the UConnect    system  then follow the  instruction described in your cellular phone user s  manual     List Paired
170. er to skip forward or backward 1 to 6 selections   Press the SEEK button once to move 1 selection  twice to  move 2 selections  etc     Fast Forward  FF    Press the FF button up momentarily to advance the tape  in the direction that it is playing  The tape will advance  until the button is pressed again or the end of the tape is  reached  At the end of the tape  the tape will play in the  opposite direction     Rewind  RW    Press the RW button momentarily to reverse the tape  direction  The tape will reverse until the button is pressed  again or until the end of the tape is reached  At the end of  the tape  the tape will play in the opposite direction     Tape Eject  Press this button and the cassette will disen   A  gage and eject from the radio     TAPE    Scan Button  Press this button to play 10 seconds of each selection   Press the scan button a second time to cancel the feature     Changing Tape Direction   If you wish to change the direction of tape travel  side  being played   press Preset 6  The lighted arrow in the  display window will show the new direction     Metal Tape Selection  If a standard metal tape is inserted into the player  the  player will automatically select the correct equalization     Pinch Roller Release   If ignition power or the radio ON OFF switch is turned  off  the pinch roller will automatically retract to protect  the tape from any damage  When power is restored to the  tape player  the pinch roller will automatically reengage  and the ta
171. ertrain Control  Module  PCM     Windshield Wiper   Washer       Cavity Car  Mini Description  tridge Fuse  Fuse   19 50 Amp     Radiator Fan  Red   20 20 Amp     Starter  Blue   21 50 Amp     Anti lock Brakes System  Red  ABS  Pump Motor   22 40 Amp     AC Clutch Radiator Fan  Green High     Low   23 50 Amp     High Intensity Lighting  Red  HID    24 60 Amp     Radiator Fan  Yellow   25 30 Amp     Front Control Module  Pink  FCM    26         27 30Amp     Front Control Module  Pink  FCM     302 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE M    CAUTION  Fuses  Rear Power Distribution Center   There is also a power distribution center located in the  trunk under the spare tire access panel  This center    e When installing the Power Distribution Center  contains fuses and relays     cover  it is important to ensure the cover is prop   erly positioned and fully latched  Failure to do so  may allow water to get into the Power Distribu   tion Center  and possibly result in an electrical  system failure     When replacing a blown fuse  it is important to  use only a fuse having the correct amperage  rating  The use of a fuse with a rating other than  indicated may result in a dangerous electrical  system overload  If a properly rated fuse contin   ues to blow  it indicates a problem in the circuit  that must be corrected        Rear Power Distribution Center    N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 303    Cavity Car  Mini Description Cavity Car  Mini Description   tridge Fuse tridge Fuse  Pase Fuse   1 60 Amp  
172. ervals  Fill the reservoir with  windshield washer solvent  not radiator antifreeze  and  operate the system for a few seconds to flush out the  residual water     The fluid reservoir will hold nearly 1 gallon  4 liters  of  washer fluid when the message  Low Washer Fluid   appears in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center   EVIC      WARNING     Commercially available windshield washer solvents    are flammable  They could ignite and burn you  Care  must be exercised when filling or working around  the washer solution           286 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN ed  Exhaust System WARNING   The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into    the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust Exhaust gases can injure or kill  They contain carbon  system  monoxide  CO  which is colorless and odorless     Breathing it can make you unconscious and can  eventually poison you  To avoid breathing CO  refer  to  Exhaust Gas  in the  Safety Tips  section of this  manual     Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaust  system  when exhaust fumes can be detected inside the  vehicle  or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is  damaged  have a competent mechanic inspect the com   plete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken   damaged  deteriorated  or mispositioned parts  Open  seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes  to seep into the passenger compartment  In addition   inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised  for
173. es the stopping distance longer  Just press firmly on  your brake pedal when you need to slow down or stop     Anti lock system  ABS  cannot prevent the natural laws  of physics from acting on the vehicle  nor can it increase  braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded by  the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the  traction afforded     The ABS cannot prevent accidents  including those  resulting from excessive speed in turns  following an   other vehicle too closely  or hydroplaning  Only a safe   attentive  and skillful driver can prevent accidents     The capabilities of an ABS equipped vehicle must never  be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner  which  could jeopardize the user   s safety or the safety of others           All vehicle wheels and tires must be the same size and  type and tires must be properly inflated to produce  accurate signals for the computer     Anti Lock Brake Light    G9  The ABS light monitors the Anti Lock Brake Sys   tem  The light will come on when the ignition   switch is turned to the ON position and may stay on for   as long as four seconds     If the ABS light remains on or comes on while driving  it  indicates that the Anti Lock portion of the brake system  is not functioning and that service is required  However   the conventional brake system will continue to operate  normally if the BRAKE warning light is not on     If the ABS light is on  the brake system should be serviced  as soon as possible to restore the 
174. estraint  If you install the restraint improperly  it may  not work when you need it     e Buckle the child into the seat according to the child  restraint manufacturer s directions     A rearward facing child restraint should only be  used in a rear seat  A rearward facing child re        straint in the front seat may be struck by a e When your child restraint is not in use  secure it in the  deploying passenger airbag  which may cause vehicle with the seat belt or remove it from the vehicle   severe or fatal injury to the infant  Do not leave it loose in the vehicle  In a sudden stop or  collision  it could strike the occupants or seat backs  Here are some tips on getting the most out of your child and cause serious personal injury   restraint  LATCH     Child Seat Anchorage System  Lower    e Before buying any restraint system  make sure that it Anchors and Tether for CH ildren   has a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety Your vehicle s rear seat is equipped with the child  Standards  We also recommend that you make sure restraint anchorage system called LATCH  The LATCH    where you will use it before you buy it  without using the vehicle s seat belts  instead securing    NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51    the child restraint using lower anchorages and upper  tether straps from the child restraint to the vehicle  structure     LATCH compatible child restraint systems are now avail   able  However  because the lower anchorages are to be  i
175. exist  the EVIC pro   vides the following telephone information     e Phone status  idle  voice mail  roaming  battery  strength  and signal strength in increments of 20  percent        COMPASS VARIANCE MAP poodebab       e Call status  Incoming call  connecting  connected  air  time in minutes and seconds  call ended  call failed   roaming  and no phone connection     e UConnect Active     e Caller ID phone number display     When the appropriate conditions exist  and if supported  by the cell phone  the EVIC will display the following  telephone symbols     Signal  Strength    t    Incom   ing Call    The EVIC displays this symbol to indicate the  signal strength of the UConnect    phone  The  number of horizontal bars increases as the  strength of the UConnect    phone signal in   creases     The EVIC displays this symbol to indicate an  incoming call     Analog    Roam   ing    Voice  Mail    EI    Text  Message    UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 151    The EVIC displays this symbol to indicate that  the UConnect    phone is currently in analog  mode     The EVIC displays this symbol to indicate that  the UConnect    phone is currently roaming     The EVIC displays this symbol to indicate that  you have voice mail     The EVIC displays this symbol to indicate a  text message     152 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    The EVIC displays this symbol to indicate the  LY battery strength of the UConnect    phone     Battery  Strength    The EVIC displays this sy
176. file 1 or 2     3  Press and release the Set  5  button on the memory  switch  then press and release the side of the rocker  switch labeled 1 or 2 accordingly   Memory Profile Set   1  or 2  will display in the Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC      4  Press and release the LOCK button on the transmitter  within 10 seconds     92 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    NOTE  Your transmitters can be unlinked to your  memory settings by pressing the Set  S  button followed  by the UNLOCK button on the transmitter in Step 4  above     Memory Position Recall    NOTE  The vehicle must be in Park to recall memory  positions  If a recall is attempted when the vehicle is not  in Park  a message will display in the Electronic Vehicle  Information Center  EVIC      To recall the memory settings for driver one  press  memory button number 1 on the driver s door or the   Unlock  button on the Remote Keyless Entry transmit   ter linked to memory position 1     To recall the memory setting for driver two  press  memory button number 2 on the driver s door or the   Unlock  button on the Remote Keyless Entry transmit   ter linked to memory position 2     A recall can be cancelled by pressing any of the memory  buttons  S  1  or 2  on the drivers door during a recall   When a recall is cancelled  the driver seat  side mirror     adjustable pedals  and power tilt and telescopic steering  column stop moving  A delay of one second will occur  before a
177. fog   press the Recirculation button to return to outside air     Some temp humidity conditions will cause captured  interior air to condense on windows and hamper  visibility  For this reason  the system will not allow  Recirculation to be selected while in defrost or  defrost floor mode  Attempting to use the recircula   tion while in these modes will cause the LED in the  control button to blink and then turn off     Manual Operation   This system offers a full complement of manual override  features  which consist of Blower Preferred Automatic   Mode Preferred Automatic  or Blower and Mode Pre   ferred Automatic  This means the operator can override  the blower  the mode  or both  There is a manual blower  range for times when the AUTO setting is not desired   The blower can be set to any fixed blower speed by  rotating the Blower Control knob  on the left      NOTE  Please read the Automatic Temperature Control  Operation Chart that follows for details     186 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL    Automatic Temperature     anteo Operation    Operation    Full Aulonmatiy   peratien    Blower Preferred Automate    hole Preferred Aubnmarie    Blower and Maule  Preterred Automatic    Set hler knob 10 ether   Hi or Lo Auw  Sec mede knob  lo Auto  Set temperature  knobs foe comfort     Sel blower knob to any  desired amos level other  than Hi or lay Auto  Set made  knab ter Aube  Sep Iempierature  knobs forc vomturt     Nel mode knob to any desired     delivery point other th
178. formation on  GAWR   s  vehicle loading  and trailer towing  refer to the   Vehicle Loading  section of this manual     To determine the maximum loading conditions of your  vehicle  locate the statement  The combined weight of  occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX  Ibs     on the Tire and Loading Information placard  The  combined weight of occupants  cargo luggage and  trailer tongue weight  if applicable  should never exceed  the weight referenced here     Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit    1  Locate the statement  The combined weight of occu   pants and cargo should never exceed XXX pounds  on  your vehicle s placard     2  Determine the combined weight of the driver and  passengers that will be riding in your vehicle     3  Subtract the combined weight of the driver and pas   sengers from XXX kilograms or XXX pounds     4  The resulting figure equals the available amount of  cargo and luggage load capacity  For example  if    XXX     amount equals 1400 Ibs  and there will be five 150 Ib   passengers in your vehicle  the amount of available cargo  and luggage load capacity is 650 Ibs   since 5 x 150   750   and 1400   750   650 lbs      5  Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo  being loaded on the vehicle  That weight may not safely  exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity  calculated in Step 4     6  If your vehicle will be towing a trailer  load from your  trailer will be transferred to your vehicle  Consult this    ee 
179. formulated Gasoline                   246 D Gross Vehicle Weight Rating  GVWR          252  O Gasoline Oxygenate Blends                247 H Gross Axle Weight Rating  GAWR            292  AMMI Di Gasolie ia sai trinti ARE a 247 E Overlodding ii casa deeded e RA HE 259  o Materials Added To Fuel i e dude eR RS 247 E C ENTNER RD RP ER OER eee 299  oO Fuel System Cautions 2  xu deos zo e px 248 Ja Trader Towing   uie rh e s pee eae 9  O Carbon Monoxide Warnings               248 W Recreational Towing   Mid din Fuel  iss n aes WEES EE i kamia ses 249 Ee ET bade iene  EFueLhllercap  Gas Cap  sedeer SERE RREF 249 we dein DL ree ee  oO Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message              251 GOUNA 4 e pa eE PES Kone        T 254    B Vehicle Loading                esee 252 W Ground Clearance        EE EE ee 254    196 STARTING AND OPERATING NN Id  STARTING PROCEDURES    Before starting your vehicle  adjust your seat  adjust the   inside and outside mirrors  fasten your seat belt  and if e Never leave children alone in a vehicle  Leaving   present  instruct all other occupants to buckle their seat children in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for   belts  a number of reasons  A child or others could be  seriously or fatally injured  Don t leave the keys  in the ignition  A child could operate power  windows  other controls  or move the vehicle     Do not leave animals or children inside parked  vehicles in hot weather  interior heat build up  may cause serious injury or death     Be sure to tu
180. ger Modules  mounted in three of the four  wheel wells     e Various Tire Pressure Monitoring System Messages   which display in the Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC     e Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light    Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings   1  The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will  ref illuminate in the instrument cluster and an audible  chime will sound when tire pressure is low in one  or more of the four active road tires  The audible chime  will sound once every ignition cycle for each condition  that it detects  In addition  the Electronic Vehicle Infor   mation Center  EVIC  will display one or more Low  Pressure messages  Left Front  Left Rear  Right Front   Right Rear  for 3 seconds and a graphic showing the  pressure values of each tire with the low tire pressure    values flashing  Should this occur  you should stop as  soon as possible  and inflate the tires with low pressure   those flashing in the EVIC graphic  to the vehicle s  recommended cold placard pressure value  Once the  system receives the updated tire pressures  the system  will automatically update  the graphic display in the  EVIC will stop flashing  and the Tire Pressure Monitoring  Telltale Light will turn off  The vehicle may need to be  driven for up to 10 minutes above 15 mph  25 km h  in  order for the TPMS to receive this information  Low  pressure in the spare tire will not cause the Tire Pressure  Monitoring Telltale Light to illuminate or the chi
181. he LOAD EJT button and the push   button with the corresponding number where  the CD was loaded and the disc will unload  and move to the entrance for easy removal   Radio display will show  EJECTING DISC  when the disc  is being ejected and prompt the user to remove the disc     LOAD    If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within  15 seconds  it will be reloaded  If the CD is not removed   the radio will continue to play the non removed CD  If  the CD is removed and there are other CD s in the radio   the radio will play the next CD after a 2 minute timeout   If the CD is removed and there are no other CD s in the  radio  the radio will remain in CD mode and display   INSERT DISC  for 2 minutes  After 2 minutes  the radio  will go to the previous tuner mode     INFO Button  CD Mode for MP3 Play    Press and INFO button while playing MP3 or WMA disc   The radio scrolls through the following TAG information   Song Title  Artist  File Name  and Folder Name  if avail   able      Press the INFO button once more to return to  elapsed  time  priority mode    Press and hold the INFO button while in the message  display priority mode or elapsed time display priority  mode will display the song title for each file    RW FF  CD Mode for MP3 and WMA Play     Press the FF side of the button to move forward through  the file or MP3 and WMA selection     TUNE Control  CD Mode for MP3 Play   Pressing the TUNE Control allows the adjustment of  Tone  Balance  and Fade     AM FM 
182. he current setting  refer to  Flash Lights    with Remote Key Lock   under  Personal Settings  Cus   tomer Programmable Features   under  Electronic Ve   hicle Information Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this  manual     Turn Headlights On with Remote Key Unlock   This feature activates the headlights for up to 90 seconds  when the doors are unlocked with the transmitter  The  time for this feature is programmable  For details on how  to change the current setting  refer to  Turn Headlights  On with Remote Key Unlock   under  Personal Settings   Customer Programmable Features    under  Electronic  Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this  manual     To lock the doors    Press and release the LOCK button on the transmitter to  lock all doors  The turn signal lights will flash and the  horn will chirp to acknowledge the signal     Sound Horn with Remote Key Lock   This feature will cause the horn to chirp when the doors  are locked with the transmitter  This feature can be  enabled or disabled  For details on how to change the  current setting  refer to  Sound Horn with Remote Key    NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19    Lock  under  Personal Settings  Customer Program   mable Features      under  Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this manual     To unlatch the trunk   Press the trunk button on the transmitter two times to  unlatch the trunk     Using The Panic Alarm    To turn the panic alarm feature ON or OFF  press an
183. heck when the ignition switch is first  turned ON  If the light is either not on    138 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    during starting  or stays on  or turns on while driving   then have the system inspected at your authorized  dealer as soon as possible   See page 46 for more  information      12  Brake System Warning Light  This light monitors various brake functions   BRAKE including brake fluid level and parking  brake application  If the brake light turns on   it may indicate that the parking brake is  applied  that the brake fluid level is low  or that there  is a problem with the anti lock brake system     The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capac   ity to a portion of the hydraulic system in the event of a  failure  Failure of either half of the dual brake system is  indicated by the Brake Warning Light  which will turn on  when the brake fluid level in the master cylinder drops  below a specified level     The light will remain on until the cause is corrected     NOTE  The light may flash momentarily during sharp  cornering maneuvers due to a change in fluid level  If so   the vehicle should have service performed and the brake  fluid level checked     Immediate repair is necessary if brake failure is indicated     WARNINCG     Driving a vehicle with the brake light on is danger     ous  Part of the brake system may have failed  It will  take longer to stop the vehicle  You could have an  accident  Have the vehicle checked immediately     
184. here is  no need to remove the radiator cap unless checking for  coolant freeze point or replacing coolant  Advise your  service attendant of this  As long as the engine operating  temperature is satisfactory  the coolant bottle need only  be checked once a month     When additional coolant is needed to maintain the  proper level  it should be added to the coolant bottle  Do  not overfill     Points To Remember    NOTE  When the vehicle is stopped after a few miles   kilometers  of operation  you may observe vapor coming  from the front of the engine compartment  This is nor   mally a result of moisture from rain  snow  or high    N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 291    humidity accumulating on the radiator and being vapor   ized when the thermostat opens  allowing hot coolant to  enter the radiator     If an examination of your engine compartment shows no  evidence of radiator or hose leaks  the vehicle may be  safely driven  The vapor will soon dissipate     Do not overfill the coolant recovery bottle     Check coolant freeze point in the radiator and in the  coolant recovery bottle  If antifreeze needs to be  added  contents of coolant recovery bottle must also be  protected against freezing     If frequent coolant additions are required  or if the  level in the coolant recovery bottle does not drop when  the engine cools  the cooling system should be pres   sure tested for leaks     Maintain coolant concentration at 50  HOAT engine  coolant  minimum  and distilled water for pro
185. hone and Network Status Indicators   If available on the radio and or on a premium display  such as the instrument panel cluster  and supported by  your cell phone  the UConnect    system will provide  notification to inform you of your phone and network  status when you are attempting to make a phone call  using UConnect     The status is given for roaming net   work signal strength  phone battery strength  etc        78 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    Dialing Using the Cellular Phone Keypad   You can dial a phone number with your cellular phone  keypad and still use the UConnect    system  while  dialing via the cell phone keypad  the user must exercise  caution and take precautionary safety measures   By  dialing a number with your paired Bluetooth   cellular  phone  the audio will be played through your vehicle s  audio system  The UConnect    system will work the  same as if you dial the number using voice recognition     NOTE  Certain brands of mobile phones do not send  the dial ring to the UConnect    system to play it on the  vehicle audio system  so you will not hear it  Under this  situation  after successfully dialing a number  the user  may feel that the call did not go through even though the  call is in progress  Once your call is answered  you will  hear the audio     Mute Un mute  Mute off    When you mute the UConnect   system  you will still be  able to hear the conversation coming from the other  party  but the oth
186. hose off the undercarriage at least once Wheel and Wheel Trim Care  a month     All wheels and wheel trim  especially aluminum and  e It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges chrome plated wheels should be cleaned regularly with a    of the doors  rocker panels  and trunk be kept clear mild soap and water to prevent corrosion  To remove  and open  heavy soil and or excessive brake dust  use Mopar     Wheel Cleaner  05066247AB  or equivalent or select a  nonabrasive  non acidic cleaner  Do not use scouring  pads  steel wool  a bristle brush  or metal polishes  Only  Mopar or equivalent is recommended  Do not use oven  e If your vehicle is damaged due to an accident or cleaner  Avoid automatic car washes that use acidic  similar cause  which destroys the paint and protective solutions or harsh brushes that may damage the wheels     coating  have your vehicle repaired as soon as pos  protective finish   sible  The cost of such repairs is considered the respon   sibility of the owner        e If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint   touch them up immediately  The cost of such repairs is  considered the responsibility of the owner     298 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    Interior Care  Use Mopar  Fabric Cleaner or equivalent to clean fabric  upholstery and Mopar  Carpet Cleaner for carpeting     Interior Trim should be cleaned starting with a damp  cloth  or Mopar  Satin Select  Do not use harsh cleaners  or Armorall  Use Mopar  Total Clean to clea
187. hten all three straps as you push the  child restraint rearward and downward into the seat   removing slack in the straps according to the child  restraint manufacturer   s instructions     NOTE    e Ensure that the tether strap does not slip into the  opening between the seat backs as you remove slack in  the strap     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53    e When using the LATCH attaching system to install a WARNING   child restraint  please ensure that all seat belts not    being used for occupant restraints are stowed and out Improper installation of a child restraint to the  of reach of children  It is recommended that before LATCH anchorages can lead to failure of an infant or  installing the child restraint  buckle the seat belt so the child restraint  The child could be badly injured or  seat belt is tucked behind the child restraint and out of killed  Follow the manufacturer s directions exactly    reach  If the buckled seat belt interferes with the child when installing an infant or child restraint   restraint installation  instead of tucking the seat belt  behind the child restraint  route the seat belt through  the child restraint belt path and then buckle it  This  should stow the seat belt out of the reach of an  inquisitive child  Remind all children in the vehicle  that the seat belts are not toys and should not be  played with  and never leave your child unattended in  the vehicle        Installing Child Restraints Using the Vehicle Seat  belt  
188. icle systems and features  They show  exactly how to find and correct problems the first time   using step by step troubleshooting and driveability  procedures  proven diagnostic tests and a complete list  of all tools and equipment     IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE NN    Owner s Manuals     These manuals have been prepared with the assistance  of service and engineering specialists to acquaint you  with specific Chrysler group vehicles  Included are  starting  operating  emergency and maintenance pro   cedures as well as specifications  capabilities and  safety tips     Call Toll Free at     Or    1 800 890 4038  U S    1 800 387 1143  Canada     Visit us on the World Wide Web at     www techauthority daimlerchrysler com    e www daimlerchrysler ca manuals    N F YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 343    DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM  TIRE QUALITY GRADES   The following describes the tire grading categories estab   lished by the National highway Traffic Safety Adminis   tration  The specific grade rating assigned by the tire s  manufacturer in each category is shown on the sidewall  of the tires on your car     All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform to Federal Safety  Requirements in Addition to These Grades     Treadwear   The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the  wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled con   ditions on a specified government test course  For ex   ample  a tire graded 150 would wear one and a half  1  1 2  times as well on the g
189. ific vehicle  data parameters  see list below  in an event data recorder  prior to the moment of airbag deployment  Please note  that such data are ONLY recorded if an airbag deploys   and are otherwise unavailable  In conjunction with other  data gathered during a complete accident investigation     the electronic data may be used by DaimlerChrysler and  others to learn more about the possible causes of crashes  and associated injuries in order to assess and improve  vehicle performance  In addition to crash investigations  initiated by DaimlerChrysler  such investigations may be  requested by customers  insurance carriers  government  officials  and professional crash researchers  such as those  associated with universities  and with hospital and insur   ance organizations     In the event that an investigation is undertaken by  DaimlerChrysler  regardless of initiative   the company  or its designated representative will first obtain permis   sion of the appropriate custodial entity for the vehicle   usually the vehicle owner or lessee  before accessing the  electronic data stored  unless ordered to download data  by a court with legal jurisdiction  ie    pursuant to a  warrant   A copy of the data will be provided to the  custodial entity upon request  General data that does not  identify particular vehicles or crashes may be released for  incorporation in aggregate crash databases  such as those  maintained by the US government and various states   Data of a potentially 
190. in the normal range indicates that  the engine cooling system is operating satisfactorily     The gauge pointer will likely indicate a higher tempera   ture when driving in hot weather  up mountain grades   or when towing a trailer  It should not be allowed to  exceed the upper limits of the normal operating range     CAUTION     Driving with a hot cooling system could damage  your vehicle  If temperature gauge reads 240  F   116  C  or greater  pull over and stop the vehicle  Idle    the vehicle with the air conditioner turned off until  the pointer drops back into the normal range 200   230 F  93 110 C   If the pointer remains at 240 F   116  C  or greater and you hear a chime  turn the  engine off immediately  and call for service        140 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    WARNING     A hot engine cooling system is dangerous  You or  others could be badly burned by steam or boiling  coolant  You may want to call a service center if your    vehicle overheats  If you decide to look under the  hood yourself  see Section 7 of this manual  Follow  the warnings under the Cooling System Pressure  Cap paragraph     15  Trip Odometer Button   Press this button to change the display from odometer to  either of two trip odometer settings  The letter    A    or    B     will appear when in the trip odometer mode  Push in and  hold the button for two seconds to reset the trip odometer  to 0 miles  kilometers   The odometer must be in trip  mode to reset it     16  High Be
191. indicator fails to light  when the lever is moved  it would suggest that the fuse  or indicator is defective or there may be a circuit failure     NOTE  A    Turn Signal On  message will appear in the  Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC  and a con   tinuous chime will sound if the vehicle is driven more  than 1 mile  1 6 km  with either turn signal on     Highbeam Lowbeam Select Switch   Push the Multi Function Lever away from you to switch  the headlights to HIGH beam  Pull the Lever towards  you to switch the headlights back to LOW beam     Flash to Pass   You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by  lightly pulling the Multi Function Lever toward you   This will cause the headlights to turn on at high beam  and remain on until the lever is released        Overhead Console Map Reading Lights  These lights are mounted between the sun visors on the  overhead console  Each light is turned ON by pressing  the lens  Press the lens a second time to turn OFF the  light  These lights also turn on when a door is opened  or  when the unlock button on the remote keyless entry  transmitter is pressed  or when the dimmer control is  turned fully upward  past the second detent     IN doe H Hy   EM E I    EM E      m  ETE  x  E  3  z    pa         REF     p iB  ee    8125e174    Overhead Console       100 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    Interior Lights  The interior lights come on when a door is opened     To protect the battery  the interior lights wil
192. inue to follow the system prompts to complete  language selection     After selecting one of the languages  all prompts and  voice commands will be in that language     NOTE  After every UConnect    language change op   eration  only the language specific 32 name phonebook is  usable  The paired phone name is not language specific  and usable across all languages        Emergency Assistance  If you are in an emergency and the mobile phone is  reachable     e Pick up the phone and manually dial the emergency  number for your area     If the phone is not reachable and the UConnect    system  is operational  you may reach the emergency number as  follows     e Press the    Phone    button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Emergency  and the UConnect    system will instruct  the paired cellular phone to call the emergency num   ber  This feature is only supported in the USA     76 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    NOTE  The emergency number dialed is based on the  Country where the vehicle is purchased  911 for USA and  Canada and 060 for Mexico   The number dialed may not  be applicable with the available cellular service and area     The UConnect    system does slightly lower your  chances of successfully making a phone call as to that  for the cell phone directly     Your phone must be turned on and paired to the  UConnect    system to allow use of this vehicle feature  in emergency situations when th
193. io station preset frequencies  CD e Right Rear Turn Signal Light Out  with a single chime   MODE disc number  CD track number  tape  or any  Button one of 200 Satellite radio channels depending  on which radio is in the vehicle  e Memory 111 32 Profile Set    e Left Front Turn Signal Light Out  with a single chime     Right Front Turn Signal Light Out  with a single  chime     e RKE Battery Low  with a single chime     Memory  1  2 Profile Recall    Memory System Disabled   Vehicle Not In Park  with  a single chime     Memory System Disabled   Seat Belt Buckled  with a  single chime     Personal Settings Not Available     Vehicle Not in Park    Left  Right Front Door Ajar  one or more  with a single  chime if speed is above 1 mph  1 6 km      Left Right Rear Door Ajar  one or more  with a single  chime if speed is above 1 mph  1 6 km      Door s  Ajar  with a single chime if vehicle is in  motion     Trunk Ajar  with a single chime   Low Washer Fluid  with a single chime     Adjustable Pedals Disabled     Cruise Engaged  with a  single chime      only available on vehicles equipped  with memory seats     146 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    Adjustable Pedals Disabled   Vehicle In Reverse  with  a single chime      only available on vehicles equipped  with memory seats     Channel 1  2  OR 3 Transmit  Channel 1  2  OR 3 Training  Channel 1  2  OR 3 Trained  Clearing Channels   Channels Cleared   Channels Defaulted   Did Not Train    Left Front Low Pressure  with a
194. ion Lever     ou oe deb ER DER ER 98  O Overhead Console Map Reading Lights        99  Senor Hie  siuen oe LEK Hd bs pups aos 6 100  ll Windshield Wipers And Washers            101  O Intermittent Wiper System                 101  Niel Feature s an ope dcr d eed GR ey oh 102  OWindshield Washers essre ty wav goes ises  102  o Headlights On With Wipers            LLL  102  H Rain Sensing Wipers  siens sd io kR ER RR 102  E Adding Washer Fluid uarie 9s 104  B Headlight Washers            esses 105  o Adding Washer Fluid x v4 106  E Power Tilt Telescoping Steering Column       107    W Adjustable Pedals                    4   108    NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 61    W Electronic Speed Control                   109  O Electronic Speed Control Operation          109  sop reip  EE 110  o To Set At A Desired Speed ii succ mer rs 110  H TOHDSGCBVAIB esege SKAARS Sa seen nayki 110  Olo Resume eed  snr PR ee qon d RE ot 4 110  o To Vary The Speed Setting ss mes enn 111  o To Accelerate For Passing ss  111   Bl Rear Park Assist System                   112   W Overhead Console                ssssse 115  H Courtesv  Readin   Lights si sae Rr RAS RS 115  Hounslasses StOrage 4 a chee a Veces vor ace oh dons 115   lll Garage Door Opener  HomeLink9            116  O Programming HomeLink                  117    O Canadian Programming  Gate Programming    119    D Using HomeLink    H Erasing HomeLink Buttons  O Reprogramming a Single HomeLink Button      120  sri  ACT        
195. ir pump to run for five minutes and then  read the pressure gauge  4   If the tire inflates to 26 psi   1 8 bar  or greater  proceed to Step 19 of this procedure   If not  proceed to the following step     11  Press the air pump switch  3  to 0  OFF   Then   disconnect the TIREFIT system from the tire and place it  back in the vehicle     12  Release the parking brake and drive the vehicle back  and forth approximately 30 feet  9 1 m  to distribute the  sealant more evenly within the tire     13  Turn on the hazard warning flashers     14  Move the transmission selector lever to the PARK  position  turn off the engine  and set the parking brake     15  Disconnect the air pump hose  1  from the underside  of the sealant bottle  5  by flipping the hose valve open     16  Connect the air pump hose valve to the tire valve and  flip the hose valve closed     17  Leave the parking brake set and the transmission  selector lever in PARK and start the engine     18  Press the switch  3  on the air pump to I  ON   The air  pump should inflate the tire to at least 26 psi  1 8 bar   within five minutes  If the tire inflates to this level   proceed to the following step  NOTE  If a tire pressure of  26 psi  1 8 bar  is not obtained within five minutes  the  tire is too badly damaged  Do not attempt to drive the  vehicle further  Call for assistance     NN WHATTODOI NEMERGENCIES 261    19  With a tire pressure of no less than 26 psi  1 8 bar   press the air pump switch  3  to 0  OFF  and t
196. isor Vanity Lights                   0   A6220  Glove Box Ie BE seais ie eee gtr RE s panes 194  Door Courtesy id aad uma RE e ELA de Rea 562  Shift Indicator  Light  ess sara tnr JKLE14140    NOTE  For lighted switches  see your dealer for re   placement instructions     All of the interior bulbs are glass wedge base or glass  cartridge types  Aluminum base bulbs are not approved  and should not be used for replacement     LIGHT BULBS     Exterior Bulb Number    Low Beam Headlight   High    Intensity Discharge  HID              isses DIS   Serviced at Dealer   High Beam Headlight    1 4 uar ere gc e 9005    Front Park  Turn Lights oo ei scd v   dg 3157AK    Front Fog Light          9145 H10  Serviced at Dealer   Front Side Marker          W5W  Serviced at Dealer   TOL top DE S 2 21 93 308 3 9 RADE EP SA OUD 3057  IDEE DU uo ood ee IT Sopra taro Poe d RP 0057  Turn Signal EISE  ea ssia RC e a op cg ob eges 3057  Packup EIE Hb eau or PERK ARE So ddr OE ie 3057  Center High Mount Stop Light  CHMSL         LED  IIGCNSS 454 aes ooh en aa ee OE OR AN W5W    BULB REPLACEMENT    Low Beam Headlight  High Beam Headlight  and  Park Turn Light    High Intensity Discharge Headlights  HID    The headlights are a type of high voltage discharge tube   High voltage can remain in the circuit even with the  headlight switch off and the key removed  Because of  this  you should not attempt to service a headlight bulb  yourself  If a headlight bulb fails  take your vehicle to  an authorized deal
197. ission    Fluid Level Check  Regular automatic transmission fluid level checks are not  required  For this reason  the dipstick is omitted     If you notice fluid loss or gear shift malfunction  have  your authorized dealer check the transmission fluid level     N S NN MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 295    CAUTION     e Using a transmission fluid other than the manu   facturer s recommended fluid may cause deterio   ration in transmission shift quality and or torque  converter shudder  Using a transmission fluid  other than that recommended by the manufac   turer will result in more frequent fluid and filter  changes  Refer to  Fluids  Lubricants  and Genu     ine Parts  for the correct fluid type     The fluid level is preset at the factory and it does  not require adjustment under normal operating  conditions  If a transmission fluid leak occurs   visit your authorized dealer immediately  Severe  damage to the transmission may occur  Your au   thorized dealer has the proper tools to adjust the  fluid level accurately     Fluid and Filter Changes  Automatic transmission fluid and filter should be  changed as follows     Normal Usage     No change necessary       Severe Usage  fluid and filter      Refer to Maintenance  Schedule  B     Severe Usage is defined as     e Police  taxi  limousine  commercial type operation  or  trailer towing where the vehicle is driven regularly for  more than 45 minutes of continuous operation     If the transmission is disassembled for any reason  th
198. ity of catalyst damage     e Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition  when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in  motion     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 281    e Do not try to start engine by pushing or towing the  vehicle     EERS RE EER    e Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires  disconnected or removed  such as when diagnostic  testing  or for prolonged periods during very rough  idling or malfunctioning operating conditions                                2    EL  RR RR    Maintenance Free Battery   The top of the MAINTENANCE FREE battery is perma   nently sealed  You will never have to add water  nor is  periodic maintenance required        NOTE  The battery is stored under an access cover in  the trunk  Remote battery terminals are located in the  engine compartment for jump starting     Battery Location       e Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution and can  burn or even blind you  Don t allow battery fluid  to contact your eyes  skin  or clothing  Don t lean  over a battery when attaching clamps  If acid  splashes in eyes or on skin  flush the area imme   diately with large amounts of water     Battery gas is flammable and explosive  Keep  flame or sparks away from the battery  Don t use  a booster battery or any other booster source with  an output greater than 12 volts  Don t allow cable  clamps to touch each other     Battery posts  terminals  and related accessories  contain lead and lead compounds  Wash hands  after handling 
199. iven  You  can also break the commands into parts and say each  part of the command  when you are asked for it  For  example  you can use the combined form voice com   mand  Phonebook New Entry  or you can break the  combined form command into two voice commands    Phonebook  and  New Entry   Please remember  the  UConnect    system works best when you talk in a  normal conversational tone  as if speaking to some one  sitting eight feet away from you     Voice Command Tree  Refer to  Voice Tree  at the end of this section     Help Command   If you need assistance at any prompt  or if you want to  know your options are at any prompt  say  Help  follow   ing the voice on beep  The UConnect    system will play  all the options at any prompt if you ask for help     To activate the UConnect    system from idle  simply  press the  Phone  button and follow audible prompts for  directions  All UConnect    system sessions begin with a  press of the    Phone    button on the mirror     Cancel Command   At any prompt  after the voice on beep  you can say   Cancel    and you will be returned to the main menu   However  in a few instances the system will take you  back to the previous menu     Pair  Link  UConnect    System to a Cellular Phone  To begin using your UConnect    system  you must pair  your compatible Bluetooth    enabled cellular phone     NOTE  The UConnect    system use requires a cellular  phone equipped with the Bluetooth  Hands Free Profile      version 0 96 or higher  
200. iversal Transceiver   Do not train the transceiver if people or pets are in  the path of the door or gate  A moving door or gate  can cause serious injury or death to people and  pets or damage to objects        NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 117    Programming HomeLink    NOTE  When programming a garage door opener  it is  advised to park outside the garage  It is also recom   mended that you install a new battery in the hand held  transmitter of the device being programmed  This will  allow for quicker training and accurate transmission of  the radio frequency signal     The Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC  fea   tures a driver interactive display  which includes  HomeLink system messages  The EVIC is located in the  upper part of the cluster between the speedometer and  tachometer  Electronic Vehicle Information Center        amp 1Bc9c36    118 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    1  Press and hold the two outer HomeLink buttons   Release the buttons only when the EVIC displays  Chan   nels Cleared   after 20 seconds   however  do not hold  the buttons for longer than 30 seconds  Do not repeat this  step if programming a second or third hand held trans   mitter to the remaining HomeLink buttons        8125a18h    HomeLink Buttons    2  Position the end of your hand held transmitter 1 3  inches  3 8 cm  away from the HomeLink buttons     3  Simultaneously press and hold the HomeLink button   that you want to train  and the hand held tra
201. k  it indicates that there is  a problem with the electronics  In addition  if the light  begins to flash after the bulb check  it indicates that  someone used an invalid key to start the engine  Either of  these conditions will result in the engine being shut off  after two  2  seconds     If the Vehicle Security Alarm Indicator Light turns on  during normal vehicle operation  vehicle running for  longer than 10 seconds   it indicates that there is a fault in  the electronics  Should this occur  have the vehicle ser   viced as soon as possible     NOTE    e The Sentry Key Immobilizer System is not compatible  with remote starting systems  Use of these systems  may result in vehicle starting problems and loss of  security protection     e Exxon Mobil Speed Pass     additional Sentry Keys  or  any other transponder equipped components on the  same key chain will not cause a key related  tran   sponder  fault unless the additional part is physi   cally held against the ignition key being used  when starting the vehicle  Cell phones  pagers  or  other RF electronics will not cause interference with  this system     All of the keys provided with your new vehicle have  been programmed to the vehicle electronics     Replacement Keys    NOTE  Only keys that are programmed to the vehicle  electronics can be used to start and operate the vehicle   Once a Sentry Key is programmed to a vehicle  it cannot  be programmed to any other vehicle     At the time of purchase  the original owner
202. ke by locking the  transmission  The engine can be started in this range        Never use P  Park  while the vehicle is in motion   Apply the parking brake when leaving the vehicle in  this range     When parking on a flat surface  place the gear selector in  the P  Park  position first  and then apply the parking  brake     When parking on a hill  it is important to set the parking  brake before placing the gear selector in P  Park   other   wise the load on the transmission locking mechanism  may make it difficult to move the selector out of park  As  an added precaution  turn the front wheels toward the  curb on a downhill grade and away from the curb on an  uphill grade     WARNING     Never use Park position on an automatic transmis   sion as a substitute for the parking brake  Always    apply parking brake fully when parked to guard  against vehicle movement and possible injury or  damage           200 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    The following indicators should be used to ensure that  you have engaged the selector lever into the P  Park   position     e When shifting into P  Park  move the lever all the way  forward until it stops  and is fully seated     e Look at the shift indicator display on the instrument  panel to ensure it is in the P  Park  position     CAUTION     Damage to the shifter could result if the selector    lever is moved out of P  Park  before the ignition is  turned from the LOCK to ON position        R  Reverse   Shift into R  Reverse  gear on
203. ked or unlocked with the  remote keyless entry transmitter  This feature may be  selected with or without the sound horn on lock feature    selected  To make your selection  press and release the  FUNCTION SELECT button until  ON  or  OFF  ap   pears        Headlights On with Wipers    When ON is selected  and the headlight switch is in the  AUTO position  the headlights will turn on approxi   mately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on  The  headlights will also turn off when the wipers are turned  off if they were turned on by this feature  To make your  selection  press and release the FUNCTION SELECT  button until  ON  or  OFF  appears     NOTE  Turning the headlights on during the daytime  causes the instrument panel lights to dim  To increase the  brightness  refer to  Lights  in Section 3 of this manual      Delay Turning Headlights Off    When this feature is selected  the driver can choose to  have the headlights remain on for 0  30  60  or 90 seconds  when exiting the vehicle  To make your selection  press  and release the FUNCTION SELECT button until  0       30      60   or  90  appears     156 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id     Tilt Mirrors Down in Reverse    When ON is selected  the outside rearview mirrors will  tilt downward when the ignition switch is in the ON  position and the transmission is in the R  Reverse   position  The mirrors will move back to their previous  position when the transmission is shifted out of R  Re   verse   Io make y
204. l  on     NOTE  Check for a defective outside light bulb if either  indicator flashes at a rapid rate   See page 98 for more  information      5  Speedometer  Indicates vehicle speed     6  Electronic Vehicle Information Center Display  This display shows the Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC  messages when the appropriate conditions  exist   See page 144 for more information      Loose Fuel Filler Cap    If the vehicle diagnostic system determines that the fuel  filler cap is loose  improperly installed  or damaged  a   Check Gascap  message will display in the Electronic  Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   Tighten the fuel filler  cap properly and press the odometer reset button to turn  off the message  If the problem continues  the message  will appear the next time the vehicle is started     A loose  improperly installed  or damaged fuel filler cap  may also turn on the Malfunction Indicator Light  MIL     See page 272 for more information         7  Tachometer   The red segments indicate the maximum permissible  engine revolutions per minute  r p m  x 1000  for each  gear range  Ease up on the accelerator before reaching the  red area     8  Engine Temperature Warning Light   This light will turn on and a single chime will  sound to warn of an overheated engine condi   tion  When this light turns on  the engine tem   perature is critically hot  The vehicle should be turned  off immediately and serviced as soon as possible   See  page 256 for more information 
205. l be Flowchart    FI hart  used  The phones paired zia    are available across all  languages        Number    associated Number  with entry is Dialed  is dialed    Note  Available Voice commands are shown in bold face and are underlined  41940226    NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 83    Voice Tree   Phonebook Phonebook       Era N Entries Listed one  at a time        Enter Name 1st Confirmation  Enter Location end Gonfirmatian  Entry Deleted       Gurrent Number  Enter New       Phonebook  Cleared       Entry is modified    Note  Available Voice commands are shown in bold face and are underlined  81315294       84 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE    Voice Tree   Setup     Setup      Confirmation    Confirmation will    Prompts    aelect a language   English  Espanol    or Francais    temporarily       priorities     to be deleted    Say 4 digit override  pin code  Phones phone  EE dus List Phones       Systern System Lists    Phone Deleted confirms Phones    All Phones  Deleted       Note  Available Voice commands are shown in bold face and are underlined  81940224    NE UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 85       North American English SEATS  Primary Alternate s  Power Seats  Zero Oh The power seat switch is on the outboard side of the seat  Add location Add new near the floor  Use this switch to move the driver   s seat  All Allot them up or down  forward or rearward  or to tilt the seat  The 3  Confirmation prompts Confirmations prompts pas
206. l be thrown about and possibly  injured  or injure a passenger during panic braking or in  a collision        Pets should be restrained in the rear seat in pet harnesses  or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts     BREAK IN RECOMMENDATIONS  A long break in period is not required for the drivetrain   engine  transmission  and rear axle  in your new vehicle     Drive moderately during the first 500 miles  800 km    After the initial 60 miles  100 km   speeds up to 50 or 55  mph  80 or 90 km h  are desirable     While cruising  brief full throttle acceleration  within the  limits of local traffic laws  contributes to a good break in   However  wide open throttle acceleration in low gear can  be detrimental and should be avoided     The engine oil  transmission fluid  and axle lubricant  installed at the factory is high quality and energy con   serving  Oil  fluid  and lubricant changes should be  consistent with anticipated climate and conditions under  which vehicle operations will occur  The recommended  viscosity and quality grades is shown in Section 7 of this  manual        56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    CAUTION     Never use Non Detergent Oil or Straight Mineral  Oil in the engine or damage may result        NOTE  Anew engine may consume some oil during its  first few thousand miles  kilometers  of operation  This  should be considered as a normal part of the break in and  not interpreted as an indication of difficulty     SAFETY TIPS    Transpo
207. l turn off  automatically 10 minutes after the ignition switch is  moved to the LOCK position  This will occur if the  interior lights were switched on manually or are on  because a door is open  This includes the glove box light   but not the trunk light  To restore interior light operation   either turn the ignition switch ON or cycle the light  switch     Dimmer Control   3 The dimmer control is part of the  headlight switch  and is located on the  left side of the instrument panel  With  the parking lights or headlights on   rotating the dimmer control upward    will increase the brightness of the in     strument panel lights        Dome Light Position   Rotate the dimmer control completely upward to the  second detent to turn on the interior lights  The interior  lights will remain on when the dimmer control is in this  position     Interior light Defeat  OFF    Rotate the dimmer control to the extreme bottom    OFF     position  The interior lights will remain off when the  doors are open     Parade Mode  Daytime Brightness Feature    Rotate the dimmer control upward to the first detent   This feature brightens all text displays such as the  odometer  Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC    and radio when the parking lights or headlights are on        UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 101    GES  The multifunction lever operates the windshi   amp  Ihe multi function lever operates the windshield  wipers and washer when the ignition switch is in  the ON p
208. late  grasp and twist the belt webbing 180  to create a  fold that begins immediately above the latch plate     3  Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing   The folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of the  latch plate     4  Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the  folded webbing     Seat Belt Pretensioners   The seat belts for both front seating positions are  equipped with pretensioning devices that are designed to  remove any slack from the seat belts in the event of a  collision  These devices improve the performance of the  seat belt system by assuring that the belt is tight about the  occupant in a collision  Pretensioners work for all size  occupants  including those in child restraints     NOTE  These devices are not a substitute for proper  seat belt placement by the occupant  The seat belt still  must be worn snugly and positioned properly     The pretensioners are triggered by the Airbag Control  Module  refer to information on Airbags in this section    Like the front airbags  the pretensioners are single use  items  After a collision that is severe enough to deploy  the airbags and pretensioners  both must be replaced     Enhanced Seat Belt Reminder System  BeltAlert   If the driver s seat belt has not been buckled within 60  seconds of starting the vehicle and if the vehicle speed is  greater than 5 mph  8 km h   the Enhanced Warning  System  BeltAlert  will alert the driver to buckle their seat  belt  The driver should als
209. ld be cleaned on a regular basis  with Mopar   Glass Cleaner or any commercial  household type glass cleaner  Never use an abrasive type    N A NN MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 299    cleaner  Use caution when cleaning the inside rear win   dow equipped with electric defrosters or the right rear  quarter window equipped with the radio antenna  Do  not use scrapers or other sharp instruments  which may  scratch the elements     When cleaning the rear view mirror  spray cleaner on the  towel or rag that you are using  Do not spray cleaner  directly on the mirror     Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster Lenses   The lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle are  molded in clear plastic  When cleaning the lenses  care  must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic     1  Clean with a wet soft rag or micro fiber towel  A mild  soap solution may be used  but do not use high alcohol  content or abrasive cleaners  If soap is used  wipe clean  with a clean damp rag     2  Dry with a soft tissue     Seat Belt Maintenance   Do not bleach  dye  or clean the belts with chemical  solvents or abrasive cleaners  This will weaken the fabric   Sun damage can also weaken the fabric     If the belts need cleaning  use Mopar  Total Clean  a mild  soap solution  or lukewarm water  Do not remove the  belts from the vehicle to wash them     Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the  buckles do not work properly     Cleaning the Center Console Cup Holders  Clean with a damp cloth o
210. ld be replaced after six    years  regardless of the remaining tread  Failure to  follow this warning can result in sudden tire failure   You could lose control and have an accident result   ing in serious injury or death     These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread   grooves  They will appear as bands when the tread depth Keep dismounted tires in a cool  dry place with as little  becomes 1 16 inch  2 mm   When the tread is worn to the exposure to light as possible  Protect tires from contact  tread wear indicators  the tire should be replaced  with oil  grease  and gasoline     Many states have laws requiring tire replacement at this  point     234 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    Replacement Tires   The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many  characteristics  They should be inspected regularly for  wear and correct cold tire inflation pressure  The manu   facturer strongly recommends that you use tires equiva   lent to the originals in size  quality and performance  when replacement is needed  refer to the paragraph on     Tread Wear Indicators    Refer to the    Tire and Loading  Information  placard for the size designation of your tire   The service description and load identification will be  found on the original equipment tire  Failure to use  equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the  safety  handling  and ride of your vehicle  We recommend  that you contact your original equipment or an autho   rized tire dealer with any ques
211. le  A single chime will sound when this light   turns on     Do not operate the vehicle until the cause is corrected   This light does not show how much oil is in the engine   The engine oil level must be checked using the procedure  shown in section 7   See page 275 for more information         144 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL M    ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER   EVIC        B1Br8c36    Electronic Vehicle Information Center    The Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC  fea   tures a driver interactive display  It is located in the  upper part of the cluster between the speedometer and  tachometer  Vehicles equipped with steering wheel  mounted buttons  described in this section  are also  equipped with the EVIC  The EVIC consists of the  following     e System Status    e Vehicle information warning message displays   e Tire Pressure Monitor System  if equipped    e Personal Settings  customer programmable features   e Compass display   e Outside temperature display   e Trip computer functions    e UConnect M hands free communication system dis   plays  if equipped   e Navigation system screens  if equipped     e Audio mode display    The system allows the driver to select information by   pressing the following buttons mounted on the steering  wheel    Press and release the MENU button and the   mode displayed will change between Trip   Functions  Navigation  if equipped   System   MENU Status  Personal Settings  and Telephone  if   Button equipped     
212. leaner and a soft cloth to clean  the glass panel     Ignition Off Operation   The power sunroof switch will remain active for up to 60  minutes after the ignition switch is turned off  Opening  either front door will cancel this feature  The time for this  feature is programmable  For details  refer to  Delay  Power Off to Accessories Until Exit     under  Personal       124 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    Settings  Customer Programmable Features   under   Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in Sec   tion 4 of this manual     Sunroof Fully Closed  Press the switch forward and release to ensure that the  sunroof is fully closed     ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS  There are two 12 volt electrical outlets on this vehicle   Both of the outlets are protected by a fuse     The 12 volt power outlet next to the ash receiver tray  if  equipped with an optional Smoker s Package  has power  available only when the ignition is on  This outlet will  also operate a conventional cigar lighter unit     WARNINCG     Do not place ashes inside the cubby bin located on    the center console on vehicles not equipped with the  ash receiver tray  A fire leading to bodily injury  could result        NOTE  If desired  the power outlet next to the ash  receiver tray  if equipped  can be converted by your  authorized dealer to provide power with the ignition  switch in the LOCK position        Front Power Outlet    NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 125    The center con
213. leaner filter    Inspect the front and rear brake linings and rotors     Replace the spark plugs   Check and replace  if necessary  the PCV valve   t    Flush and replace the engine coolant at 102 000  miles if not done at 60 months        M  A      N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8    Replace the air conditioning filter   Rotate the tires         84   90   96   HENNE SES  EEN EE X poo   EEN o  X p jo  Check and Inspect the accessory drive belt and ten  X  E  LLL X E LL  EE EE X b  NE EE OE EE  gt   MEEN EES GE GEE ee EE EE    M  A     N  T  E  N  A  N  C  E  S  C  H  E  D  U  L  E  S  8       334 SCHEDULE  A     Miles    Kilometers     Months    Change engine oil and engine oil filter    Inspect the air cleaner filter and replace if re   quired     Replace the air cleaner filter    Inspect the front and rear brake linings and rotors     Check and Inspect the accessory drive belt and ten   sioner  Replace if required     Check and replace  if necessary  the PCV valve       Replace the air conditioning filter     Flush and replace the engine coolant at 120  months  if not replaced at 102 000 miles     Rotate the tires     108 000   180 000    108     114 000   190 000     120 000   200 000     126 000   210 000        132 000   220 000        Miles   Kilometers    Months     SCHEDULE    A    335    138 000 144 000 150 000   230 000   240 000   250 000    138   144   150     Change engine oil and engine oil filter     Inspect the air cleaner filter and replac
214. lied  It does not show the degree of brake application  Your vehicle is equipped with dual hydraulic  BRAKE brake systems  If either of the two hydraulic  systems loses normal capability  the remaining  system will still function  There will be some  e Never leave children alone in a vehicle  Leaving loss of overall braking effectiveness  This may be evident  children in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for by increased pedal travel during application  greater    a number of reasons  A child or others could be pedal force required to slow or stop  and potential  seriously or fatally injured  Don t leave the keys activation of the Brake Warning Light        in the ignition  A child could operate power  windows  other controls  or move the vehicle     In the event power assist is lost for any reason  for  example  repeated brake applications with the engine off   Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged   the brakes will still function  The effort required to brake  before driving  failure to do so can lead to brake the vehicle will be much greater than that required with  failure  and an accident  the power system operating        Anti Lock Brake System   The Anti Lock Brake System provides increased vehicle  stability and brake performance under most braking con   ditions  The system automatically  pumps  the brakes  during severe braking conditions to prevent wheel lock up     The electronic brake force distribution  EBD  prevents the  rear wheels from over braking and
215. look under the  the fan control to HI  This allows the heater core to act as hood yourself  see Section 7  Maintenance  of this  a supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat manual  Follow the warnings under the Cooling    from the engine cooling system  System Pressure Cap paragraph     CAUTION  TIREFIT TIRE REPAIR    Small punctures  particularly those in the tread  can be  sealed with TIREFIT  Foreign objects  e g   screws or  nails  should not be removed from the tire  TIREFIT can  be used in outside temperatures down to approximately   4  F   20  C            Driving with a hot cooling system could damage  your vehicle  If temperature gauge reads 240  F   116  C  or greater pull over and stop the vehicle  Idle    the vehicle with the air conditioner turned off until  the pointer drops back into the normal range 200   230 F  93 110  C   If the pointer remains at 240  F   116  C  or greater and you hear a chime  turn the  engine off immediately  and call for service        258 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES M    The TIREFIT system is located under an access panel in  the trunk     CES  eo Toe  teens  Tene  Tee  Te ee  pr  pop          nMTecI     DOSE    fgg     te TsTll  ERA RRR RS  Db ve  t es   tes e  cee READ  zr    zo r0 T0072  IERE RE ee GAMMA MM TESTSUTUTT  Me ER ERAS ee eens  rrr ETTET EM    SERE   MP    IMMER   Deen   ene  KAMBAN  mr nnn   NRMNSNEMNS MN    Re Re RR BOE Re  susaysa  x e    aparra unuunu  ee ee         eee  rele te N  OE EL   TEER EER  tram mt  
216. ls the  operation of the headlights  parking lights  instru   ment panel lights  instrument panel light dimming  inte   rior lights  and fog lights          eee        PERETI    pd    MM He Bo Had    EE    Headlight Switch    UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 95    Rotate the headlight switch clockwise to the first detent  for parking light and instrument panel light operation   Turn it to the second detent for headlight  parking light   and instrument panel light operation     Automatic Headlights   This system automatically turns the headlights ON or  OFF according to ambient light levels  To turn the system  ON  rotate the headlight switch counter clockwise to the  AUTO  A  position  When the system is ON  the Head   light Time Delay feature is also ON  This means the  headlights will stay ON for up to 90 seconds after you  turn the ignition switch OFF  To turn the Automatic  System OFF  move the headlight switch out of the AUTO   A  position        96 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M       Headlight Switch    NOTE  The engine must be running before the head   lights will come ON in the Automatic mode     Headlights On with Wipers   When this feature is active  the headlights will turn on  approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on  if the headlight switch is placed in the AUTO position  In  addition  the headlights will turn off when the wipers are  turned off if they were turned on by this feature     The Headlights On with Wipers featur
217. ly when the vehicle is  completely stopped     N  Neutral    No power is transmitted from the engine to the drive  axle  When the brakes are released  the vehicle can be  moved freely  pushed or towed   Do not engage N     Neutral  position while driving except to coast when  the vehicle is in danger of skidding  e g   on icy roads      The engine may be started in this range  Use this range  for starting your vehicle if it is moving or being towed     CAUTION     Coasting the vehicle  or driving for any other reason  with selector lever in NEUTRAL can result in trans   mission damage     WARNING     Do not coast in N  Neutral  and never turn off the  ignition to coast down a hill  These are unsafe  practices that limit your response to changing traffic  or road conditions  You might lose control of the  vehicle and have an accident        ee STARTING AND OPERATING 205    D  Drive    This range should be used for most city and highway  driving  It provides the smoothest upshifts and down   shifts and best fuel economy     The transmission automatically upshifts through fifth  gear  The D  Drive  position provides optimum driving  characteristics under all normal operating conditions     When frequent transmission shifting occurs when using  the Overdrive range  such as when operating the vehicle  under heavy loading conditions  in hilly terrain  travel   ing into strong head winds  or while towing heavy  trailers  use the AutoStick   mode and select the    3     range     Aut
218. lytic con   verter will not require maintenance  However  it is im   portant to keep the engine properly tuned to assure  proper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalyst  damage        280 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    CAUTION  WARNING     Damage to the catalytic converter can result if your A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you park over  vehicle is not kept in proper operating condition  In materials that can burn  Such materials might be    the event of engine malfunction  particularly involv   ing engine misfire or other apparent loss of perfor     mance  have your vehicle serviced promptly  Contin   ued operation of your vehicle with a severe  malfunction could cause the converter to overheat   resulting in possible damage to the converter and the  vehicle     NOTE     against you        Intentional tampering with emissions control  systems can result in civil penalties being assessed    grass or leaves coming into contact with your ex   haust system  Do not park or operate your vehicle in  areas where your exhaust system can contact any   thing that can burn        In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioning  engine operation  a scorching odor may indicate severe  and abnormal catalyst overheating  If this should occur   safely bring the vehicle to a complete stop  shut the  engine off  and allow the vehicle to cool  Thereafter   obtain service  including a tune up to manufacturer   s  specifications immediately     To minimize the possibil
219. mation                 158  H Radio Broadcast Signals                   158   O Two pes Of Signals xs dives 993 n oes 158   O Electrical Disturbances awe a 5 ow w Exe dv d ares a 158  OAM RROCGDUIONE a dd ca dete dud SOR preci gd 8 d 158    AFM Recepto   ay rcis riag RUE REED     X Hehe 158       132 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    ll Sales Code RAK   AM FM Cassette CD  6 Disc   Radio With Optional Satellite Radio  Hands Free  Phone  Video  MP3  And WMA Capabilities   159    O Operating Instructions   Radio Mode         159  O Operating Instructions     Tape Player         162  Seek DURON sca Hos 3 4 84 SOR eed yt bE eee 163  O Fast Forward  FF       uds ves r9 s 163  O Rewind  RW  ides OR RO OR REOR edes 163  Hope Eet iss sk EE LAER SR ER RE ROER HS ES 163  El dik DURON oos sd ERA BROERS 163  oChanging lape DirecHon is ins sets osx  163  O Metal Tape Selection   a9 un RR 163  O Pinch Roller Release 24442222 4 293 163  d Noise Reduclioi aca d SES 42 044 HR DEE DR 164  D Operation Instructions    CD Mode For CD   PUGIO TIO  ESE idR SEP ERAS AR 164    O Load Eject Button  CD Mode For CD  teo PDT  ng vence EE SR See ea ee Di 165    O Notes On Playing MP3 Files    D Operation Instructions    CD Mode For MP3  And WMA Audio Play                    168    O Load Eject Button  CD Mode For MP3 And    WMA Play   Lm 168  ll Sales Code REC     AM FM CD  6 Disc   Radio With Navigation System              170  O Operating Instructions     Satellite Radio  If  EOUIDDEd  sore L
220. mbol to indicate that  t a phone connection has been made     Call in  Progress    X    Phone  Not  Avail   able    The EVIC displays this symbol to indicate that  the UConnect    phone is currently not avail   able     Navigation     If Equipped    Navigation Display Control   Press and release the MENU button until Navigation  displays in the EVIC  When the Navigation System is On   the steering wheel buttons can be used to select the Map  or Menu display on the Navigation Unit  When the Menu  display is active  the SCROLL button can be used to scroll  through the list  the FUNCTION SELECT button can be  used to select an item  and the AUDIO MODE button can  be used to return to the previous menu  When the Map  display is active  pressing the FUNCTION SELECT but   ton will change the Navigation Unit Display to the Menu     Turn By Turn Directions   The EVIC displays turn by turn directions to a pro   grammed destination when Turn by Turn Navigation is  enabled through Personal Settings  When enabled  the  EVIC displays the name of the approaching road at the  top of the screen  followed by an arrow to indicate the  direction to turn the vehicle  and a count down to  indicate the distance to the turn     NOTE  Refer to your  Navigation User s Manual  for  detailed operating instructions     N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 153    System Warnings  Customer Information  Features    Press and release the MENU button until  SYSTEM  WARNINGS  displays in the EVIC  Then  pres
221. me to  sound        244 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    of a road tire that has a pressure below the low   pressure warning limit  the Tire Pressure Monitoring  Telltale Light will remain ON and a chime will still            z u    sound each ignition key cycle  In addition  the EVIC   o Lal T lre F     I will still roam a by eee message and a flash     TA ing pressure value in the graphic display  Once you   A  d ul ha repair or replace the original road tire  and reinstall it   mue  m on the vehicle in place of the compact spare  the TPMS   FAI mE will update automatically  In addition  the Tire Pres    Er d  ry 1 sure Monitoring Telltale Light will turn OFF  and the    graphic in the EVIC will stop flashing and display a    B18T33f         new pressure value  as long no tire pressure is below    NOTE  the low pressure warning limit in any of the four  e You can change the pressure units to display in PSI  active road tires  The vehicle may need to be driven for  kPA  or BAR  Refer to    Language     under    Personal up to 10 minutes above 15 mph  25 km h  in order for    JJ    Settings  Customer Programmable Features      under the TPMS to receive this information    Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in Check TPMS Warning    Be Onn ENE MOMS The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will flash on   e The compact spare tire  if so equipped  does not have and off for 60 seconds and an audible chime will sound  a tire pressure monitoring sensor  Therefore  the 
222. mended     RECREATIONAL TOWING  BEHIND  MOTORHONE  ETC      TOWING THIS VEHICLE BEHIND ANOTHER  VEHICLE  Flat towing with all four wheels on the  ground    Recreational towing for this vehicle is not recommended     NOTE  If the vehicle requires towing  make sure all  four wheels are off the ground     GROUND CLEARANCE    CAUTION     Damage to the front and rear fascias can occur if you  disregard the low ground clearance in the front and    rear of this vehicle  Pay close attention when parking  to avoid running into parking curbs  Exercise caution  when entering or exiting steep driveways or when  pulling off the road onto soft shoulders           WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES    CONTENTS   Bl Hazard Warning Flasher                   256  N If Your Engine Overheats                  256  W TIREFIT Tire Repair iis si kie VM seek bodes 207  B Jump Starting Procedures                  262  B Freeing A Stuck Vehicle                   265    B Towing A Disabled Vehicle                 266    O Without The Ignition Key                 266    D Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle   Flat Towing With All Four Wheels On The  CON ERROR SEN PEE S d    D Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle  With low Dolf  eens EER KOR SCR esas       256 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES M    HAZARD WARNING FLASHER  The hazard flasher switch is located in the center of the    FEEFEII    MENEER EE REG    Hazard Flasher Switch    To engage the Hazard Warning Flashers  depress the  switch on the instrument
223. minder to remove the  key     Automatic Door Locks  The doors will lock automatically on vehicles with power  door locks if all of the following conditions are met       The Automatic Door Locks feature is enabled     The transmission is in gear       All doors are closed     1   2   3   4  The throttle is pressed    5  The vehicle speed is above 15 mph  24 km h    6      The doors were not previously locked using the power  door lock switch or remote keyless entry transmitter     Automatic Door Locks Programming   The Automatic Door Locks feature can be enabled or  disabled  For details  refer to  Lock Doors Automatically  at 15 mph  24 Km h      under  Personal Settings  Cus   tomer Programmable Features   under  Electronic Ve   hicle Information Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this  manual     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23    Automatic Unlock Doors on Exit  The doors will unlock automatically on vehicles with  power door locks if     1  The Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature is en   abled     2  The transmission was in gear and the vehicle speed  returned to 0 mph  0 km h      3  The transmission is in NEUTRAL or PARK   4  The driver door is opened    5  The doors were not previously unlocked    6  The vehicle speed is 0 mph  0 km h      Automatic Unlock Doors on Exit Programming   The Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature can be  enabled or disabled  For details  refer to  Unlock Doors  Automatically on Exit    under  Personal Settings  Cus   tomer
224. mp  Express Power  Window Switch   if  equipped  Power Mir   rors   if equipped Rain  Sensor   if equipped    Rear Detrost   Hands Free Phone   if  equipped  Media System  Monitor DVD   if  equipped   Radio    Satellite Receiver   if    equipped  37    Transmission   NAG      Analog Clock Cargo  Light Overhead Con   sole    N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 305    Cavity Car  Mini Description  tridge Fuse  Fuse  39     10 Amp Heated Mirrors   if    Red equipped    40     10 Amp Heated Seats   if  Red equipped Inside Rear   view Mirror  41     10 Amp AC Heater Control Park  Red Assist   if equipped  Tire  Pressure Monitoring   if  equipped  42 30 Amp     Front Blower Motor  Pink  43 30 Amp     Amplifier   if equipped   Pink Antenna Rear Defrost  44 20 Amp     Amplifier   if equipped   Blue Front Control Module     FCM  Sunroof   if  equipped      Cavities 11  12  and 13 contain self resetting fuses   circuit breakers  that are only serviceable by an autho   rized dealer  The Cluster  without power memory seat    the Driver Seat Switch  with power memory seat   and  the Memory Module  if equipped  are fused by the 25  amp circuit breaker in Cavity 11  The Passenger Seat  Switch is fused by the 25 amp circuit breaker in Cavity 12   The Door Modules  except base   the Driver Door Lock  Switch  base   the Driver Express Power Window Switch   if equipped   and the Passenger Door Lock Switch  base   are fused by the 25 amp circuit breaker in Cavity 13  If  you experience temporary or perma
225. n     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Setup Phone Pairing      e At the next prompt  say  Delete  and follow the  prompts     e You can also press the  Voice Recognition  button  anytime while the list is being played and then choose  the phone you wish to delete     Things You Should Know About Your UConnect     System    Voice Recognition  VR  o  e Always wait for the beep before speaking     e Speak normally  without pausing  just as you would  speak to a person sitting approximately eight  8  feet  away from you     e Make sure that no one other than you is speaking  during a voice recognition period     Performance is maximized under   e low to medium blower setting   e low to medium vehicle speed   e low road noise    e smooth road surface    e fully closed windows    e dry weather condition     Even though the system is designed for users speaking  in North American English  French  and Spanish ac   cents  the system may not always work for some     When navigating through an automated system  such  as voice mail  or when sending a page at the end of  speaking the digit string  make sure to say  send      Storing names in phonebook when vehicle is not in  motion is recommended     It is not recommended to store similar sounding  names in the UConnect    phonebook     N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  81    e UConnect    phonebook nametag recognition rate is  optimized for the voice of the person who stored the  name in the phonebook
226. n  m  O     O  z    j         SENE SNE OOIT    TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE    INTRODUCTION                THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE    UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE                   22222 200     UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL        sesse sesse sees ese ss ntt nts    STARTING AND OPERATING sette de seder sed Rage 64450 5 x dese Re dee ie de aie ie       CONTENTS    B Introduction               B How To Use This Manual    ll Warnings And Cautions      INTRODUCTION     V 4 Bl Vehicle Identification Number    EST EER 4 W Vehicle Modifications   Alterations       4 INTRODUCTION M    INTRODUCTION   This manual has been prepared with the assistance of  service and engineering specialists to acguaint you with  the operation and maintenance of your new vehicle  It is  supplemented by a Warranty Information Booklet and  various customer oriented documents  You are urged to  read these publications carefully  Following the instruc   Hons and recommendations in this manual will help  assure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle     NOTE  After you read the manual  it should be stored  in the vehicle for convenient reference and remain with  the vehicle when sold  so that the new owner will be  aware of all safety warnings     When it comes to service  remember that your dealer  knows your vehicle best  has the factory trained techni   cians and genuine Mopar  parts  and is interested in  your satisfaction     WARNING     Engine exhaust  some of it
227. n on the cover as shown to expose the cup  holders  Close the cover when the cup holders are no  longer needed                                                                          MR  EE ve EER SERE RR ee est steers iia ann m  erEL ETE EE HE Salsas FEE Ii NAM 7  INMIUIIGIVR  EER EETL Saas cw REEREEREER EER REID NEE NE eres    er or ae EE danse EE MAREE RARR ER REEDE RD SESE    WEIN SERE marn I DO DLANE bee EDE SPREE REE eee DERS ES NR NEE 3  EER RR ER Re feet RE ENAN EET MR T SRRRSTSRSTSTZMMSNNERSSARNEE    MM Mel EET ES Ee eer EED EEEREER LERE ER REEN DERE NR NEAR    WEE EER ER RR ee E IMMER KERR RARR RA RES n PPPS PPPS REEDE EE RE HR EEANN  bere EET PERPE EE pi beer SEE ERRERR EER EE D  SUT iTi  LTT i SRSA SSE TERREA Proc aea a ao aro granata  PONE EENM IMIN Eed 2 ROER RARR terre Pere rr EE EG avs  DY EER KERSE uu fries t Reed aa EO ee  pneter ennes ne  REPE  Ga ae id E als als remata De  BEE pas ad al da RR  ds Nes asse Tiii aaa ac rr DERE  ra NM pp Inh  naa ada n 1    MED    nr rrr   1  E  REB Tao  H  1  ETE 1  ja 1  H  PPS LI           TI EERS SASANN  Top RR We N Be Re EE  TII EIE  Re Re Re Re RR RE  DR REIS Re Re SR Be SAN   et RES N N Be RR EE  DRAERS MR RM Re RE  PASSE  FEC RR Ee Re Re RR RE  EER ER RM RR EE  DELE  FESS     E    oe Soon  Ts  oe oon  SENSE  DERS Re RR Ry MOE AA Ar Re Ba Es Bea Ar           PASSE  meee       Ne  SSS          cee ee  re Tocco rs       PEER EP ah A AN  Pe RE EET  aenean ee i eN       www aa Ea wa E M E DD M D  WR RANA E REA E nu EA A N
228. n until you make another selection  Holding  the button and will bypass stations without stopping  until you release it     SCAN Button  Radio Mode    Pressing the SCAN button causes the tuner to search for  the next station  in either AM  FM or Satellite  if  equipped  frequencies  pausing for 5 seconds  satellite  scan 8 seconds  at each listenable station before continu   ing to the next  To stop the search  press SCAN a second  time     Time Button  Press the time button and the time of day will display for  5 seconds     Clock Setting Procedure  1  Press and hold the time button until the hours blink     2  Adjust the hours by turning the right side Tune   Audio control     3  After the hours are adjusted  press the right side  Tune  Audio control to set the minutes  The minutes will  begin to blink     4  Adjust the minutes using the right side Tune  Audio  control     5  To exit  press any button knob or wait 5 seconds     INFO Button  Radio Mode    Press the INFO button for an RBDS station  one with call  letters displayed   The radio will return a Radio Text  message broadcast  if available  from an FM station  FM  mode only      RW FF  Radio Mode    Pressing the rewind   fast forward button causes the tuner  to search for the next frequency in the direction of the  arrows  This feature operates in either AM  FM or Satel   lite  if equipped  frequencies     TUNE Control  Radio Mode   Turn the right side rotary control to increase or decrease  the frequency     NE o  
229. n vinyl  upholstery     Mopar  Total Clean is specifically recommended for  leather upholstery     Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular  cleaning with a damp soft cloth  Small particles of dirt  can act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery  and should be removed promptly with a damp cloth   Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth  and Mopar  Total Clean or equivalent  Care should be  taken to avoid soaking your leather upholstery with any  liquid  Please do not use polishes  oils  cleaning fluids   solvents  detergents  or ammonia based cleaners to clean  your leather upholstery  Application of a leather condi   tioner is not required to maintain the original condition     WARNING     Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes     Many are potentially flammable  and if used in  closed areas they may cause respiratory harm        Cleaning Headlights  Your vehicle has plastic headlights that are lighter and  less susceptible to stone breakage than glass headlights     Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore  different lens cleaning procedures must be followed     To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and  reducing light output  avoid wiping with a dry cloth  To  remove road dirt  wash with a mild soap solution fol   lowed by rinsing     Do not use abrasive cleaning components  solvents  steel  wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses     Glass Surfaces   All glass surfaces shou
230. nd RIDE  93 RS BR 295  BUC                    PTTT 246  hong 9263s es chat ROER ade PES HA 249  Ole AE oue os an SERRE REALE EU ee es 246  PUHANOL AR RT EE ET EO TE TOT EE 247  Fillertap  Gas Cap  vars d acd dob ehe 249  ei ROET EE OE EE OE 279  ecco n sese ritteri Hada eee ARE DENS 246  EE TERT ER EE dd 141  als EET EE EE SEE NT ER ED 272  Metanol iu eine ods ees ow a oe 247  Octane Ravine   s 3 9 ae REEDE HARE 246 314  bedieners  so pda sane peas  4 246 313  Tan AS Ie eis 2x 8   centia RC e oe ae oy oe 313  Fuel System C QU BD ssec acc pie drerit 504 ben 250  FUCHOG 222591923229 99 2599394939  ses 249  Do                   HPPTII 300    Garage Door Opener  HomeLink               116    N INDEX 351    Gas Cap  Fuel Filler Cap  usos mx Reed 249 272   Gasoline  Clean Air                  een 246  Gasoline  Fuel  vsu sac cs ME does ER EE dE 246  Gasoline  Reformulated                    246  Gauges  Coolant Temperature 22222999 3202 RE HR 139  lo ME AE P              141  DPSOHDEIIEISE uos soucis m que ie Ma oa ER 136  Tachometer iis wes aie  nde Xe ERAS RS 137  General Information                   15 20 245  Glass Clean  242  64456442 624008445 heen 298  Gross Axle Weight Rating                   252  Gross Vehicle Weight Rating              252  Ground Clearance                   leen  254  qi gr  252  Hands Free Phone  UConnect                  66  Hazard Warning Flasher                    256  Head Restraints                cee eee eee 87  Headlight Washers                
231. nd normally heal quickly     However  if you haven t healed significantly within a  few days  or if you have any blistering  see your doctor  immediately     As the airbags deflate  you may see some smoke like  particles  The particles are a normal by product of the  process that generates the nontoxic gas used for airbag  inflation  These airborne particles may irritate the skin   eyes  nose  or throat  If you have skin or eye irritation   rinse the area with cool water  For nose or throat  irritation  move to fresh air  If the irritation continues   see your doctor  If these particles settle on your  clothing  follow the garment manufacturer s instruc   tions for cleaning     It is not advisable to drive your vehicle after the  airbags have been deployed  If you are involved in  another collision  the airbags will not be in place to  protect you     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45    WARNING  Maintaining Your Airbag System  WARNING     e Modifications to any part of the airbag system  could cause it to fail when you need it  You could  be injured because the airbags are not there to  protect you  Do not modify the components or  wiring  including adding any kind of badges or  stickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or  the upper passenger side of the instrument panel     Deployed airbags can   t protect you in another colli     sion  Have the airbags replaced by an authorized  dealer as soon as possible        Enhanced Accident Response Feature   If 
232. nect    system     When calling a number with your UConnect    system  that normally requires you to enter in a touch tone  sequence on your cellular phone keypad  you can push  the    Voice Recognition    button and say the sequence you  wish to enter followed by the word  Send   For example   if required to enter your pin number followed with a  pound 3 7 4 6    you can press the  Voice Recognition     button and say  3 7 4 6   Send     Saying a number  or  sequence of numbers  followed by  Send  is also to be  used to navigate through an automated customer service  center menu structure and to leave a number on a pager     Barge In   Overriding Prompts   The  Voice Recognition  button can be used when you  wish to skip part of a prompt and issue your voice  recognition command immediately  For example  if a  prompt is playing  Would you like to pair a phone  clear    a   you could press the    Voice Recognition    button and  say  Pair a Phone  to select that option without having to  listen to the rest of the voice prompt     Turning Confirmation Prompts On Off   Turning confirmation prompts off will stop the system  from confirming your choices  e g  the UConnect     system will not repeat a phone number before you dial  it      e Press the  Phone  button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Setup Confirmations     The UConnect    system will  play the current confirmation prompt status and you  will be given the choice to change it     P
233. nent loss of these  systems  see your authorized dealer for service     306 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    VEHICLE STORAGE     EEN If you are leaving your vehicle dormant for more than 21    e When installing the Power Distribution Center days  you may want to take steps to protect your battery   cover  it is important to ensure the cover is prop  You may     erly positioned and fully latched  Failure to do so e Disconnect the negative cable from the battery   may allow water to get into the Power Distribu     tion Center  and possibly result in an electrical e Anytime you store your vehicle  or keep it out of  system failure  service  i e  vacation  for two weeks or more  run the    air conditioning system at idle for about five minutes  in the fresh air and high blower setting  This will  insure adequate system lubrication to minimize the  possibility of compressor damage when the system is  started again     When replacing a blown fuse  it is important to  use only a fuse having the correct amperage  rating  The use of a fuse with a rating other than  indicated may result in a dangerous electrical  system overload  If a properly rated fuse contin   ues to blow  it indicates a problem in the circuit  that must be corrected        N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 307    REPLACEMENT BULBS    LIGHT BULBS     Interior Bulb Number    Rear Courtesy  Reading Lights               W5W  Rear Compartment  Trunk  Light               5 9  Overhead Console Reading Lights              578  V
234. ng the seat belt  It may be necessary to retract  the seat belt     4  Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position  A  single chime will sound to signify that you have success   fully completed the programming     The Enhanced Warning System  BeltAlert  can be reacti   vated by repeating this procedure     NOTE  When the Enhanced Warning System  BeltAlert   is deactivated  the Seat Belt Reminder Light will continue  to illuminate as long as the driver s seat belt is unbuck   led     Automatic Locking Mode     If Equipped   In this mode  the shoulder belt is automatically pre   locked  However  the belt will still retract to remove slack  in the shoulder belt  Use The Automatic Locking Mode  any time a child safety seat is installed in a seating  position that has a seat belt with this feature  Seat belts  that have the Automatic Locking Mode feature have a    N THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37    distinctive label on the webbing  Children 12 years old  and under should be properly restrained in the rear seat  whenever possible     How To Engage The Automatic Locking Mode  1  Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt     2  Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until  the entire belt is extracted     3  Allow the belt to retract  As the belt retracts  you will  here a clicking sound  This indicates the safety belt is  now in the automatic locking mode     How To Disengage The Automatic Locking Mode  Unbuckle the combination lap and shoulder belt and  
235. nic Stability Program  ESP  It can also damage the tires  Do not spin the  before rocking the vehicle  For details  refer to  Electronic wheels above 35 mph  55 km h      stability Program   or  Traction Control  in this manual   WARNING     Fast spinning tires can be dangerous  Forces gener   ated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire dam   age or failure  A tire could explode and injure       someone  Do not spin your vehicle s wheels faster  than 35 mph  55 km h  when you are stuck  and don t  let anyone near a spinning wheel  no matter what the  speed        266 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES M    TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE    WITHOUT THE IGNITION KEY   Special care must be taken when the vehicle is towed  with the ignition in the LOCK position  The only ap   proved method of towing without the ignition key is  with a flat bed truck  Proper towing equipment is neces   sary to prevent damage to the vehicle     TOWING THIS VEHICLE BEHIND ANOTHER  VEHICLE  Flat towing with all four wheels on the  ground    Flat towing of vehicles equipped with an automatic  transmission  is only permitted within the following  limitations     With The Ignition Key   Your vehicle may be towed under the following condi   tions  The gear selector must be in NEUTRAL  the  distance to be traveled must not exceed 30 miles  48 km    and the towing speed must not exceed 30 mph  48  km h   Exceeding these towing limits may cause a trans   mission geartrain failure  If the transmission is not op   erativ
236. nly  be used temporarily  An LED in the button  illuminates when the recirculation mode is active  You  may use this feature separately     NOTE  Extended use of recirculation may cause the  windows to fog  If the interior of the windows begins to  fog  press the Recirculation button to return to outside  air  Some temp  humidity conditions will cause captured  interior air to condense on windows and hamper visibil   ity  For this reason  the system will not allow Recircula   tion to be selected while in defrost or defrost floor mode   Attempting to use the recirculation while in these modes  will cause the LED in the control button to blink and then  turn off     Operating Tips    NOTE  Refer to the chart at the end of this section for  suggested control settings for various weather condi   tions     Summer Operation   The engine cooling system in air conditioned vehicles  must be protected with a high quality antifreeze coolant  to provide proper corrosion protection and to protect  against engine overheating  A 50  solution of ethylene  glycol antifreeze coolant in water is recommended  Refer  to  Maintenance Procedures  in Section 7 of this manual  for proper coolant selection     Winter Operation   Use of the air Recirculation mode during winter months  is not recommended because it may cause window  fogging    Vacation Storage   Anytime you store your vehicle  or keep it out of service   i e  vacation  for two weeks or more  run the air condi   tioning system at idle fo
237. nother recall can be selected     Easy Entry Exit Seat  Available with Memory Seat  Only    This feature provides automatic driver seat positioning to  enhance driver mobility when entering and exiting the  vehicle     The distance the driver seat moves depends on where  you have the driver seat positioned when you remove the  key from the ignition switch     e When you remove the key from the ignition switch   the driver seat will move about 2 4 inches  60 mm   rearward if the driver seat position is greater than or  equal to 3 5 inches  90 mm  forward of the rear stop   The seat will return to its previously set position when  you insert the key into the ignition switch and turn it  out of the LOCK position     e When you remove the key from the ignition switch   the driver seat will move to a position 1 2 inches  30  mm  forward of the rear stop if the driver seat position    NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 93    is between 2 4 inches and 3 5 inches  60 mm and 90  mm  forward of the rear stop  The seat will return to its  previously set position when you insert the key into  the ignition switch and turn it out of the LOCK  position     e The Easy Entry  Easy Exit feature is disabled when the  driver seat position is less than 2 4 inches  60 mm   forward of the rear stop  At this position  there is no  benefit to the driver by moving the seat for Easy Exit  or Easy Entry     Each stored memory setting will have an associated Easy  Entry and Easy Exit position 
238. nsmitter  button  Do not release the buttons until Step 4 is  complete     NOTE  Some gate operators and garage door openers  may require you to replace this Programming Step 3 with  procedures noted under  Gate Operator  Canadian Pro   gramming      4  The EVIC will display  Channel X Training   where X  is Channel 1  2  or 3   Release both buttons after the EVIC  displays  Channel X Trained      NOTE  If the EVIC displays  Did Not Train   repeat  Steps 2 4     5  Press and hold the just trained HomeLink button and  observe the EVIC display  If the EVIC displays  Channel  X Transmit     where X is Channel 1  2  or 3   then  programming is complete  and your device should acti   vate when the HomeLink button is pressed and released     NOTE  To program the remaining two HomeLink but   tons  begin with  Programming  Step 2  Do not repeat  Step 1     N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 119    NOTE  If your garage door opener fails to respond to  the programmed HomeLink   Universal Transceiver  and  your garage door opener is manufactured after 1995  it  may have a multiple security code system  rolling code  system   Please proceed to Steps 6 8 to complete the  programming of a rolling code equipped device  most  common garage door openers require this step     6  At the garage door opener receiver  motor head unit   in the garage  locate the  learn  or  smart  button  This  can usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is  attached to the motor head unit     7  
239. nt accidents  The capabilities of an  ABS equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a  reckless or dangerous manner  which could jeopar   dize the user   s safety or the safety of others        TCS  Traction Control System    This system monitors the amount of wheel spin of each  driven wheel  If wheel spin is detected  brake pressure is  applied to the slipping wheel s  and engine power is  reduced to provide enhanced acceleration and stability     BAS  Brake Assist System    This system complements the Anti Lock Brake System   ABS  by optimizing the vehicle braking capability dur   ing emergency braking maneuvers  This system detects  an emergency braking situation by sensing the rate and  amount of brake application and then applies optimum  pressure to the brakes  This can help reduce braking  distances     Applying the brakes very quickly results in the best BAS  assistance  To receive the benefits of this system  you  must apply continuous brake pedal pressure during the  stopping sequence  Do not reduce brake pedal pressure  unless braking is no longer desired  Once the brake pedal  is released  the BAS is deactivated        216 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    WARNING     The BAS  Brake Assist System  cannot prevent the  natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle   nor can it increase the traction afforded by prevail   ing road conditions  The BAS cannot prevent acci   dents  including those resulting from excessive    speed in turns  driving on very slipper
240. nterior power door  lock switches will not unlock the doors     The Vehicle Security Alarm system is designed to protect  your vehicle  however  you can create conditions where  the system will give you a false alarm  If one of the  previously described arming sequences has occurred  the  system will arm regardless of whether you are in the  vehicle or not  If you remain in the vehicle and open a  door  the alarm will sound  If this occurs  disarm the  system     If the alarm system is armed and the battery becomes  disconnected the system will remain armed when the  battery is reconnected  The exterior lights will flash  the  horn will sound  and the ignition will not start the  vehicle  If this occurs  disarm the system     Tamper Alert   If something has triggered the system in your absence   the horn will sound three times when you disarm the  system  Check the vehicle for tampering     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17    ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY  The courtesy lights will turn on when you use the keyless This system allows you to lock or unlock the doors  open  entry transmitter or open the doors  the trunk  or activate the panic alarm from distances up    to about 23 feet  7 meters  using a hand held radio  transmitter  The transmitter need not be pointed at the  vehicle to activate the system        The lights will fade to off after about 30 seconds or they  will immediately fade to off once the ignition switch is  turned ON from th
241. ntroduced over a period of years  child restraint systems  having attachments for those anchorages will continue to  have features for installation using the vehicle s seat  belts  Child restraints having tether straps and hooks for  connection to the top tether anchorages have been avail   able for some time  For some older child restraints  many  child restraint manufacturers offer add on tether strap  kits or retrofit kits  You are urged to take advantage of all  the available attachments provided with your child re   straint in any vehicle     All three rear seating positions have lower anchorages  that are capable of accommodating LATCH compatible  child seats  You should NEVER install LATCH   compatible child seats such that two seats share a com   mon lower anchorage  If installing child seats in adjacent  rear seating positions  or if your child restraints are not  LATCH compatible  install the restraints using the vehi   cle s seat belts     EEREEEREETELXDE CELERE wont     JE      ne    LATCH Anchorages       52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    Installing the LATCH Compatible Child Restraint  System  We urge that you carefully follow the directions of the  manufacturer when installing your child restraint  Not all  child restraint systems will be installed as described here   Again  carefully follow the installation instructions that  were provided with the child restraint system   Vs  meets the seat back  and are just visible when  you lean into the 
242. o instruct all other occupants to  buckle their seat belts  Once the warning is triggered  the  Enhanced Warning System  BeltAlert  will continue to  chime and flash the Seat Belt Reminder Light for 96  seconds or until the driver s seat belt is buckled  The  Enhanced Warning System  BeltAlert  will be reactivated  if the driver s seat belt is unbuckled for more than 10  seconds and the vehicle speed is greater than 5 mph  8  km h         36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    BeltAlert Programming   The Enhanced Warning System  BeltAlert  can be en   abled or disabled by your authorized dealer or by  performing the following steps     NOTE  DaimlerChrysler does not recommend deacti   vating the Enhanced Warning System  BeltAlert      1  With all doors closed  and the ignition switch in any  position except ON or START  buckle the driver s seat  belt     2  Turn the ignition switch to the ON  RUN position  but  do not start the engine  Wait for the Seat Belt Reminder  Light to turn off and then proceed to the next step     NOTE  You must perform the following steps within 60  seconds of turning the ignition switch to the ON  RUN  position     3  Within 60 seconds of turning the ignition switch to the  ON  RUN position  unbuckle and then re buckle the  driver s seat belt at least three times within 10 seconds   ending with the seat belt buckled     NOTE  Watch for the Seat Belt Reminder Light to turn  on while unbuckling the seat belt and turn off while  re buckli
243. o station frequencies  any one of  twelve radio station preset frequencies  CD  disc number  CD track number  tape  or any  one of 200 Satellite radio channels depending  on which radio is in the vehicle     If Compass Temp  Audio is already displayed when the  AUDIO MODE button is pressed  then the radio mode  will change from AM to FM  to Tape  to CD  or to Satellite   SAT  accordingly      gt     FUNC   TION  SELECT  Button    A  v    SCROLL  Button       When the EVIC is in the Compass Temp   Audio screen  press the FUNCTION SELECT  button to advance the radio to the next preset  station  to change the side of the tape being  played  if so equipped   or to change the cur   rent CD track being played  if so equipped      when the EVIC is in the Compass Temp   Audio screen  press the SCROLL button to seek  up and down the radio stations  CD track  numbers  if so equipped   or satellite radio  channels  if so equipped      The following describes the operation of the SCROLL  button in each mode     Radio Operation   Press the top of the SCROLL button once to SEEK the  next listenable station up from the current setting  Press  the bottom of the SCROLL button once to SEEK the next  listenable station down from the current setting     NE UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 181    Tape Player Operation   Press the top of the SCROLL button once to listen to the  next track on the cassette  Press the bottom of the  SCROLL button once either to listen to the beginning of  the curr
244. oStick   Gear selection   The AutoStick   feature can be selected by pressing the  selector lever to the right or the left with the lever in the  D  Drive  position  The gear currently selected is indi   cated in the instrument cluster display  Briefly  press the  selector lever in the    D      direction and the transmission  will shift from the current gear to the next lower gear     Press and hold the selector lever in the    D     direction and  the transmission will shift from the current gear directly  to the next lowest gear for best acceleration     NOTE  To avoid overrevving the engine when the  selector lever is moved in    D      direction  the transmis   sion will not shift to a lower gear if the engine   s revolu   tions per minute  RPM  limit would be exceeded     Briefly  press the selector lever in the    D      direction and  the transmission will shift from the current gear to the  next higher gear     Press and hold the selector lever in the  D      direction  and the transmission will shift from the current gear  directly to gear  D         206 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    WARNING     On slippery road surfaces  never downshift in order  to obtain braking action  This could result in drive    wheel slip and reduced vehicle control  Your vehi   cle   s ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control   You could lose control of your vehicle and have an  accident     Delayed Shifts in Cold Temperatures   During cold temperature operation  you may notice 
245. oad capacity for your vehicle  Never  overload them     e Under inflation increases tire flexing and can  result in tire failure     TIRES     GENERAL INFORMATION e Over inflation reduces a tire   s ability to cushion  shock  Objects on the road and chuckholes can cause    damage that result in tire failure        Tire Pressure   Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and  satisfactory operation of your vehicle  Three primary  areas are affected by improper tire pressure     e Unequal tire pressures can cause steering prob     lems  You could lose control of your vehicle     e Over inflated or under inflated tires can affect  vehicle handling and can fail suddenly  resulting in  loss of vehicle control    e Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle  to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the right  or left     e Always drive with each tire inflated to the recom   mended cold tire inflation pressure        230 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    2  Economy      Improper inflation pressures can cause uneven wear  patterns to develop across the tire tread  These abnormal  wear patterns will reduce tread life resulting in a need for  earlier tire replacement  Under inflation  also increases  tire rolling resistance and results in higher fuel consump   tion     3  Ride Comfort and Vehicle Stability     Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride   Over inflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable ride     Tire Inflation Pressures   The
246. ol loo  CM AA AA RR AE AA Re Re EE RE AR  RA RE AE Aag Be An Re Re Ba Ar BAD Re An Ry Ar BOE Ar An Re Re SS       TINMM  ENXNAXMNNMMA    pops  BR Ha Me Re Rd  oe N Ha Re  TENEAT  pop   RAM    nan    EE    E           2    E  PES  PE  Pr  E  E  E  Do     aa       x     E     2       sete  meee       meee  weer  seer       Fees   IBI   EE EER  IBDININLILM  BEE             EI     MNANTNASNNNNRRR ee       soe  ee          eee eee  coe DERE EET  ER EER nn  ee er  eT eee  ROER R AREA ERAS cee    REK AREA EED  EER tr EA ERA    MUERE Rek EE ARE    RA N oa ale ewe  nadie pe ee                N N Re Re  ens  Se  SS       Soa mice pede  EE LES r             ds       te  i  ep   ie              N  S  v  5   4   ea   ep    gt       Q         oa     ep       OD    amp   N     U       Da    Ww  rm a mE MI   Pi rn eK    Wee ee  WCEP ee    ee    oe    Sauce ss    geb    M    RS REDE RR ER IE    BEER ERS  eet  Pee    popit  MSS MSS  OB Re Re SE Re  IS  OR RR EE   a8 ST   OR RR EE       MAD  Ry Be Be Se Re MNT  SM  ELE  YS ee ee ee Re hid  LELIE N  PELLE    OR Re Re Se Re Es NRI  ae  a    See  ee    1  1    1rror    Sa  ate  BREER RES  kid  rss S        Lr    Power M    Tees  Ires  axe  vM    MM    BR Re Re  AAN BR SOPRA DE RR RE RE RR    See SEA id  SE SE SPOR OTE    ee seinen aa eae ee    Fe n ER eee E AREA RE    SS BOND Re ey He Aa Be Se Er Re S DAT E    TAL Re Pe He Ps Be Se Re Re Ba Es Be Re  Shhh   SR BE RR Re    Ph  soos  sans   ne  LM    Vue EER EDE RE  pop PP ER RE ER ER  UU ae  Ere id
247. olonged driving with the  Malfunction Indicator  Light  on could cause further damage to the emis   sion control system  It could also affect fuel economy  and driveability  The vehicle must be serviced before    any emissions tests can be performed     If the  Malfunction Indicator Light  is flashing  while the engine is running  severe catalytic con   verter damage and power loss will soon occur  Im   mediate service is required        Loose Fuel Filler Cap   If the vehicle diagnostic system determines that the fuel  filler cap is loose  improperly installed  or damaged  a   Check Gascap  message will display in the Electronic  Vehicle Information Center  EVIC      if equipped  If this  occurs  tighten the fuel filler cap properly and press the  odometer reset button to turn off the message  If the  problem continues  the message will appear the next time  the vehicle is started     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 273    A loose  improperly installed  or damaged fuel filler cap  may also turn on the Malfunction Indicator Light  MIL      EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  PROGRAMS   In some localities  it may be a legal requirement to pass  an inspection of your vehicle s emissions control system   Failure to pass could prevent vehicle registration     For states  which have an I M  Inspection and   Maintenance  requirement  this check verifies the   following  the MIL  Malfunction Indicator Lamp   is functioning and is not on when the engine is running   and that the OBD  On 
248. om the  buckle and twist the short buckle end belt several times  to shorten it  Insert the latch plate into the buckle with the  release button facing out     If the belt still can   t be tightened  or if by pulling and  pushing on the restraint loosens the belt  you may need  to do something more  Disconnect the latch plate from  the buckle  turn the buckle around  and insert the latch       plate into the buckle again  If you still can   t make the  child restraint secure  try a different seating position     To attach a child restraint tether strap     1  Rotate the cover over the anchor directly behind the  seat where you are placing the child restraint                  2  Route the tether strap to provide the most direct path  for the strap between the anchor and the child seat     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55    3  Attach the tether strap hook  A  of the child restraint to  the anchor  B  and remove slack in the tether strap  according to the child restraint manufacturer s instruc   tions     NOTE  Ensure that the tether strap does not slip into  the opening between the seat backs as you remove slack  in the strap     WARNING     An incorrectly anchored tether strap could lead to  increased head motion and possible injury to the    child  Use only the anchor positions directly behind  the child seat to secure a child restraint top tether  strap     Transporting Pets   Airbags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet   An unrestrained pet wil
249. om the speed recommended by the manufac   ture        NOTE  In order to avoid damage to tires  chains  and  your vehicle do not drive for a prolonged period of time  on dry pavement  Observe the tire chain manufacturer s  instructions on method of installation  operating speed   and conditions for usage     Always use the lower suggested operating speed if both  the chain manufacturer and vehicle manufacture suggest  a maximum speed  This notice applies to all chain  traction devices  including link and cable  radial  chains     SNOW TIRES   Some areas of the country require the use of snow tires  during winter  Standard tires are of the all season type  and satisfy this requirement as indicated by the M S  designation on the tire sidewall     If you need snow tires  select tires equivalent in size and  type to the original equipment tires  Use snow tires only  in sets of 4  failure to do so may adversely affect the  safety and handling of your vehicle     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 237    Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what  was originally equipped with your vehicle and should  not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph  120  km h      TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS   Tires on the front and rear axles of vehicles operate at  different loads and perform different steering  driving   and braking functions  For these reasons  they wear at  unequal rates  and tend to develop irregular wear pat   terns     These effects can be reduced by timely rotation of 
250. omer  Programmable Features   under  Electronic Vehicle In   formation Center  EVIC   in Section 4 of this manual     The system uses four sensors located in the rear bumper  to scan for obstacles up to 59 inches  150 cm  away from  the rear bumper fascia  The warning display located  above the rear window provides both visible and audible  warnings to indicate the range of the object              cM  MERE ttt    rE re  ovum   ee RR Sm mmc    Fi 81 2aD8 de        ES    nt       Rear Park Assist Indicator    The warning display contains two sets of yellow and red  LEDs  one set to warn of obstacles behind the left rear of  the vehicle and the other set to warn of obstacles behind  the right rear of the vehicle  The driver can view the LEDs  either through the rear view mirror or by looking at the  display above the rear window     The system dimly illuminates the two outer most yellow  LEDs when it is ON and detecting no obstacles  The  following chart shows the warning display operation  when the system is detecting an obstacle     NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 113    WARNING DISPLAY DISTANCES    DISPLAY LED OBSTACLE DISTANCE FROM  LED COLOR AUDIBLE SIGNAL  REAR CORNERS REAR em    5th LED 25 5 in   65 em  255 in  s cm   6th LED 20 in   50 cm  20 in   50 cm     7th LED 16 in   40 cm  16 in   40 cm  at 12 in   30 cm   Intermittent    8th LED 6 in   15 cm  12 in   30 cm  at 8 in   20 cm   E    NOTE  The Rear Park Assist system will MUTE the  radio  if on  when th
251. operly  the engine coolant  antifreeze  will begin to  drain from the coolant recovery bottle  DO NOT RE   MOVE THE COOLANT PRESSURE CAP WHEN THE  COOLING SYSTEM IS HOT     Cooling System     Drain  Flush  and Refill  The system should be drained  flushed  and refilled at the  intervals shown on the Maintenance Schedule     If the solution is dirty or contains a considerable amount  of sediment  clean and flush with a reliable cooling       288 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    system cleaner  Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove  all deposits and chemicals  Properly dispose of old CAUTION     antifreeze solution  e Mixing of coolants other than specified HOAT  Selection of Coolant engine coolants  may result in engine damage and  Use only the manufacturer   s recommended coolant  Re  may decrease corrosion protection  If a non HOAT  fer to    Fluids  Lubricants  and Genuine Parts    for the coolant is introduced into the cooling system in an    correct coolant type  emergency  it should be replaced with the speci   fied coolant as soon as possible     Do not use plain water alone or alcohol base  engine coolant  antifreeze  products  Do not use  additional rust inhibitors or antirust products  as  they may not be compatible with the radiator  engine coolant and may plug the radiator     e This vehicle has not been designed for use with  Propylene Glycol based coolants  Use of Propy   lene Glycol based coolants is not recommended        N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 289    A
252. or  the    NORMAL STARTING    procedure  should be repeated     After Starting  The idle speed is controlled automatically and it will  decrease as the engine warms up     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 199    ENGINE BLOCK HEATER     IF EQUIPPED AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION   The engine block heater warms engine coolant and   permits quicker starts in cold weather  Connect the cord   to a standard 110 115 volt AC electrical outlet with a CAUTION    boud AA wre exten coe Damage to the transmission may occur if the follow     The engine block heater cord is routed under the hood on ing precautions are not observed    the driver side of the vehicle  It has a removable cap that e Shift into PARK only after the vehicle has come to  is located on the driver side of the Integrated Power a complete stop    Module     Shift into or out of REVERSE only after the  vehicle has come to a complete stop and the  engine is at idle speed     Do not shift from REVERSE  PARK  or NEUTRAL  into any forward gear when the engine is above  idle speed     WARNING     Remember to disconnect the cord before driving     Damage to the 110 115 volt electrical cord could  cause electrocution        Before shifting into any gear  make sure your foot  is firmly on the brake pedal        200 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE    WARNING     It is dangerous to shift the selector lever out of    P    or     N    if the engine speed is higher than idle speed  If  your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal  the    vehicle could acc
253. ory  switch  then press the side of the rocker switch labeled  1   within 5 seconds  The Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC  will display which memory position is  being set     If desired  a second memory profile can be stored into  memory as follows     1  Adjust all memory profile settings to desired prefer   ences  i e  seat  side mirror  adjustable pedals  power tilt  and telescopic steering column  and radio station pre   sets      2  Press and release the Set  5  button on the memory  switch  then press the side of the rocker switch labeled  2   within 5 seconds  The Electronic Vehicle Information  Center  EVIC  will display which memory position is  being set     NOTE  Memory profiles can be set without the vehicle  in Park  but the vehicle must be in Park to recall a  memory profile     NOTE  The Recall Memory with Remote Key Unlock  feature can be enabled or disabled  For details  refer to     Recall Memory with Remote Key Unlock   under  Per   sonal Settings  Customer Programmable Features      un   der  Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in  Section 4 of this manual     Linking  amp  Unlinking the Remote Keyless  Transmitter to the Memory Feature   Your Remote Keyless Entry Transmitters can be pro   grammed to recall one of two pre programmed memory  profiles by pressing the UNLOCK button on the Remote  Keyless Entry Transmitter     To program your transmitters  perform the following   1  Remove key from ignition   2  Select desired memory pro
254. oser to the obstacle than the rear fascia  when the warning display turns the red LEDs ON   Also  the sensors could detect the ball mount and  hitch ball assembly  depending on its size and  shape  giving a false indication that an obstacle is  behind the vehicle     e Jackhammers  large trucks  and other vibrations could  affect the performance of the system        NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 115    If  Service Park Assist System  appears in the Electronic  Vehicle Information Center  EVIC  after making sure the  rear bumper is clean please see your authorized dealer     OVERHEAD CONSOLE   The overhead console contains courtesy  reading lights   an optional universal garage door opener  HomeLink      storage for sunglasses  and an optional power sunroof  switch        8125e121    Overhead Console    Courtesy Reading Lights    At the forward end of the console are two courtesy    reading lights     Press the lens to turn on the light  Press it a second time  to turn off the light     These lights also turn on when a door is opened  or when  the unlock button on the remote keyless entry transmitter  is pressed  or when the dimmer control is turned fully  upward  past the second detent     Sunglasses Storage  At the rear of the console  a compartment is provided for  the storage of a pair of sunglasses     The storage compartment access is a  push push  design   Push the finger depression on the overhead console to  open  Push the finger depression to close   
255. osition  The lever is located on the left  side of the steering column     Turn the windshield wipers off when driving    through an automatic car wash  Damage to the  windshield wipers may result if the wiper switch is  left in any position other than OFF        Intermittent Wiper System   Use the intermittent wiper when weather conditions  make a single wiping cycle with a variable pause be   tween cycles desirable  Rotate the end of the multi   function lever to the first detent position  and then turn  the end of the lever to select the desired delay interval   There are six delay settings  which allow you to regulate  the wipe interval from a minimum of one cycle every  818c9c32 second to a maximum of approximately 23 seconds    Windshield Wiper Washer Control between cycles   Rotate the end of the multi function lever to the first  detent past the intermittent settings for Low speed wiper  operation  or to the second detent past the intermittent  settings for High speed wiper operation        102 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  NN Id    WARNING     Sudden loss of visibility through the windshield  could lead to an accident  You might not see other    vehicles or other obstacles  To avoid sudden icing of  the windshield during freezing weather  warm the  windshield with defroster before and during wind   shield washer use     Mist Feature   Push the multi function lever inward  toward the steer   ing column  to the first detent to activate a single wipe  cycl
256. others   Service should be obtained as soon as possible     CAUTION     Prolonged operation of the steering system at the  end of the steering wheel travel will increase the       steering fluid temperature and it should be avoided  when possible  Damage to the power steering pump  may occur        ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM   Your vehicle is equipped with an advanced electronic  brake control system commonly referred to as ESP  This  system includes the ABS  Anti Lock Brake System   the  TCS  Traction Control System   the BAS  Brake Assist  System   and the ESP  Electronic Stability Program    These systems work together to enhance both vehicle  stability and control in various driving conditions     ABS  Anti Lock Brake System    This system aids the driver in maintaining vehicle control  under adverse braking conditions by controlling hydrau   lic brake pressure  This prevents wheel lock up to help  avoid skidding on slippery surfaces during braking  For  more information about ABS  refer to  Anti Lock Brake  System  in Section 5 of this manual     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 215    WARNING     The ABS  Anti Lock Brake System  cannot prevent  the natural laws of physics from acting on the  vehicle  nor can it increase the traction afforded by  prevailing road conditions  The ABS cannot prevent  accidents  including those resulting from excessive    speed in turns  driving on very slippery surfaces  or  hydroplaning  Only a safe  attentive  and skillful  driver can preve
257. our selection  press and release the  FUNCTION SELECT button until  ON  or  OFF  ap   pears        Turn Headlights On with Remote Key Unlock   When this feature is selected  the headlights will activate  and remain on for up to 90 seconds when the doors are  unlocked with the remote keyless entry transmitter  To  make your selection  press and release the FUNCTION  SELECT button until    OFF        30 sec       60 sec      or  90  sec     appears        Delay Power Off to Accessories Until Exit      When this feature is selected  the power window  switches  radio  hands free system  if equipped   DVD  video system  if equipped   power sunroof  if equipped    and power outlets will remain active for up to 60 minutes  after the ignition switch is turned off  Opening a vehicle    door will cancel this feature  To make your selection   press and release the FUNCTION SELECT button until     Off      45 sec      5 min       10 min       30 min      or  60  min   appears      Confirmation of Voice Commands      If  Equipped   When ON is selected  all voice commands from the  UConnect    system are confirmed  To make your selec   tion  press and release the FUNCTION SELECT button  until  ON  or  OFF  appears      Park Assist System    When ON is selected  the system will scan for objects  behind the vehicle when the transmission is in the R   Reverse  or N  Neutral  position  To make your selec   tion  press and release the FUNCTION SELECT button  until  ON  or  OFF  appears        T
258. ove 15 mph  25 km h  in order for the TPMS to  receive this information        240 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE    CAUTION     e The TPMS has been optimized for the original        For example  your vehicle may have a recom   mended cold  parked for more than 3 hours  placard  pressure of 30 psi  207 kPa   If the ambient tempera     ture is 68  F  20  C  and the measured tire pressure is  27 psi  186 kPa   a temperature drop to 20  F   7  C   will decrease the tire pressure to approximately 23  psi  157 kPa   This tire pressure is sufficiently low  enough to turn ON the Tire Pressure Monitoring  Telltale light  Driving the vehicle may cause the tire  pressure to rise to approximately 27 psi  186 kPa    but the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will  still be ON  In this situation  the Tire Pressure  Monitoring Telltale Light will turn OFF only after  the tires are inflated to the vehicle s recommended  cold placard pressure value     equipment tires and wheels  TPMS pressures and  warning have been established for the tire size  equipped on your vehicle  Undesirable system  operation or sensor damage may result when  using replacement equipment that is not of the  same size  type  and or style  After market wheels  can cause sensor damage  Do not use tire sealant  from a can  or balance beads if your vehicle is  equipped with a TPMS  as damage to the sensors  may result     After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure   always reinstall the valve stem cap  This will   
259. overnment course as a tire  graded 100  The relative performance of tires depends  upon the actual conditions of their use  however  and  may depart significantly from the norm due to variations  in driving habits  service practices and differences in road  characteristics and climate     Traction Grades   The traction grades  from highest to lowest  are AA  A  B   and C  Those grades represent the tire s ability to stop on  wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions  on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and  concrete  A tire marked C may have poor traction perfor   mance     WARNINCG     The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on  straight ahead braking traction tests  and does not  include acceleration  cornering  hydroplaning  or    peak traction characteristics        344 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE  NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNEEEEEEE  Temperature Grades    WARNING   The temperature grades are A  the highest   B  and C     representing the tire   s resistance to the generation of heat The temperature grade for this tire is established for  and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded   controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory Excessive speed  under inflation  or excessive load   test wheel  Sustained high temperature can cause the ing  either separately or in combination  can cause    material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life  and heat buildup and possible tir
260. p  you understand and save you concern about these  ap   parent  malfunctions  you must understand a point or  two about the transmission and reception of radio sig   nals     Two Types of Signals   There are two basic types of radio signals   AM or  Amplitude Modulation  in which the transmitted sound  causes the amplitude  or height  of the radio waves to  vary   and FM or Frequency Modulation  in which the  frequency of the wave is varied to carry the sound     Electrical Disturbances  Radio waves may pick up electrical disturbances during  transmission  They mainly affect the wave amplitude     and thus remain a part of the AM reception  They  interfere very little with the frequency variations that  carry the FM signal     AM Reception  AM sound is based on wave amplitude  so AM reception  can be disrupted by such things as lightning  power lines  and neon signs     FM Reception   Because FM transmission is based on frequency varia   tions  interference that consists of amplitude variations  can be filtered out  leaving the reception relatively clear   which is the major feature of FM radio     NOTE  The radio  steering wheel radio controls  and 6  disc CD DVD changer  if equipped  will remain active  for up to 60 minutes after the ignition switch is turned  off  Opening either front door will cancel this feature  The  time is programmable  For details  refer to  Delay Power  Off to Accessories Until Exit     under    Personal Settings   Customer Programmable Features   
261. park  and cycle the ignition key   The light should turn off  If the light remains lit with the  engine running  your vehicle will usually be drivable   However  see your dealer for service as soon as possible     If the light is flashing when the engine is running   immediate service is required  In this case  you may  experience reduced performance  an elevated   rough idle  or engine stall  and your vehicle may require towing     Also  have the system checked by an authorized dealer if  the light does not come on during starting     UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 141    22  Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light     If  Equipped   Each tire  including the spare  if provided      1  should be checked monthly when cold and   inflated to the inflation pressure recom    mended by the vehicle manufacturer on the  vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label   If your  vehicle has tires of a different size than the size  indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pres   sure label  you should determine the proper tire  inflation pressure for those tires    As an added safety feature  your vehicle has been  equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system  TPMS   that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or  more of your tires are significantly under inflated  Ac   cordingly  when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates   you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible   and inflate them to the proper pressure  Driving on a  significantly
262. pe will resume play        164 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN    Noise Reduction  The Dolby Noise Reduction System  is on whenever the  tape player is on  but may be switched oft     To turn off the Dolby Noise reduction System  Press  Preset 1 after you insert the tape  The NR light in the  display will go off when the Dolby System is off        Dolby  noise reduction is manufactured under license  from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation  Dolby  and the double D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Labo   ratories Licensing Corporation     Operation Instructions    CD MODE for CD Audio  Play     NOTE  The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC  position to operate the radio     NOTE  Note  This Radio is capable of playing compact  discs  CD   recordable compact discs  CD R   rewritable  compact discs  CD RW  compact discs with MP3 tracks  and multisession compact discs with CD and MP3 tracks  and WMA     Inserting Compact Disc s     CAUTION     This CD player will accept 4 3 4 inch  12 cm  discs    only  The use of other sized discs may damage the  CD player mechanism        You may eject a disc with the radio OFF     If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio  ON  the unit will switch from radio to CD mode and  begin to play when you insert the disc  The display will  show the disc number  the track number  and index time  in minutes and seconds  Play will begin at the start of  track 1     SEEK Button  CD MODE for CD Audio Play   Press the right sid
263. per  corrosion protection of your engine  which contains  aluminum components     e Make sure that the radiator and coolant recovery  bottle overflow hoses are not kinked or obstructed     e Keep the front of the radiator clean  If your vehicle is  equipped with air conditioning  keep the front of the  condenser clean  also     e Do not change the thermostat for summer or winter  operation  If replacement is ever necessary  install  ONLY the correct type thermostat  Other designs may  result in unsatisfactory coolant performance  poor gas  mileage  and increased emissions     Hoses and Vacuum Vapor Harnesses   Inspect surfaces of hoses and nylon tubing for evidence  of heat and mechanical damage  Hard or soft spots   brittle rubber  cracking  tears  cuts  abrasions  and exces   sive swelling indicate deterioration of the rubber     Pay particular attention to those hoses nearest to high  heat sources such as the exhaust manifold  Inspect hose  routing to be sure hoses do not come in contact with any  heat source or moving component  which may cause heat  damage or mechanical wear        292 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    Insure nylon tubing in these areas has not melted or  collapsed     Inspect all hose connections such as clamps and cou   plings to make sure they are secure and no leaks are  present     Components should be replaced immediately if there is  any evidence of wear or damage that could cause failure     Fuel System   The Electronic Fuel Injection high pressu
264. perate power windows   other controls  or move the vehicle     CAUTION     An unlocked car is an invitation to thieves  Always  remove key from the ignition and lock all doors  when leaving the vehicle unattended        Key In Ignition Reminder  If you open the driver s door and the key is in the ignition  switch  a chime will sound to remind you to remove the    key     NOTE  The Key In Ignition reminder only sounds  when the ignition key is placed in the LOCK or ACC  positions     SENTRY KEY   The Sentry Key Immobilizer System prevents unautho   rized vehicle operation by disabling the engine  The  system does not need to be armed or activated  Operation  is automatic  regardless of whether the vehicle is locked  or unlocked     The system uses ignition keys  which have an embedded  electronic chip  transponder   to prevent unauthorized  vehicle operation  Therefore  only keys that are pro   grammed to the vehicle can be used to start and operate  the vehicle  The system will shut the engine off in two  2   seconds if someone uses an invalid key to start the  engine     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13    NOTE  A key  which has not been programmed  is also  considered an invalid key even if it is cut to fit the  ignition lock cylinder for that vehicle     During normal operation  after turning on the ignition  switch  the Vehicle Security Alarm Indicator Light will  turn on for three  3  seconds for a bulb check  If the light  remains on after the bulb chec
265. portant that you distribute the load  evenly over the front and rear axles     Overloading can cause potential safety hazards and  shorten useful service life  Heavier axles or suspension  components do not necessarily increase the vehicle   s  GVWR     Loading   To load your vehicle properly  first figure out its empty  weight  axle by axle and side by side  Store heavier items  down low and be sure you distribute their weight as  evenly as possible  Stow all loose items securely before    driving  If weighing the loaded vehicle shows that you  have exceeded either GAWR  but the total load is within  the specified GVWR  you must redistribute the weight   Improper weight distribution can have an adverse effect  on the way your vehicle steers and handles and the way  the brakes operate     A loaded vehicle is shown in the illustration  Note that  neither the GVWR nor the GAWR capacities have been  exceeded     GROSS VEHICLE WEIGHT RATING  GVWR  2177 KG  4800 LBS    Example Only        B12cb  da       254 STARTING AND OPERATING    EXAMPLE ONLY Front Rear Axle  Axle  Empty Weight 2054 lbs   1805 Ibs   932 kg  819 ke    Load  Including driver  pas     e  g    sengers  and cargo   123 kg     263 kg    1055 kg     1081 kg    1155 kg     1228 kg    NOTE  Refer to the    Vehicle Certification Label    at     tached to the rear of the driver s door for your vehicle s  GVWR and GAWRSs  This table is only an example           TRAILER TOWING  Trailer towing with this vehicle is not recom
266. posted speed limits          blank          Absence of any text on sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load  SL  Tire    C D E   Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure  Maximum Load     Maximum Load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry     Maximum Pressure     Maximum Pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this  tire        224 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    Tire Identification Number  TIN  Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall  The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire  tires as mounted on the vehicle  If the TIN is not found on  however  the date code may only be on one side  Tires the outboard side then you will find it on the inboard side  with white sidewalls will have the full TIN including of the tire    date code located on the white sidewall side of the tire     EXAMPLE   DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301    DOT   Department of Transportation     This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U S  Department of Transportation tire  safety standards  and is approved for hiehway use   its     ABCD   Code used by tire manufacturer   1 to 4 digits   03   Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured   2 digits      03 means the 3rd week     01   Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured   2 digits      01 means the year 2001        Prior to July 2000  tire manufacturers were only required to
267. r about five minutes in the fresh  air and high blower setting  This will insure adequate    N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 189    system lubrication to minimize the possibility of com   pressor damage when the system is started again     Window Fogging   Interior fogging on the windshield can be quickly re   moved by turning the mode selector to Defrost  The  Defrost Floor mode can be used to maintain a clear  windshield and provide sufficient heating  If side win   dow fogging becomes a problem increase blower speed   Vehicle windows tend to fog on the inside in mild but  rainy or humid weather     NOTE  Recirculate without A C should not be used for  long periods as fogging may occur     Outside Air Intake   Make sure the air intake  located directly in front of the  windshield  is free of obstructions such as leaves  Leaves  collected in the air intake may reduce airflow  and if they  enter the plenum  they could plug the water drains  In  winter months  make sure the air intake is clear of ice   slush  and snow     A C Air Filter     If Equipped   The climate control system filters outside air containing  dust  pollen and some odors  Strong odors cannot be  totally filtered out  Refer to  Maintenance Procedures  in  Section 7 of this manual for filter replacement instruc   tions        190 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id     Control Setting Suggestions for Various Weather Conditions    WEATHER CONTROL SETTINGS    HOT WEATHER Open the windows  start the 
268. r from the coolant recovery bottle     The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there is any  accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces        290 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    WARNING     e The warning words    DO NOT OPEN HOT    on  the cooling system pressure cap are a safety pre   caution  Never add coolant when the engine is  overheated  Do not loosen or remove the cap to  cool an overheated engine  Heat causes pressure    to build up in the cooling system  To prevent  scalding or injury  do not remove the pressure cap  while the system is hot or under pressure     Do not use a pressure cap other than the one  specified for your vehicle  Personal injury or  engine damage may result     Disposal of Used Coolant   Used ethylene glycol based engine coolant is a regulated  substance requiring proper disposal  Check with your  local authorities to determine the disposal rules for your  community  To prevent ingestion by animals or children   do not store ethylene glycol based engine coolant in open  containers or allow it to remain in puddles on the       ground  If ingested by a child  contact a physician  immediately  Clean up any ground spills immediately     Coolant Level   The coolant bottle provides a quick visual method for  determining that the coolant level is adequate  With the  engine off and cold  the level of the coolant in the bottle  should be between the ranges indicated on the bottle     The radiator normally remains completely full  so t
269. r navigation is supplied on a  DVD that is loaded into the unit  One map DVD covers  all of North America  Refer to your  Navigation User s  Manual  for detailed operating instructions     Operating Instructions     Satellite Radio  If  Equipped    Refer to your  Navigation User s Manual  for detailed  operating instructions     REC Setting the Clock    GPS Clock   The GPS receiver used in this system is synchronized to  the time data being transmitted by the GPS satellites  The  satellites  clock is Greenwich Mean Time  GMT   This is  the worldwide standard for time  This makes the sys   tem s clock very accurate once the appropriate time zone  and daylight savings information is set     1  At the Main Menu screen  highlight  Clock Setup   and press ENTER OR press and hold for 3 seconds the  TIME button on the unit s faceplate  The Clock Setup  screen appears     FM       2  To show the GPS clock  select    Displayed Clock  GPS  Clock    and press ENTER     3  To adjust the time zone  Select    Time Zone    and press  ENTER  Select the appropriate time zone and press  ENTER     172 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL M    4  To turn daylight savings on or off  select  Daylight  Savings  and press ENTER  Select  On  or  Off  and  press ENTER     5  Select DONE to exit from the clock setting mode  Press  ENTER to save your changes  If you press CANCEL or  NAV then your changes will not be saved     User Defined Clock   If you wish to set the clock to a time different than the 
270. r once the trunk  is closed     With the key in the lock position or key out  the trunk  open symbol will display until the trunk is closed     EEUU THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29  TRUNK SAFETY WARNING Trunk Emergency Release    WARNING     Do not allow children to have access to the trunk   either by climbing into the trunk from outside  or  through the inside of the vehicle  Always close the    trunk lid when your vehicle is unattended  Once in  the trunk  young children may not be able to escape   even if they entered through the rear seat  If trapped  in the trunk  children can die from suffocation or  heat stroke        Emergency Release  The trunk of your vehicle is equipped with an emergency  release handle  It is located on the inside of the trunk lid   near the latch  and is coated so that it glows in a darkened  trunk  Pull on the handle to open the trunk     30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    OCCUPANT RESTRAINTS   Some of the most important safety features in your  vehicle are the restraint systems  These include the front  and rear seat belts for the driver and all passengers  front  airbags for both the driver and front passenger and  if so  equipped  side curtain airbags for the driver and passen   gers seated next to a window  If you will be carrying  children too small for adult size belts  your seat belts also  can be used to hold infant and child restraint systems     Please pay close attention to the information in this  sec
271. r s airbag is mounted in the center of  the steering wheel  The passenger s front airbag is  mounted in the instrument panel  above the glove com   partment  The words SRS AIRBAG are embossed on the  airbag covers     AIRBAG       KNEE BOLSTERS    84 8c9e09    Front Airbag Components    NOTE  The front airbags are certified to the Federal  regulations that allow less forceful deployment     The front airbags have a multistage inflator design  This  may allow the airbag to have different rates of inflation  that are based on collision severity     This vehicle may also be equipped with side curtain  airbags to protect the driver and passengers sitting next  to a window  If the vehicle is equipped with side curtain  airbags  they are located above the side windows  Their  covers are also labeled SRS AIRBAG        THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39    WARNING     Do not put anything on or around the front airbag  covers or attempt to manually open them  You may  damage the airbags and you could be injured be   cause the airbags are no longer functional  These  protective covers for the airbag cushions are de   signed to open only when the airbags are inflating     If your vehicle is equipped with side curtain airbags   do not stack luggage or other cargo up high enough  to block the location of the side curtain airbag  The  area where the side curtain airbag is located should       rd       remain free from any obstructions     Window Airbag If your vehicle is equipp
272. r should be replaced at every engine  oil change     Engine Oil Filter Selection   This manufacturer s engines have a full flow type oil  filter  Use a filter of this type for replacement  The quality  of replacement filters varies considerably  Only high  quality filters should be used to assure most efficient  service  Mopar  Engine Oil Filters are a high quality oil  filter and are recommended     Drive Belts     Check Condition and Tension   Belt tension is controlled by means of an automatic  tensioner  Therefore  no belt tension adjustments are  required  However  belt and belt tensioner condition    should be inspected at the specified intervals and re   placed if required  Improper belt tension can cause belt  slippage and failure  Low generator belt tension can  cause battery failure     At the mileage indicated in the maintenance schedule   inspect belt and belt tensioner condition  Inspect belts for  evidence of cuts  cracks  glazing  or frayed cords and  replaced if there is indication of damage  which could  result in belt failure  Also  check belt routing to make sure  there is no interference between the belts and other  engine components  See your authorized dealer for ser   vice     Spark Plugs   Spark plugs must fire properly to assure engine perfor   mance and emission control  New plugs should be in   stalled at the specified mileage  The entire set should be  replaced if there is any malfunction due to a faulty spark  plug  Malfunctioning spark plugs can 
273. r the name  the UConnect    system will  ask you which designation you wish to delete  home   work  mobile  or pager  Say the designation you wish  to delete     Note that only the phonebook entry in the current  language is deleted     After confirmation  the phonebook entries will be de   leted  Note that only the phonebook in the current  language is deleted     Delete All Entries in the UConnect    Phonebook    Press the  Phone  button to begin     After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Phonebook Erase All        The UConnect    system will ask you to verify that you  wish to delete all the entries from the phonebook     After confirmation  the phonebook entries will be  deleted     List All Names in the UConnect    Phonebook    Press the    Phone    button to begin     After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Phonebook List Names      The UConnect    system will play the names of all the  phonebook entries     To call one of the names in the list  press the  Voice  Recognition  button during the playing of the desired  name  and then say    Call     NOTE  the user can also  exercise  Edit  or  Delete  operations at this point     The UConnect    system will then prompt you as to  number designation you wish to call     The selected number will be dialed     NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 73    Phone Call Features   The following features can be accessed through the  UConnect    system if the feature s  are available on your  c
274. r towel using a mild detergent  with the cup holder in the center console     NOTE  The cup holder cannot be removed     300 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE    FUSES  POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTERS     Fuses  Front Power Distribution Center   A power distribution center is located in the engine  compartment  This center contains fuses and relays     terere hh N e E fuu N EK 7  EMI TEE  SOET E e e  MDDCEREREREEERR   N            Je BI eterae2s       MS    Front Power Distribution Center          Cavity Car  Mini Description  tridge Fuse  Fuse  1     20 Amp Left High Intensity Dis     Yellow charge  HID  Headlight  2     20 Amp Right High Intensity  Yellow Discharge  HID  Head     light    3     15 Amp Adjustable Pedals   if  Blue equipped   4     20 Amp AC Clutch Horn  Yellow   5     20 Amp Headlight Washer   If    Yellow Equipped    6     15 Amp Front Control Module  Blue  FCM          20 Amp Fog Lights  Yellow   8     15 Amp Lights   License  Park     Blue Side Marker  Stop  Turn  9     15 Amp Front Control Module  Blue  FCM     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 301    Cavity Car  Mini  tridge Fuse    Description    Powertrain Control    Orange Module  PCM  Starter    Auto Shutdown    Powertrain Control  Module  PCM     Powertrain Control  Module  PCM     Injectors  Ignition Coils    yellow    Fuse  10     5 Amp  11     25 Amp  Clear  12          13          14     25 Amp  Clear  15     20 Amp  16          17 30 Amp      Pink  18 30 Amp      Pink    Anti lock Brakes System   ABS  Valves   Pow
275. rake transmission shift  interlock system  BTSI  that holds the selector lever in the  P  Park  position when the ignition switch is in the LOCK  position  To move the gear selector lever out of the P   Park  position  the ignition switch must be turned to the  ON position  and the brake pedal must be depressed     EER de  des S s MOED io  TEER    E    MES CM           prn  Se  er   por   Dod    Brake Interlock Override       For electrical system malfunctions  there is an override  for the interlock system  In order to override this system  the key must be in the ignition with the switch in the  ACC or ON positions  Remove the rubber storage tray  from the bin located to the right of the shifter lever  The  override can be activated by pressing the pink colored  tab  which can be accessed through a hole inside the bin   While the override is pressed  the shifter can be moved  out of the park position without pressing the brake  After  operation  return the rubber storage tray to its original  position     ee STARTING AND OPERATING 203    5 Speed Automatic Transmission   Shifting from D  Drive  to P  Park  or R  Reverse   or  from P or R to D  should be done only after the  accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped   Be sure to keep your foot on the brake when moving the  selector lever between these gears        DD Sr EE NN  ate  Pe     at ste   E  pasce  PERI  x    aaa   rr   Tr     Selector Lever  Gear Ranges    P  Park   P  Park  supplements the parking bra
276. re fuel system s  hoses and quick connect fittings have unique material  characteristics that provide adequate sealing and resist  attack by deteriorated gasoline     You are urged to use only the manufacture specified  hoses with quick connect fittings  or their equivalent in  material and specification  in any fuel system servicing  It  is mandatory to replace any damaged hoses or quick  connect fittings that have been removed during service   Care should be taken in installing quick connect fittings  to insure they are properly installed and fully connected   See your authorized dealer for service     Brake System   In order to assure brake system performance  all brake  system components should be inspected periodically   Suggested service intervals can be found in the  Mainte   nance Schedule  in this manual     WARNINCG     Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and  possibly an accident  Driving with your foot resting    or riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally  high brake temperatures  excessive lining wear  and  possible brake damage  You wouldn t have your full  braking capacity in an emergency        Brake and Power Steering Hoses   When the vehicle is serviced for scheduled maintenance   inspect surface of hoses and nylon tubing for evidence of  heat and mechanical damage  Hard and brittle rubber   cracking  tears  cuts  abrasion  and excessive swelling  indicate deterioration of the rubber  Particular attention  should be made to examining those
277. re injuries in a collision  The airbags work  with your seat belt to restrain you properly  In  some collisions  the airbags won t deploy at all    10  If the airbag system in this vehicle needs to be Always wear your seat belts even though you   modified to accommodate a disabled person  contact the have airbags    Customer Center  Phone numbers are provided in the  If   You Need Customer Assistance  section in this manual     9  If your vehicle has side curtain airbags do not lean  against the door  airbags will inflate forcefully into the  space between you and the door     Being too close to the steering wheel or instru   ment panel during airbag deployment could cause  serious injury  Airbags need room to inflate  Sit  back  comfortably extending your arms to reach  the steering wheel or instrument panel     If the vehicle has side curtain airbags  they also  need room to inflate  Do not lean against the door  or window  Sit upright in the center of the seat        Air Bag System Components  The airbag system consists of the following     e Airbag Control Module  ACM     e Side Remote Acceleration Sensors  if equipped     42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    Airbag Warning Light  Driver Airbag  Front Passenger Airbag    Supplemental Side Curtain Airbags above Side Win   dows  if equipped     Steering Wheel and Column  Instrument Panel  Interconnecting Wiring  Seatbelt Reminder Light  Knee Impact Bolsters   Front Acceleration Sensors    Driver and Front Pas
278. re it is latched by strongly pulling on the top of the  seatback above the seat strap        128 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  NN Id    WARNING     e The weight and position of cargo and passengers    WARNING     e Be certain that the seatback is securely locked into    position  If the seatback in not securely locked  into position  the seat will not provide the proper  stability for child seats and or passengers  An  improperly latched seat could cause serious in   jury    The cargo area in the rear of the vehicle  with the  rear seatbacks in the locked up or folded down  position  should not be used as a play area by  children when the vehicle is in motion  They  could be seriously injured in an accident  Chil   dren should be seated and using the proper re   straint system     To help protect against personal injury  passen   gers should not be seated in the rear cargo area   The rear cargo space is intended for load carrying  purposes only  not for passengers  who should sit  in seats and use seat belts        can change the vehicle center of gravity and    vehicle handling  To avoid loss of control result   ing in personal injury  follow these guidelines for  loading your vehicle        e Always place cargo evenly on the cargo floor  Put  heavier objects as low and as far forward as possible     e Place as much cargo as possible in front of the rear  axle  Too much weight or improperly placed weight  over or behind the rear axle can cause the rear of the  
279. re manual  you may miss important  information  Observe all Warnings and Cautions     VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER   The vehicle identification number  VIN  is on the left  front corner of the instrument panel  The VIN is visible  from outside of the vehicle through the windshield  This  number also appears on the Automobile Information  Disclosure Label affixed to a window on your vehicle  the  vehicle registration  and the title           VIN LOCATION  NOTE  It is illegal to remove the VIN     N INTRODUCTION 7    VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS   ALTERATIONS    WARNING     Any modifications or alterations to this vehicle       could seriously affect its roadworthiness and safety  and may lead to an accident resulting in serious  injury or death           THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE    CONTENTS   NA Word About Your Keys                   11  Hlgnition  Key Removal  244422452 ER EES RR 11  EH Rey m lenition Reminder is esae eves 12   it Key PE 12  O Replacement Keys s oo   oe dor sup 939 tay eon 13  O Customer Key Programming                14  OGeneral forman  amp  ewe o 3 ie d Eee dee 15   W Security Alarm System     If Equipped         15  O Rearming OF The System o cn aces SR pres 15    Ellie SEDE lhe Oy Ste as cand g P aane Abe bie riii 15  O To Disarm Ihe System sicas dcos HEER DR masi 16    N illuminated Entry System                   1  Bl Remote Keyless Entry                      17  O 1o Unlock The Doors  2   2444   4  y5eues  4 18  Elo Lock Hie Dore   aru ri
280. re redo ice earned RE 18  ELIO Unlatce Ihe AK uu ote se oa ER Rm ens 19  O Using The Panic Alarm iss ate Ses pe tea 19  O Programming Additional Transmitters          19  O Battery Replacement   5 ss eke ER DERE N 19  Hi General ORE ODE sarreretan d 9 o See 20  M Door Locks ixexsadkesescdRecbresQesds   21  E Manual Door LooRS    o roos ri e n oe ER NE 21    10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE NN    O Power Door Locks 45224 43 unm ike 21  O Child Protection Door Lock                 22  B Windows                    eee 25  O Power Windows              00 eee eee 25  OWind Dulienng 244s EERS sos e Re ag Ped 27  W Trunk Lock And Release                    28  B Trunk Safety Warning                      29  DH Trunk Emergency Release    o ccevecauna saad 29  W Occupant Restraints            llle 30  lap  Shoulder Bets os 22 ES PER KOR SR RR CR 30  O Lap Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure       2D  O Seat Belt Pretensioners               000  OD   D Enhanced Seat Belt Reminder System   BeltAlert      gee E ME DER IG PSI S 9D  o Automatic Locking Mode     If Equipped       36    O Seat Belts And Pregnant Women              O Seat Belt Extender    O Driver And Front Passenger Supplemental  Restraint System  SRS    Airbag    D Event Data Recorder  EDR   D Child Restraint    Bl Break In Recommendations                  Ea Safety Tips  MEE EE exem  dope od  D Transporting Passengers  D Lock Your Vehicle  D Exhaust Gas    O Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The  Vehicle   
281. rear seat to install the child  restraint  You will easily feel them if you run your finger    along the intersection of the seatback and seat cushion  surfaces     The rear seat lower anchorages are round bars   located at the rear of the seat cushion where it    wz  In addition  there are tether strap anchorages  3l Ay behind each rear seating position located in the  panel between the rear seat back and the rear  window  These tether strap anchorages are   under a plastic cover with this symbol on it   Many  but not all restraint systems will be equipped with    separate straps on each side  with each having a hook or  connector for attachment to the lower anchorage and a    means of adjusting the tension in the strap  Forward   facing toddler restraints and some rear facing infant  restraints will also be equipped with a tether strap  a  hook for attachment to the tether strap anchorage and a  means of adjusting the tension of the strap     You will first loosen the adjusters on the lower straps and  on the tether strap so that you can more easily attach the  hooks or connectors to the vehicle anchorages  Next   attach the lower hooks or connectors over the top of the  seat cover material  Then rotate the tether anchorage  cover directly behind the seat where you are placing the  child restraint and attach the tether strap to the anchor   age  being careful to route the tether strap to provide the  most direct path between the anchor and the child  restraint  Finally  tig
282. reset  the display will read   RESET  or show dashes for two seconds  Then  the  history information will be erased  and the averaging will  continue from the last fuel average reading before the  reset     148 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    e Distance To Empty  DTE    Shows the estimated distance that can be traveled with  the fuel remaining in the tank  This estimated distance is  determined by a weighted average of the instantaneous  and average fuel economy  according to the current fuel  tank level  DTE cannot be reset through the FUNCTION  SELECT button     NOTE  Significant changes in driving style or vehicle  loading will greatly affect the actual drivable distance of  the vehicle  regardless of the DTE displayed value     e When the DTE value is less than 30 miles  48 km   estimated driving distance  the DTE display will  change to a text display of  LOW FUEL   This display  will continue until the vehicle runs out of fuel  Adding  a significant amount of fuel to the vehicle will turn off  the  LOW FUEL    text and a new DTE value will  display    e Trip A   Shows the total distance traveled for trip A since the last   reset     e Trip B  Shows the total distance traveled for trip B since the last  reset     e Elapsed Time   Shows the total elapsed time of travel since the last reset  when the ignition switch is in the ACC position  Elapsed  time will increment when the ignition switch is in the ON  or STARI position     e Display Units of Measure in  
283. rity allows the  UConnect    system to know which cellular phone to  use if multiple cellular phones are in the vehicle at the  same time  For example  if priority 3 and priority 5  phones are present in the vehicle  the UConnect     system will use the priority 3 cellular phone when you  make a call  You can select to use a lower priority  cellular phone at any time  refer to  Advanced Phone  Connectivity       Call Dial by Saying a Number    Press the  Phone  button to begin     After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Dial      System will prompt you to say the number you want  call     For example  you can say  234 567 8901         e The UConnect    system will confirm the phone num   ber and then dial  The number will appear in the  display of certain radios     Call Dial by Saying a Name    e Press the  Phone  button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Dial  or Call      System will prompt you to say the name of the person  you want call     After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say  the name of the person you want to call  For example   you can say  John Doe     where John Doe is a previ   ously stored name entry in the UConnect    phone   book  Refer to  Add Names to Your UConnect     Phonebook     to learn how to store a name in the  phonebook     The UConnect    system will confirm the name and  then dial the corresponding phone number  which  may appear in the display of certain radios     70 UNDERSTANDING 
284. rn off the engine if you want to rest or  sleep in your car  Accidents can be caused by  inadvertently moving the gear selection lever or  by pressing the accelerator pedal  This may cause  excessive heat in the exhaust system  resulting in  overheating and vehicle fire  which may cause  serious or fatal injuries        ee STARTING AND OPERATING 197    Automatic Transmission   The gear selector must be in the NEUTRAL or PARK  position before you can start the engine  Apply the brakes  before shifting into any driving gear     Normal Starting   Normal Starting of either a cold or a warm engine is  obtained without pumping or depressing the accelerator  pedal  Turn the key to the    START    position and release  when the engine starts  If the engine has not started  within 3 seconds  slightly depress the accelerator pedal  while continuing to crank  If the engine fails to start  within 15 seconds  turn the key to the    LOCK    position   wait 10 to 15 seconds  then repeat the normal starting  procedure     Extremely Cold Weather  below    20  F or     29  C   To insure reliable starting at these temperatures  use of an  externally powered electric engine block heater  available  from your dealer  is recommended     If Engine Fails To Start   If the engine fails to start after you have followed the     NORMAL STARTING    procedure  it may be flooded   Push the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and  hold it there while cranking the engine  This should clear  any excess
285. ront  door windows through the side window demister  grilles     e Floor     Air flows through the floor outlets located  under the instrument panel and into the rear  seating area through vents under the front seats     UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 187    e Bi Level  ugh Air flows through the outlets located in the  instrument panel and through the outlets lo   cated on the floor  Air flows through the registers in  the back of the center console to the rear seat  passengers  These registers can be closed to block  airflow     e Panel   A Air flows through the outlets located in the  instrument panel  Air flows through the regis    ters in the back of the center console to the rear seat   passengers  These registers can be closed to block    airflow   e Air Conditioning Control  ro Press this button to turn on the air condition   ing during manual operation only  When the  air conditioning is turned on  cool dehumidi   fied air will flow through the outlets selected with  the Mode control dial  Press this button a second  time to turn off the air conditioning  An LED in the    button illuminates when manual compressor opera   tion is selected        188 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    NOTE  To control the air conditioning manually  the  mode selector must be moved out of the AUTO position     e Recirculation Control  This button can be used to block out smoke   c odors  dust  high humidity  or if rapid cooling  is desired  The recirculation mode should o
286. rting Passengers  NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO  AREA     WARNING     It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area   inside or outside of a vehicle  In a collision  people  riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously    injured or killed     Do not allow people to ride in any area of your  vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts   Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and  using a seat belt properly        Lock Your Vehicle   Always remove the keys from the ignition and lock all  doors when leaving the vehicle unattended  even in your  own driveway or garage  Try to park your vehicle in a  well lit area and never invite theft by leaving articles of  value exposed     Exhaust Gas  Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in confined  areas any longer than needed to move your vehicle in or  out of the area     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57    If it is necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with the engine  running  adjust your heating or cooling controls to force  outside air into the vehicle  Set the blower at high speed     The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into  the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust  system     Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaust  system  when exhaust fumes can be detected inside the  vehicle  or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is  damaged  have a competent mechanic inspect the com   plete exhaust system and adjacent body are
287. rument cluster on the transmission range indica   tor     NOTE    e In Autostick   mode  the transmission will only shift  up and down when the driver manually moves the  selector lever Right  D   or Left  D       208 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE    An UPSHIFT message will appear in the Electronic  Vehicle Information Center  EVIC  portion of the in   strument cluster when using Autostick    This message  appears in order to alert the driver to upshift to the  next gear  The UPSHIFT message will display while  operating the vehicle at higher engine revolutions per   minute  RPM      You can shift in or out of the Autostick  mode at any time  without taking your foot off the accelerator pedal  When  you wish to engage Autostick   simply move the selector  lever to the Right  D   or Left  D   while in the D  Drive   position  The transmission will remain in the current gear  until an upshift or downshift is chosen  When you wish  to disengage Autostick    hold the selector lever to the  right for at least one second  The transmission will now  operate automatically  shifting between the five available  gears     Autostick  General Information    You can start out in first or second gear  The system  will ignore attempts to upshift at too low of a vehicle  speed     The transmission will automatically downshift to first  gear when coming to a stop     Starting out in second gear is helpful in snowy or icy  conditions     Avoid using speed control when Autostick  is en   gaged     
288. s below 32   F  0   C   unless the  wiper control on the multi function lever is moved  or  the vehicle speed becomes greater than 0 mph  0  km h   or the outside temperature rises above freez   ing    Neutral Wipe Inhibit     The rain sensing feature will  not operate when the ignition is ON  and the trans   mission shift lever is in the N  Neutral  position  and  the vehicle speed is less than 5 mph  8 km h   unless  the wiper control on the multi function lever is moved  or the shift lever is moved out of the N  Neutral   position     104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    Adding Washer Fluid   The windshield washer fluid reservoir is located in the  front of the engine compartment on the passenger side of  the vehicle  Be sure to check the fluid level in the  reservoir at regular intervals  Fill the reservoir with  windshield washer solvent  not radiator antifreeze  and  operate the system for a few seconds to flush out the  residual water    mu  i       Washer Fluid Reservoir       The fluid reservoir will hold nearly 1 gallon  4 liters  of  washer fluid when the message  Low Washer Fluid   appears in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center   EVIC      WARNINCG     Commercially available windshield washer solvents    are flammable  They could ignite and burn you  Care  must be exercised when filling or working around  the washer solution        NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105    HEADLIGHT WASHERS   The multi function lever operates the he
289. s constituents and certain  vehicle components contain or emit chemicals  known to the State of California to cause cancer and    birth defects or other reproductive harm  In addition   certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain prod   ucts of component wear contain or emit chemicals  known to the State of California to cause cancer and  birth defects or other reproductive harm        HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL  Consult the table of contents to determine which section  contains the information you desire     The detailed index  at the rear of this manual  contains a  complete listing of all subjects     Consult the following table for a description of the  symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout  this owner   s manual        d   WEE m m      i   ad  r i     r   Lc od      WATER IM FUEL REAR WINDOW WINDSHIELD WIPER   BULE HIGH BEAM TURN SIBNALS PERA HEATED SEAT  WIPER INTERMITTENT OUTLET LOW             CX A          FUEL REAR WINDOW AIWOSHIELD MASTER LIGHTING KEY ACTIVATE UPPER AMD LOWER     HEATED SEAT  INTERMITTENT WIPER SWITCH  POWER OUTLET      AIR OUTLET HIGH  dl My WE Bu Ame Fh  m m  ior d mr     i rd   I      I  FUELFILLSIDE     REARWIMDOW WINDSHIELD WABHER DOME LIGHT     FROMTFOGLIGHT HOOD RELEASE LOWERAIR   RECIRCULATION  WAGHER FLUID LEVEL OUTLET  uv O sc Gt cx x g  WINDSHIELD  LIFTGATE RELEASE  ENGINE DIL REAR WINDY ELECTRICALLY     PARKLIGHTB     REAR FOG LAMP     ANDLKTGATE     DEFROSTAND     VENTILATING FAN  DEFROST HEATED DPEN LOWER AIR GUTLET 
290. s the  SCROLL button to display anyone of the following  choices     e Oil Temperature  Shows the actual oil temperature     e Oil Pressure  Shows the actual oil pressure     e Tire Pressure  Shows the actual tire pressure for each tire  EXCLUDING  THE SPARE TIRE      Personal Settings  Customer Programmable  Features    Personal Settings allows the driver to set and recall  features when the transmission is in PARK     Press and release the MENU button until Personal Set   tings displays in the EVIC     Use the SCROLL button to display one of the following  choices      Language    When in this display you may select one of five lan   guages for all display nomenclature  including the trip  functions and the navigation system  if equipped   Press  the FUNCTION SELECT button while in this display to  select English  Espanol  Deutsch  Italiano  or Francais   Then  as you continue  the information will display in the  selected language     NOTE  The EVIC will not change the UConnect     language selection  Please refer to  Language Selection   in the HANDS FREE COMMUNICATION  UConnect7M   section of this manual for details      Lock Doors Automatically at 15 mph  24 Km h    When ON is selected  all doors will lock automatically  when the vehicle reaches a speed of 15 mph  24 km h    To make your selection  press and release the FUNC   TION SELECT button until  ON  or  OFF  appears        154 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id     Unlock Doors Automatically on Exit    Wh
291. se requires a cellular  phone equipped with the Bluetooth  Hands Free Profile    version 0 96 or higher  See www chrysler com uconnect  for supported phones     UConnect    allows you to transfer calls between the  system and your cellular phone as you enter or exit your  vehicle  and enables you to mute the system s micro   phone for private conversation     The UConnect    phonebook enables you to store up to 32  names and four numbers per name  Each language has a  separate 32 name phonebook accessible only in that    language  This system is driven through your Blue   tooth   Hands Free profile cellular phone  UConnect     features Bluetooth   technology   the global standard  that enables different electronic devices to connect to  each other without wires or a docking station  so UCon   nect works no matter where you stow your cellular  phone  be it your purse  pocket  or briefcase   as long as  your phone is turned on and has been paired to the  vehicle s UConnect    system  The UConnect    system  allows up to seven cellular phones to be linked to system   Only one linked  or paired  cellular phone can be used  with the system at a time  The system is available in  English  Spanish  or French languages  as equipped      The rearview mirror contains the microphone for the  system and the control buttons that will enable you to  access the system     N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 67       8105b20d    UConnect    Switches   The UConnect    system can be us
292. seat cushion while the  child s back is against the seat back  they should use a  belt positioning booster seat  The child and belt   positioning booster seat are held in the vehicle by the  lap shoulder belt     Children Too Large For Booster Seats   Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt  comfortably  and whose legs are long enough to bend  over the front of the seat when their back is against the  seat back  should use the lap  shoulder belt in a rear seat     e Make sure that the child is upright in the seat     e The lap portion should be low on the hips and as snug  as possible     e Check belt fit periodically  A child s squirming or  slouching can move the belt out of position     e  f the shoulder belt contacts the face or neck  move the  child closer to the center of the vehicle  Never allow a  child to put the shoulder belt under an arm or behind  their back     NOTE  For additional information  refer to  www seatcheck org or call 1 866 SEATCHECK     50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE ME    e The restraint must be appropriate for your child s  weight and height  Check the label on the restraint for   e Improper installation can lead to failure of an weight and height limits   infant or child restraint  It could come loose in a  collision  The child could be badly injured or    killed  Follow the manufacturer s directions ex   actly when installing an infant or child restraint     e Carefully follow the instructions that come with the  r
293. senger Seat Belt Pretensioners    How The Airbag System Works    The Airbag Control Module  ACM  determines if a  frontal collision is severe enough to require the airbags  to inflate  The front airbag inflators are designed to    provide different rates of airbag inflation from direc   tion provided by the ACM  The ACM will not detect  roll over     e The ACM also monitors the readiness of the electronic    parts of the system whenever the ignition switch is in  the START or ON positions  These include all of the  items listed above except the knee bolster  the instru   ment panel  and the steering wheel and column  If the  key is in the LOCK position  in the ACC position  or  not in the ignition  the airbags are not on and will not  inflate    e The ACM also turns on the Airbag Warning  Light in the instrument panel for 6 to 8  seconds as a self check when the ignition is  first turned on  After the self check  the   Airbag Warning Light will turn off  If the ACM detects   a malfunction in any part of the system  it turns on the   Airbag Warning Light either momentarily or continu    ously  A single chime will sound if the light comes on   again after initial start up          t    NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43    WARNING     driver   s front airbag gas is vented through vent holes  in the sides of the airbag  The passenger   s front airbag    Ignoring the AIRBAG Warning Light in your instru   ment panel could mean you won t have the airbags    to protec
294. senger s seat will move up or down  forward or  rearward     Delete a name Delete  Language Select language  List names List all   List paired phones List phones  Pager beeper    Phone pairing Pairing   Phonebook Phone book   Return to main menu Return  Main menu   Select phone select   Set up Phone settings phone set  BP       Power Seat Switch    86 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    WARNING     Adjusting a seat while the vehicle is moving is  dangerous  The sudden movement of the seat could  cause you to lose control  The seat belt might not be  properly adjusted and you could be injured  Adjust  the seat only while the vehicle is parked     CAUTION     Do not place any article under a power seat as it may  cause damage to the seat controls        Power Seat Recline Switch    WARNING     Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the  shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest        Power Reclining Seats  The recliner control is located on the outboard side of the  seat     In a collision you could slide under the seat belt and  be seriously or even fatally injured  Use the recliner  only when the vehicle is parked           UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 87    Lumbar Support The head restraints have a locking button  which must be  This feature allows you to increase or decrease the pushed in to lower the head restraint  The restraints may  amount of lumbar support  Turn the control lever for  be raised wi
295. sensitive nature  such as would  identify a particular driver  vehicle  or crash  will be    treated confidentially  Confidential data will not be dis   closed by DaimlerChrysler to any third party except  when     1  Used for research purposes  such as to match data  with a particular crash record in an aggregate database   provided confidentiality of personal data is thereafter  preserved    2  Used in defense of  DaimlerChrysler product    litigation involving a    3  Requested by police under a legal warrant  4  Otherwise required by law  Data Parameters that May Be Recorded     e Diagnostic trouble code s  and warning light status for  electronically controlled safety systems  including the  airbag system    e  Time    of airbag deployment  in terms of ignition  cycles and vehicle mileage     e Airbag deployment level  if applicable   e Seatbelt status    THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47    e Brake status  service and parking brakes    e Accelerator status  including vehicle speed    e Engine control status  including engine speed   e Cruise control status  if applicable    e Traction stability control status  if applicable     Child Restraint   Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up all the  time     babies and children  too  Every state in the United  States and all Canadian provinces require that small  children ride in proper restraint systems  This is the law   and you can be prosecuted for ignoring it     Children 12 years and under should ri
296. sh during acceleration  ease up on the  accelerator and apply as little throttle as possible  Be sure  to adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road  conditions     es STARTING AND OPERATING 217    WARNING     The ESP  Electronic Stability Program  cannot pre   vent the natural laws of physics from acting on the  vehicle  nor can it increase the traction afforded by  prevailing road conditions  The ESP cannot prevent  accidents  including those resulting from excessive    speed in turns  driving on very slippery surfaces  or  hydroplaning  Only a safe  attentive  and skillful  driver can prevent accidents  The capabilities of an  ESP equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a  reckless or dangerous manner  which could jeopar   dize the user   s safety or the safety of others        The ESP system has 3 available operating modes     ESP On   This is the normal operating mode for the ESP  When   ever the vehicle is started  the ESP system will be in  this mode  This mode should be used for most all  driving situations  The ESP should only be turned off  for specific reasons as noted in the following para   graphs     Partial Off   The    Partial Off  mode is intended for times when a  more spirited driving experience is desired  It is also  intended for driving in deep snow  sand  or gravel   This mode disables the TCS portion of the ESP and  raises the threshold for ESP activation  which allows  for more wheel spin than what ESP normally allows     The  ESP OFF  bu
297. shown  to reduce spark plug life and reduce emission system  performance in some vehicles  The manufacturer recom   mends using gasolines without MMT  Since the MMT  content of gasoline may not be indicated on the pump   you should ask your gasoline retailer if his her gasoline  contains MMT     It is even more important to look for gasolines without  MMT in Canada  because MMT can be used at levels  higher than allowed in the United States  MMT is pro   hibited in Federal and California reformulated gasolines     Materials Added to Fuel   All gasoline sold in the United States is required to  contain effective detergent additives  Use of additional  detergents or other additives are not needed under       248 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE    normal conditions and they would result in additional  cost  Therefore  you should not have to add anything to  the fuel     Fuel System Cautions    CAUTION     Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicle s  performance        e The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law   Using leaded gasoline can impair engine performance   or damage the emission control system     e An out of tune engine  or certain fuel or ignition  malfunctions  can cause the catalytic converter to  overheat  If you notice a pungent burning odor or  some light smoke  your engine may be out of tune or  malfunctioning and may require immediate service   Contact your dealer for service assistance     e The use of fuel additives  which are now being sold as  o
298. sole outlet is powered directly from the Electrical Outlet Use With Engine Off  battery  power available at all times   Items plugged into    this outlet may discharge the battery and or prevent  engine starting  CAUTION     Many accessories that can be plugged in draw  power from the vehicle s battery  even when not  in use  i e  cellular phones  etc    Eventually  if  plugged in long enough  the vehicle s battery will  discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life  and or prevent engine starting     Accessories that draw higher power  i e  coolers   vacuum cleaners  lights  etc   will degrade the  battery even more quickly  Only use these inter     mittently and with greater caution     After the use of high power draw accessories  or  long periods of the vehicle not being started  with  accessories still plugged in   the vehicle must be  driven a sufficient length of time to allow the  alternator to recharge the vehicle s battery     BEE ae aa aa he  Ji ara m m m s mam m a ach m mmm m mmm seed d       Ux  ros War os WE War UR Wa Pr EE ek oa Tes WE Re Re OE    Center Console Power Outlet    Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs  only  Do not hang any type of accessory or acces   sory bracket from the plug  Improper use of the  power outlet can cause damage not covered by  your warranty        126 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE M    CUP HOLDERS    Front Seat Cup Holders  The cup holders are located in the forward edge of the  center console     Push dow
299. t        3  Set the parking brake  place the automatic transmis   sion in PARK  and turn the ignition switch to the OFF  or  LOCK  position on both vehicles     4  Turn off the heater  radio  and all unnecessary electri   cal loads     5  Connect one end of the jumper cable to the remote  jump start positive battery post  4  in the engine com   partment  Connect the other end of the same cable to the  positive terminal of the booster battery  Refer to the  following illustration for jump starting connections     6  Connect the other cable  first to the negative terminal  of the booster battery and then to the engine ground      of the vehicle with the discharged battery  Make sure  you have a good contact on the engine ground  Refer to  the following illustration for jump starti    Britta       M  se E          LED  LEES    22  Ty  ES    Mm ttt emm    Jump Starting        260 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES Se  WARNING  8  When removing the jumper cables  reverse the above  sequence exactly  Be careful of the moving belts and fan   e You should not try to start your vehicle by push   WARNING     ing or towing   Do not connect the cable to the negative post of  Any procedure other than above could result in     the discharge battery  The resulting electrical  spark could cause the battery to explode  1  Personal injury caused by electrolyte squirting    out the battery vent     During cold weather when temperatures are be   low freezing point  electrolyte in a discharged  battery ma
300. t 45224224 om ea 99  Disposal  Antifreeze  Engine Coolant    exams 290    Nn INDEX 349    Bee eiers ARE RE KAS ET FEE TE FR IS 21  Door Locks  Automatic                  en 22  Deer Opener  Garage is ariegde ed de d bg ds 116  Drive Deus 2424552465064 quss SON RUP EAS 278  Driving   On Slippery Surfaces iua ues sod DORRE DE 209  DVD Player  Video Entertainment System       174  Electric Remote Mirrors       4 d pr RE 64  Electrical Power Outlets      ve dorem ss 124  Electronic Brake Control System              214  Electronic Speed Control  Cruise Control        109  Electronic Stability Program  ESP             216  Electronic Throttle Control Warning Light       141    Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC     144  Emergency  In Case of    Freeing Vehicle When Stuck               265  Hazard  Warning Flasher ses ie icon aot Se 256  FUGA SEED E Spat oak hd wok he ee eee a 262   OVOEDOQUUD  4559322 ER TROP NE Sones 290  TOWING  T                 266  Emission Control System Maintenance      273 318    In ROOS EE EET EER EE AE N 271    Air Cleaner 23 34 35  9 DOORS E 279  Block Heater                leen 199  Break In Recommendations                 D5  Checking Oil Level de wx erar Ged dos 275  COBDALITDIENL 6454  aussohs kerries DAS cas 271  Coolant  Antifreeze                   287 314   CODI 24 4 d qUI IE ERROR e bog ETE qt ds 287  Exhaust Gas Caution               s  56 248  balls TO Starf 423   5x63 AGA ESRA EUR E RU 197  Flooded  rie 2d acie acd A eire e EER PORE
301. t a td ES EP PEPER 1     EER EE EI Ee  RR ee hh EE EER RARR EE ER PEPER ER n    DELE  SAS  Te    Pech Re RA EER EP EE ER EER ER n  b          PERDE ERRORI eee  De eS ee eens    eS     5  TS    Se  Se  os  Ss    EIER    E       M   T  Ta  T  E  ES  ae  wee  iit  prs  ERIT  PEE  ERE   I  ERIT  PES  sat  e     TOBISSSSSDINMNANAANNNA    Se  DEEEEEMI    freti ORREL RR OR EER RO s Te n n n e ie Aa Re Ho Re IUNII  DRE  fiet RR EE te IR EE EE Pe ia SI    TEE EER EIER    et te ed te a    eth   rte coor    eee  moceIsTTsT2SIICTISI    Peete ETIS  ee eed ee eel  ELE  ETER EI    12345 6       2  In this example the large clock appears on the screen     setting mode   ill not be saved     it from the clock    in to decrease the clock by another minute   Select    DONE    to ex  Press ENTER to save your changes  If you press CAN     6   CEL or NAV then your changes w    ENTER aga    81980935    174 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL M    3  To switch the clock to the small clock  quickly press  TIME again     123 45 6        19a09ac    4  To toggle back to the large clock  simply press TIME        VIDEO ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM  SALES CODE  XRV      IF EQUIPPED   The optional VESTM  Video Entertainment System  con   sists of a DVD player and LCD  liquid crystal display   screen  a battery powered remote control  and two head   sets  The system is located in the center console storage  bin under the armrest lid  Refer to your VESTM User s  Manual for detailed operating instructions        mg  P
302. t to the rear fascia   2  Remove the bulb and socket assembly     3  Pull the bulb out of the socket assembly               Tex          N BiBdb273        License Light Bulb  2     Socket    N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 313  4  Push the replacement bulb into the socket assembly  FLUIDS AND CAPACITIES    5  Reinstall the bulb and socket assembly  US Metric   6 R TEER Pad TE Fuel  approximate    e l  the light to the rear fascia  and then install the 6 1 Liter Engine 19 gal    72 liters    lons    Engine Oil with Filter    6 1 Liter Engine  SAE 0W 40  6 6 liters  Cooling System     6 1 Liter Engine  Mopar   Antifreeze Coolant 5 Year   100 000 Mile Formula  or  equivalent       Includes heater and coolant recovery bottle filled to  MAX level               ters       314 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id  FLUIDS  LUBRICANTS  AND GENUINE PARTS    Engine  Component  Engine Coolant    Engine Oil  6 1 Liter     Oil Filter  6 1 Liter   Spark Plugs    Fluids  Lubricants  and Genuine Parts  Mopar  Antifreeze Coolant 5 Year 100 000 Mile Formula HOAT  Hybrid Or   ganic Additive Technology  or equivalent    For best performance and maximum protection under all types of operating  conditions  the manufacturer only recommends full synthetic engine oils that  meet the American Petroleum Institute  API  categories of SM or SM CF  and  meet the requirements of DaimlerChrysler Material Standard MS 10725  The    manufacturer recommends the use of a full synthetic engine oil  such as Mo   bil 19 SAE 0W
303. t you in a collision  If the light does not  come on  stays on after you start the vehicle  or if it  comes on as you drive  have the airbag system  checked right away     e The Driver and Front Passenger Airbag Inflator  Units are located in the center of the steering wheel  and the passenger side of the instrument panel  When  the ACM detects a collision requiring the airbags  it  signals the inflator units  A large quantity of nontoxic  gas is generated to inflate the front airbags  Different  airbag inflation rates may be possible based on colli   sion severity  The steering wheel hub trim cover  and  the upper passenger side of the instrument panel  separate and fold out of the way  as the bags inflate to  their full size  The bags fully inflate in about 50   70  milliseconds  This is about half of the time that it takes  to blink your eyes  The bags then quickly deflate while  helping to restrain the driver and front passenger  The       gas is vented through vent holes in the sides of the  airbag  In this way  the airbags do not interfere with  your control of the vehicle     The Side Impact SRS Side Curtain Airbag are de   signed to activate only in certain side collisions  When  the ACM  with side impact option  detects a collision  requiring the side curtain airbag to inflate  it signals  the inflators on the crash side of the vehicle  A quantity  of nontoxic gas is generated to inflate the side curtain  airbag  The inflating side curtain airbag pushes the  outside 
304. te Control Mirrors               D Heated Remote Control Mirrors                 O Illuminated Vanity Mirrors                    ll Hands Free Communication  UConnect          If Equipped    BOPE OIS Tr  m 67  H Phone Call Featutes 446 44 2464655240044 79  Ee  UGonnect    System Features   345  5n 75  H Advanced Phone Connectivity               78  H Things You Should Know About Your  DE onde le ya sor eet ER REDE Vue ds 80  ic aas se HERE RAAD HER DEd 85  uini ideo o TERT  85  E Power Reclining Seats 4 9 RI HIE EER 4 ER 86  EL bal SUDORE e iag acu eorr REIR RR daa 87  OHead Restate  2s stus DI AR GEROL sekreti 87    O Heated Seats       60 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  ee    Folding Rear Seat essercene yai tro PES 89  ll Driver Memory Seat     If Equipped           90  O Programming The Memory Feature           90  O Linking  amp  Unlinking The Remote Keyless  Transmitter To The Memory Feature           91  O Memory Position Recall              sels 92  H Easy Entry   Exit Seat  Available With Memory  JURO CE  97  W To Open And Close The Hood               93  ME EEEE RE OEE dep ds 95  Head it SWI oo sese genit qmi HOE OE RE dep 95  H Automatic THeadlislils  ue uu a s 95  o Headlights On With Wipers       ss sesse 96  O Smartbeams     If Equipped                 96  Fitleadlielit Time Delay    2224s 03454004664 RES 97  a Daytime Running Lights  Canada Only         98    OLights On Reminder 65 4 csi a ww to ER CERE 98  DPO L AE EO AE S PPP E aa 98  E Multi Funct
305. the airbags deploy after an impact and the electrical  system remains functional  vehicles equipped with  power door locks will unlock automatically  In addition   approximately 5 seconds after the vehicle has stopped  moving  the interior lights will illuminate to aid visibility     Do not modify the front bumper  vehicle body  structure  or frame     NOTE  The interior lights can only be deactivated if the  key is removed from the ignition switch or the vehicle is  driven     You need proper knee impact protection in a  collision  Do not mount or locate any aftermarket  equipment on or behind the knee impact bolster     It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the  airbag system yourself  Be sure to tell anyone who  works on your vehicle that it has airbags        46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    Airbag Warning Light  You will want to have the airbags ready to      inflate for your protection in an impact  While  PN the airbag system is designed to be mainte   nance free  if any of the following occurs  have  an authorized dealer service the system promptly     e The Airbag Warning Light does not come on or flickers  during the 6 to 8 seconds when the ignition switch is  first turned on     e The light remains on or flickers after the 6 to 8 second  interval     e The light flickers or comes on and remains on while  driving     Event Data Recorder  EDR    In the event of an airbag deployment  your vehicle is  designed to record up to 2 seconds of spec
306. the belt  system periodically  checking for cuts  frays  or loose    parts  Damaged parts must be replaced immediately   Do not disassemble or modify the system  Seat belt  assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they  have been damaged  bent retractor  torn webbing   etc          Adjusting Upper Shoulder Belt  As a guide  if you are shorter than average  you will  prefer a lower position  and if you are taller than average   you will prefer a higher position  When you release the  anchorage  try to move it up and down to make sure that  it is locked in position     Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage   In the driver and front passenger seats  the shoulder belt  can be adjusted upward or downward to position the belt  away from your neck  Push and fully depress the button  above the webbing to release the anchorage  and then  move it up or down to the position that serves you best     NOTE  When the shoulder belt is adjusted to the full  downward position  it will not be at the bottom of the slot  in the Trim Panel  This is normal  and the intended lowest  position     In the rear seat  move toward the center of the seat to  position the belt away from your neck     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35    Lap Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure    Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap   shoulder belt     1  Position the latch plate as close as possible to the  anchor point     2  At about 6 to 12 inches  15 to 30 cm  above the latch  p
307. the switch forward and  release to Express Close     NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 123    Pinch Protect Override   If a known obstruction  ice  debris  etc   prevents closing   press the switch forward and hold for two seconds after  the reversal occurs  This allows the sunroof to move  towards the closed position     NOTE  Pinch protection is disabled while the switch is  pressed     Venting Sunroof   Express   Press and release the  V  button  and the sunroof will  open to the vent position  This is called Express Vent   which operates regardless of sunroof position  During  Express Vent operation  any movement of the switch will  stop the sunroof     Sunshade Operation  The sunshade can be opened manually  However  the  sunshade will open automatically as the sunroof opens     NOTE  The sunshade cannot be closed if the sunroof is  open     Wind Buffeting   Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of  pressure on the ears or a helicopter type sound in the  ears  Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the  windows down  or the sunroof  if equipped  in certain  open or partially open positions  This is a normal occur   rence and can be minimized  If the buffeting occurs with  the rear windows open  then open the front and rear  windows together to minimize the buffeting  If the  buffeting occurs with the sunroof open  then adjust the  sunroof opening to minimize the buffeting or open any  window     Sunroof Maintenance  Use only a non abrasive c
308. these steps     1  Press and hold the desired HomeLink button  Do  NOT release the button     2  The EVIC will display  Channel X Transmit   where X  is Channel 1  2  or 3  for 20 seconds and then change to   Channel X Training   Without releasing the HomeLink  button  proceed with  Programming  Step 2     N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 121    For questions or comments  contact HomeLink at  www homelink com or 1 800 355 3515     Security   If you sell your vehicle  be sure to erase the frequencies  by following the  Erasing HomeLink Buttons  instruc   tions in this section     This device complies with part 15 of FCC rules and with  RSS 210 of Industry Canada  Operation is subject to the  following conditions     e This device may not cause harmful interference     e This device must accept any interference that may be  received including interference that may cause undes   ired operation     NOTE  Changes or modifications not expressly ap   proved by the party responsible for compliance could  void the user s authority to operate the equipment     HomeLink  is a trademark owned by Johnson Controls   Inc        POWER SUNROOF     IF EQUIPPED    The power sunroof switch is located between the sun  visors on the overhead console     ul  TE  Tt    x  E  x  E    IEEE    EE inia   AR Ee PEPER  kri    Power Sunroof Controls    122 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  NN Id    WARNING     e Never leave children in a vehicle  with the keys in  the ignition switch 
309. thing  TIREFIT is harm   ful if inhaled  swallowed  or absorbed through the skin   It causes skin  eye  and respiratory irritation  Any con   tact with eyes or skin should be flushed immediately Hazard Flasher Switch   with plenty of water  If clothing comes in contact with 2  Move the transmission selector lever to the PARK    EE a posstel  s position  turn off the engine  and set the parking brake        In case of allergic reaction or rash  consult a physician  immediately  Keep TIREFIT out of reach of children  If 3  Remove the TIREFIT kit from the trunk     swallowed  rinse mouth immediately with plenty of  water and drink plenty of water  Do not induce vomit  4  Pull the power plug  2  and the TIREFIT sealant hose    ing  Consult a physician immediately   6  out from the TIREFIT kit     Keep away from open flame or heat source        260 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES M    5  Unscrew the valve cap from the valve on the deflated  tire     6  Screw the fitting at the end of TIREFIT sealant hose  6   coming from the sealant bottle  5  onto the tire valve     7  Insert the power plug  2  into the power point on the  instrument panel     8  Leave the parking brake set and the transmission  selector lever in PARK and start the engine     9  Press the switch  3  on the air pump to I  ON   The air  pump should start to inflate the tire and the tire sealant   white fluid  will flow from the sealant bottle  5  through  the TIREFIT sealant hose  6  and into the tire     10  Allow the a
310. thout pushing in the button    ward to increase and rearward to decrease the desired  amount of lumbar support          Heated Seats   Lumbar Support Control Lever Heated seats provide comfort and warmth on cold days  Head Restraints and can help soothe sore muscles and backs  The heaters  Head restraints can reduce the risk of whiplash injury in provide the same heat level for both cushion and back   the event of impact from the rear  Adjustable restraints The driver seat and front passenger seat are heated   should be adjusted so that the upper edge is as high as    l The controls for each heater are located near the bottom  practical     center of the instrument panel  After turning on the    88 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Ed    ignition  you can choose from High  Off  or Low heat  settings  Amber LEDs in the top portion of each switch  indicate the level of heat in use  Two LEDs will illuminate  for high  one for low  and none for off     E E   Front Heated Seat Switch  Press the switch once to select high level heating  Press  the switch a second time to select low level heating  Press  the switch a third time to shut off the heating elements     If high level heating is selected  the system will automati   cally switch to the low level after 30 minutes of continu   ous operation  At that time  the number of illuminated       LEDs changes from two to one  indicating the change   Operation on the low setting also turns off automatic
311. tings from your vehicle     The most common causes are     e Road salt  dirt  and moisture accumulation     e Stone and gravel impact    e  nsects  tree sap  and tar    e Salt in the air near seacoast localities    e Atmospheric fallout industrial pollutants   Washing    e Wash your vehicle regularly  Always wash your ve   hicle in the shade using Mopar  Car Wash or a mild  car wash soap  and rinse the panels completely with  clear water     e If insects  tar  or other similar deposits have accumu   lated on your vehicle  use Mopar  Super Kleen Bug  and Tar Remover to remove     e Use Mopar  Cleaner Wax to remove road film  stains  and to protect your paint finish  Take care never to  scratch the paint     e Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing  that may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint  finish     N NN MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 297    CAUTION  e  f you carry special cargo such as chemicals  fertilizers     de icer salt  etc   be sure that such materials are well  Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materials packaged and sealed     such as steel wool or scouring powder  which will      If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads  consider  scratch metal and painted surfaces     mud or stone shields behind each wheel        e Use Mopar  touch up paint or equivalent on scratches  as soon as possible  Your dealer has touch up paint to    Special Care    e  f you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive match the color of your vehicle   near   ocean  
312. tion  It tells you how to use your restraint system  properly to keep you and your passengers as safe as  possible     WARNING     In a collision  you and your passengers can suffer  much greater injuries if you are not properly buck     led up  You can strike the interior of your vehicle or  other passengers  or you can be thrown out of the  vehicle  Always be sure you and others in your  vehicle are buckled up properly        Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver  even  on short trips  Someone on the road may be a poor driver  and cause a collision that includes you  This can happen  far away from home or on your own street     Research has shown that seat belts save lives  and they  can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision  Some  of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown  from the vehicle  Seat belts reduce the possibility of  ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the  inside of the vehicle  Everyone in a motor vehicle should  be belted at all times     Lap Shoulder Belts  All seating positions in your vehicle are equipped with  Lap Shoulder Belts     The belt webbing retractor is designed to lock during  very sudden stops or impacts  This feature allows the  shoulder part of the belt to move freely with you under  normal conditions  However  in a collision  the belt will  lock and reduce your risk of striking the inside of the  vehicle or being thrown out     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31    WARNING  Lap 
313. tions you may have on tire  specifications or capability     WARNING     e Do not use a tire  wheel size or rating other than  that specified for your vehicle  Some combina   tions of unapproved tires and wheels may change  suspension dimensions and performance charac   teristics  resulting in changes to steering  han   dling  and braking of your vehicle  This can cause  unpredictable handling and stress to steering and  suspension components  You could lose control  and have an accident resulting in serious injury or  death  Use only the tire and wheel sizes with load  ratings approved for your vehicle     Never use a tire with a smaller load index or  capacity  other than what was originally equipped  on your vehicle  Using a tire with a smaller load  index could result in tire overloading and failure   You could lose control and have an accident     Failure to equip your vehicle with tires having  adequate speed capability can result in sudden  tire failure and loss of vehicle control        ee STARTING AND OPERATING 235    CAUTION     Replacing original tires with tires of a different size    may result in false speedometer and odometer read   ings     Alignment And Balance  Poor suspension alignment may result in     e Fast tire wear     e Uneven tire wear  such as feathering and one sided  wear     e Vehicle pull to right or left        Tires may also cause the vehicle to pull to the left or right   Alignment will not correct this condition  See your dealer  for proper 
314. tires   The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhile with  aggressive tread designs such as those on all season type  tires  Rotation will increase tread life  help to maintain  mud  snow  and wet traction levels  and contribute to a  smooth  quiet ride     Follow the    Maintenance Schedules    in Section 8 of this  manual for the recommended tire rotation frequency for  your type of driving  Remember  more frequent rotation  is permissible if desired  Also  correct for anything caus   ing rapid or unusual wear prior to performing the tire  rotation        238 STARTING AND OPERATING       Tire Rotation     Standard Tires Tire Rotation     All Season Tires  The suggested rotation method is the    side to side    as The suggested rotation method for vehicles equipped  shown in the following diagram  with all season tires is the  forward cross  as shown in    the following diagram     TIRE ROTATION PATTERN  FRONT OF VEHICLE       DM  SS                 EE  4 TIRE ROTATION    TIRE ROTATION PATTERN        t    FRONT OF VEHICLE  E       BObar tte    4 TIRE ROTATION    810B4335    ee STARTING AND OPERATING 239    TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM  TPMS      IF  EQUIPPED    e The TPM System will warn the driver of a low tire  pressure if the tire pressure falls below the low     e The Tire Pressure Monitor System  TPMS  will warn pressure warning limit for any reason  including low    the driver of a low tire pressure based on the vehicle  recommended cold placard pressure     e Th
315. tive call     Redial  e Press the  Phone  button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say   Redial      e The UConnect    system will call the last number that  was dialed on your cellular phone  Note  this may not  be the last number dialed from the UConnect    sys   tem     Call Continuation   Call continuation is progression of a phone call on  UConnect    system after the vehicle ignition key has  been switched to off  Call continuation functionality  available on the vehicle can be any one of three types     e After ignition key is switched off  a call can continue  on the UConnect    system either until the call ends or    N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 75    until the vehicle battery condition dictates cessation of  the call on the UConnect    system and transfer of the  call to the mobile phone     e After ignition key is switched to off  a call can continue  on the UConnect    system for certain duration  after  which the call is automatically transferred from the  UConnect    system to the mobile phone     e An active call is automatically transferred to the  mobile phone after ignition key is switched to off     UConnect    System Features    Language Selection  To change the language that the UConnect    system is  using     e Press the  Phone  button to begin     e After the  Ready  prompt and the following beep  say  the name of the language you wish to switch to   English  Espanol  or Francais  if so equipped      e Cont
316. to  60 minutes after the ignition switch is turned off  Open   ing either front door will cancel this feature  The time for  this feature is programmable  For details  refer to  Delay  Power Off to Accessories Until Exit     under    Personal  Settings  Customer Programmable Features   under   Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in Sec   tion 4 of this manual     Auto Up Feature with Anti Pinch Protection     If  Equipped   Lift the window switch to the second detent  release  and  the window will go up automatically     To stop the window from going all the way up during the  auto up operation  push down on the switch briefly     To close the window part way  lift the window switch to  the first detent and release it when you want the window  to stop     The power window switches will remain active for up to  60 minutes after the ignition switch is turned off  Open   ing either front door will cancel this feature  The time for  this feature is programmable  For details  refer to  Delay    Power Off to Accessories Until Exit     under  Personal  Settings  Customer Programmable Features   under   Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   in Sec   tion 4 of this manual     NOTE    e  f the window runs into any obstacle during auto   closure  it will reverse direction and then stop  Remove  the obstacle and use the window switch again to close  the window     e Any impact due to rough road conditions may trigger  the auto reverse function unexpectedly during auto  
317. top the fast forward  feature  If the RW button is pressed  the current track will  reverse to the beginning of the track and begin playing     Press the RND button a second time to stop Random  Play     Buttons 1   6  CD MODE for CD Audio Play   Selects disc positions 1   6 for Play Load Eject     Notes On Playing MP3 Files   The radio can play MP3 files  however  acceptable MP3  file recording media and formats are limited  When  writing MP3 files  pay attention to the following restric   tions     Supported Media  Disc Types   The MP3 file recording media supported by the radio are  CD ROM  CD R  and CD RW     Supported Medium Formats  File Systems    The medium formats supported by the radio are ISO 9660  Level 1 and Level 2 and includes the Joliet extension   When reading discs recorded using formats other than  ISO 9660 Level 1 and Level 2  the radio may fail to read    N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 167    files properly and may be unable to play the file nor   mally  UDF and Apple HFS formats are not supported     The radio uses the following limits for file systems   e Maximum number of directory levels  15   e Maximum number of files  255   e Maximum number of folders  100    e Maximum number of characters in file folder names     e Level 1  12  including a separator    and a  3 character extension   e Level 2  31  including a separator    and a    3 character extension     Multisession disc formats are supported by the radio   Multisession discs may contain 
318. tton is located in the switch  panel above the radio  To enter the  Partial  Off  mode  momentarily depress the    ESP  OFF  button and the  ESP TCS Indicator  Light  will illuminate  To turn the ESP on again  momen   tarily depress the  ESP OFF  button and the  ESP TCS  Indicator Light  will turn off     ESP  OFF    NOTE  To improve the vehicle s traction when driving  with snow chains  or when starting off in deep snow   sand  or gravel  it may be desirable to switch to the   Partial Off  mode by momentarily depressing the  ESP  OFF  button  Once the situation requiring  Partial Off   mode is overcome  turn the ESP on again by momentarily  depressing the  ESP OFF  button  This may be done  while the vehicle is in motion        218 STARTING AND OPERATING NEE Id    Full Off   This mode is intended for off highway or off road use  only and should not be used on any public roadways   In this mode  all TCS and ESP stability features are  turned off  To enter the  Full Off  mode  depress and  hold the  ESP OFF  button for 5 seconds while the  vehicle is stopped with the engine running  After 5  seconds  a chime will sound  the  ESP TCS Indicator  Light  will illuminate  and the  ESP OFF  message will  display in the vehicle odometer  Press and release the  trip odometer button located on the instrument cluster  to clear this message  The  ESP OFF  message may  appear in the Electronic Vehicle Information Center   EVIC   Refer to  Electronic Vehicle Information Cen   ter  EVIC    
319. ture Gauge  Engine Coolant        139 257  Tether Anchor  Child Restraint                50  Theft Alarm  Security Alarm                  15  Theft System  Security Alarm                 15  Tilt Seerne COMMUN issues ie REED HR DS 107  Tire and Loading Information Placard         225  Tire Identification Number  TIN              224  Tue MEES 14293 20792900628 2p d da T Rob ER 220  Tire Safety Information   a dcr ot 0002245 220  UREP oot eae use ze s Sane ee as S d EE 257  Uc v  58 229 343  Acme  Leo Tires   cuu vo vs mega ge 233  Air Eie Uie ACC  229  ZIP DEO eure ore HE X PER DEAD 235  CNAS s cscetatereseeene doe scew m 235  General Information                l l    229  Lie peed  ER 291  Inflation Pressures            Es se 230  liese Tires Rr 233  Load Capacity oa 6 2 4a HAS des DS 225 226    Pressure Monitor System  TPMS            239  urn secnm 343  Koal sesse ea 5454 EE ERIS b RS 232  Replies is EA HORE este RO ACE dd 234  eo ele 64 66 65 4 Se wee eS eos 655 res 237   n cue hs 1044644544 Sere TM 220 229  wp seed REKE REEDS AE owe ves 222  Snow Tires   41400445444 00  5406 be4 84 RE 236  EEND os EE ER es N E eee 232  Tread Wear Indicators                    233  TOWING   LEE 254  Behind a Motor Home                   254  Disabled Vehicle                    ss 266  Recreational                   eee eee 254  jun A P PLE 254  Towing Vehicle Behind a Motor Home         254  Traction Control  amp  sisie dem ho 215  Traer TOWNE AP LAER SR ER ee ee 254  Transmission        
320. turn off     The new Sentry Key is programmed  The Keyless Entry  Transmitter will also be programmed during this pro   cedure     Repeat this procedure to program up to 8 keys  If you do  not have a programmed sentry key  contact your dealer  for details     NOTE  If a programmed key is lost  see your dealer to  have all remaining keys erased from the systems  memory  This will prevent the lost key from starting your  vehicle  The remaining keys must then be repro   grammed  All vehicle keys must be taken to the dealer at  the time of service to be reprogrammed     NN THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15    General Information   The Sentry Key system complies with FCC rules part 15  and with RSS 210 of Industry Canada  Operation is  subject to the following conditions     e This device may not cause harmful interference     e This device must accept any interference that may be  received  including interference that may cause undes   ired operation     SECURITY ALARM SYSTEM     IF EQUIPPED   The Vehicle Security Alarm system monitors the vehicle  doors for unauthorized entry and the ignition switch for  unauthorized operation  If something triggers the alarm   the system will prevent the vehicle from starting and  provide the following audible and visual signals  the  horn will pulse  the headlights will flash  the park lights  will flash  and the Vehicle Security Alarm Indicator light  in the instrument cluster will flash     Rearming of the System    If something
321. ty Information  Tire    ale NOS ganed riana aa RE RR Aris RR 56  Satellite Radio                eese 171 176  Satellite Radio Antenna                    179  Schedule  Maintenance                 s    318  Seat Belt Maintenance                     299  Seat Belt Reminder                        35  Dear Des 6445 ooo oe eee soe ob EE 30  Adjustable Upper Shoulder Anchorage        34  And Pregnant Women soas cre y qoe e ES qe 37  Child Restraint                   47 A8 49 53  Extender 4264046 c4 0004458 S Td T d  pt Sy  Front Seat 4 4 4 4 404 9 dex SERS PR RES REO 30 31  Operating InStEuc lODS  id RE po Poppo    31  Pretensioners        SS ce eee eens 35  ker el E vore E E Cee E 30  Reminder   249a dese OR RAL SERS 140  Untwist  ng Procedure S oce me   ane et ean ees 35  DGS  444444064 WEE SISSE TRES SE Sa 2d 85  Ido A C   m 92  laco ia AREA EER SEL EA ROEI SR ed 87  Lumbar UP POE io o2 6 998 nn AR esc  dc ned 87  MIER OE ie 9235 8 20 9E ye eee 3 SAD ORE 90  luo Aa RE ob N EE EE ON 85    D EEEEIILIIIIIIGIIIIIIULLUIIUUILLLIGIUILILIIIU GIU mI iN    ULS   oLOLEGLGoGIAE   AA  PAG LLL B   dOGAA4CGODP BGGAU AGUG  LGd INDEX 357    Reat BOWING sanesas ENESE Erana 89   RE aie resepe rieh ntar EP EE 86  Security Alarm  Theft Alarm               15 140  Selection of Coolant  Antifreeze            288 314  Sentry Key diese  1 3 imu Ehren 12  Service Assistance                    len  338  Service Contract as wer 29 ETE ds E ON Es 340  Service Engine Soon Light   Malfunction Indicator       
322. ur  authorized dealer or repair facility  If your vehicle was  recently serviced or had a battery failure or replacement   you may need to do nothing more than drive your  vehicle as you normally would in order for your OBD  system to update  A recheck with the above test routine  may then indicate that the system is now ready     Regardless of whether your vehicle s OBD system is  ready or not ready  if the MIL symbol is illuminated  during normal vehicle operation  you should have your  vehicle serviced before going to the I M station  The I M  station can fail your vehicle because the MIL symbol is on  with the engine running     REPLACEMENT PARTS   Use of genuine Mopar  parts for normal scheduled  maintenance and repairs is highly recommended to in   sure the designed performance  Damage or failures  caused by the use of non Mopar  parts for maintenance  and repairs will not be covered by the manufacturer s  warranty     DEALER SERVICE   Your dealer has the qualified service personnel  special  tools  and equipment to perform all service operations in  an expert manner  Service Manuals are available which  include detailed service information for your vehicle   Refer to these manuals before attempting any procedure  yourself     NOTE  Intentional tampering with emissions control  systems can result in civil penalties being assessed  against you     N MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 275    WARNING     You can be badly injured working on or around a  motor vehicle  Only do service
323. ur fingers  Oil    812c4b54    contamination will severely shorten bulb life  If the    bulb comes in contact with an oily surface  clean the  d   Pull back the trunk liner   bulb with rubbing alcohol  3  Pull back the trunk liner       4  Remove the remaining fastener from the back of the  tail light assembly     5  Push the electrical connector locking tab to the side     310 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    6  Disconnect the electrical connector  7  Pull the tail light assembly clear from the vehicle to  access the bulbs  Turn bulb sockets counter clockwise to  remove     mE  iLLINLI  E       E  E          b  x  E  E  E  D  Di    TT seers    8  Turn the appropriate bulb and socket assembly  counter clockwise to remove it from the tail light assem     bly    r     eon      n   z  SRL  iU  2    pum  i       Te TeTveTTeT    i    Se  uL oar et    mE        amp 1 amp db1af          Tail Stop Light Bulb          MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 311        amp 18db1b4  amp iBdb1b9    2     Tail Light Bulb 3     Turn Signal Light Bulb       312 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE       81Brb1c8  4     Backup Light Bulb   9  Pull the bulb out of the socket assembly    10  Push the replacement bulb into the socket assembly     11  Reinstall the bulb and socket assembly into the tail  light assembly  and then turn it clockwise     12  Reinstall the tail light assembly  fasteners  electrical  connector  and trunk liner     13  Close the trunk        License Light  1  Remove the screws securing the ligh
324. urn by Turn Navigation      If Equipped   When ON is selected  the Turn by Turn directions will  appear in the display as the vehicle approaches a desig   nated turn within a programmed route  To make your  selection  press and release the FUNCTION SELECT  button until  ON  or  OFF  appears     N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 157     Display Units of Measure in    The EVIC  odometer  and navigation system  if  equipped  can be changed between English and Metric  units of measure  To make your selection  press and  release the FUNCTION SELECT button until  US  or     METRIC    appears       Automatic High Beams      If Equipped   When this feature is selected  the high beam headlights  will deactivate automatically under certain conditions  To  make your selection  press and release the FUNCTION  SELECT button until  ON  or  OFF  appears  Refer to     SmartBeams    in section 3 of this manual for more  information         SETTING THE ANALOG CLOCK   To set the analog clock at the top center of the instrument  panel  press and hold the button until the setting is  correct     ENE    Analog Clock    158 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  NN Id    RADIO GENERAL INFORMATION    Radio Broadcast Signals   Your new radio will provide excellent reception under  most operating conditions  Like any system  however  car  radios have performance limitations  due to mobile op   eration and natural phenomena  which might lead you to  believe your sound system is malfunctioning  To hel
325. urn off the  engine  Then  disconnect the TIREFIT system from the  tire and place it back in the vehicle     20  Release the parking brake and drive the vehicle for  approximately 10 minutes to ensure optimum distribu   tion of the tire sealant within the tire     21  Turn on the hazard warning flashers     22  Move the transmission selector lever to the PARK  position  turn off the engine  and set the parking brake     23  Disconnect the air pump hose  1  from the underside  of the sealant bottle  5  by flipping the hose valve open     24  Connect the air pump hose valve to the tire valve and  flip the hose valve closed     25  Check the pressure in the tire by reading the pressure  gauge  4   If the pressure is 19 psi  1 3 bar  or greater   proceed to the following step  NOTE  If the pressure is  less than 19 psi  1 3 bar   the tire is too badly damaged   Do not attempt to drive the vehicle further  Call for  assistance     26  Leave the parking brake set and the transmission  selector lever in PARK and start the engine     27  Inflate the tire to the pressure indicated on the tire  pressure label on the driver side latch pillar by pressing  the switch  3  on the air pump to I  ON  and watching the  pressure gauge  When the tire pressure is set to the  pressure indicated on the tire pressure label  press the air  pump switch  3  to 0  OFF  and turn off the engine     28  Disconnect the TIREFIT system from the tire and  reinstall the valve cap     29  Place the sealant kit b
326. urs with  the rear windows open  then open the front and rear  windows together to minimize the buffeting  If the       28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE M    buffeting occurs with the sunroof open  then adjust the  sunroof opening to minimize the buffeting     TRUNK LOCK AND RELEASE   The trunk lid can be released from inside the vehicle by  pressing the Trunk Release Button located on the instru   ment panel to the left of the steering wheel     OTE  The transmission must be in Park before the  switch will operate                                                                                                                                                       m  Eo  EIE  Pop see H  nt B E     2   E    ELEM EM bia Er ee n n am N me Pe ee Pe Li  atat atat dann mnm amm at ok oF ea ma n n m  a  a  a  a  a  a  ma  a oo                     PE nnn nnnm  TReDTvsTETTIIc c4 c4r1 14  RE E RR EE n mnn  VOC ee Eee eee ESE arra   eee tte eee eee            ax OM RR ee    eee IS ae PP EE  E TEE ee A els ee    recur a a AAN A a IS SEER EE USA N ee EE EER  E qaum  id       MAA AANA n ee z   E KANANAM te E       z     Hd   E   E   E   E   E       x    RR    meee    Trunk Release Button    The trunk lid can be released from outside the vehicle by  pressing the trunk button on the Remote Keyless Entry  Transmitter two times     With the ignition ON  the trunk open symbol will display  in the instrument cluster indicating that the trunk is  open  The odometer display will reappea
327. urther warranty information     e The air conditioning system contains refrigerant  under high pressure  To avoid risk of personal  injury or damage to the system  adding refrigerant  or any repair requiring lines to be disconnected  should be done by an experienced technician        Refrigerant Recovery and Recycling   R 134a Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocar   bon  HFC  that is endorsed by the Environmental Pro   tection Agency and is an ozone saving product  How   ever  the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning  service be performed by dealers or other service facilities  using recovery and recycling equipment     NOTE  Use only manufacturer approved A C System  Sealers  Stop Leak Products  Seal Conditioners  Compres   sor Oil  and Refrigerants     A C Air Filter     If Equipped   The filter is located in the fresh air inlet under the hood   behind a removable panel in the cowl on the passenger  side of the vehicle  next to the windshield wipers  When  installing a new filter  ensure its proper orientation  To  replace the filter remove the access door in the cowl  screen by pressing the retaining clips  Slide the lid on the  filter adapter forward and down and remove used filter   Install new filter with arrows pointing in the direction of  airflow  which is toward the rear of the vehicle  text and  arrows on the filter indicate this         284 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE NN Id    Refer to the  Maintenance Schedule  in this manual for  the recommended
328. use           When the seatback is folded to the upright position  make  sure it is latched by strongly pulling on the top of the  seatback above the seat strap     90 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE NNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNNN Id    DRIVER MEMORY SEAT     IF EQUIPPED MESES             EE  This feature allows the driver to store up to two different    memory profiles  for easy recall through a memory  switch  Each memory profile contains desired position  settings for the driver seat  side mirror  adjustable pedals      7  and power tilt and telescopic steering column  and a set      of desired radio station presets     The memory switch is located on the driver s door panel   The switch contains an  5  button to activate the memory  save function  It also contains a rocker switch labeled  with the number  1  and the number  2   The rocker  switch allows the driver to recall either of two pre   programmed memory profiles by pressing the appropri   ate side of the switch     po   ERA RE  E EE          Memory Switch    Programming The Memory Feature  To create a new memory profile  perform the following     NOTE  Saving a new memory profile will erase an  existing profile from memory     1  Adjust all memory profile settings to desired prefer   ences  i e  seat  side mirror  adjustable pedals  power tilt  and telescopic steering column  and radio station pre   sets      NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 91    2  Press and release the Set  5  button on the mem
329. uss options for channel blocking or  unblocking  Please have your ESN SID information  available     Storing and Selecting Pre Set Channels   In addition to the 12 AM and 12 FM pre set stations  you  may also commit 12 satellite stations to push button  memory  These satellite channel pre set stations will not  erase any AM or FM pre set memory stations  Follow the  memory pre set procedures that apply to your radio     Using the PTY  Program Type  Button  if  equipped    Follow the PTY button instructions that apply to your  radio     PTY Button  SCAN    When the desired program type is obtained  press the   SCAN  button within five seconds  The radio will play 7  seconds of the selected channel before moving to the next  channel of the selected program type  Press the  SCAN   button a second time to stop the search     NOTE  Pressing the  SEEK  or  SCAN  button  while  performing a music type scan  will change the channel by  one and stop the search  Pressing a pre set memory  button during a music type scan  will call up the memory  channel and stop the search     PTY Button  SEEK    When the desired program is obtained  press the  SEEK   button within five seconds  The channel will change to  the next channel that matches the program type selected     N UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 179    Satellite Antenna   To ensure optimum reception  do not place items on the  roof around the rooftop antenna location  Metal objects  placed within the line of sight of the antenna
330. ustable Pedal Switch       Press the switch forward to move the pedals forward   toward the front of the vehicle      Press the switch rearward to move the pedals rearward   toward the driver      e The pedals can be adjusted with the ignition OFF   e The pedals can be adjusted while driving     e The pedals cannot be adjusted when the vehicle is in R   Reverse  or when the Speed Control is ON  One of the  following messages will display in the Electronic Ve   hicle Information Center  EVIC  if a pedal adjustment  is attempted when the system is locked out   Adjust   able Pedal Disabled     Cruise Control Engaged  or    Adjustable Pedal Disabled     Vehicle In Reverse      NOTE  For vehicles equipped with Driver Memory  Seat  you can use your remote keyless entry transmitter  or the memory switch on the driver   s door panel to  return the adjustable pedals to pre programmed posi   tions  Refer to    Driver Memory Seat    in this section for  details     N UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 109    CAUTION     Do not place any article under the adjustable pedals  or impede its ability to move as it may cause damage  to the pedal controls  Pedal travel may become    limited if movement is stopped by an obstruction in  the adjustable pedal s path     ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL  When engaged  this device takes over the accelerator  operation at speeds greater than 25 mph  40 km h   s diio    1     RESUME  ACCEL  Electronic Speed Control Operation 2     SET DECEL    The spee
331. vehicle  set the Mode control to Panel   7  or Bi Level  AND VEHICLE INTERIOR IS L   and turn on A C  Set the Fan control to the High position  full clockwise    VERY HOT oet the temperature control to full cool  After the hot air is flushed from the vehicle   set the Mode control to Recirculate with A C on and roll up the windows   Once vou are comfortable  set the Mode control to Panel or Bi Level  with A G on     If it s sunny  set the Mode control to Panel and turn on A C  If it s cloudy or  dark  set the Mode control to Bi Level with A C on  Adjust Temperature    control for comfort     COOL OR COLD Set the Mode control to Defrost Floor or Defrost   Sg     HUMID CONDITIONS set the Fan Control to the High position  full clockwise   Adjust Fan and       TV Temperature control for comfort if windows are clear   b  COLD DRY Set the Mode control to Floor    J    If it s sunny  you may want more upper air   CONDITIONS i In this case  set the Mode control to Bi Level 24    In very cold weather  if you    need extra heat at the windshield  set the Mode control to Defrost Floor  SF Jor  CD Defrost   S   as needed  Adjust Fan and Temperature control for comfort  T          REAR WINDOW FEATURES    Electric Rear Window Defroster   The electric Rear Window Defroster Control is   located on the climate control  Press this button to  turn on the rear window defroster and the heated side  mirrors  if equipped   An LED in the button will illumi   nate when the rear window defroster is ON
332. vehicle to sway     e Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the top of the  seatback  This could impair visibility or become a  dangerous projectile in a sudden stop or collision     NN UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 129    LOAD LEVELING SYSTEM   The automatic load leveling system will provide a level   riding vehicle under most passenger and cargo loading  conditions     A hydraulic pump contained within the shock absorbers  raises the rear of the vehicle to the correct height  It takes  approximately 1 mile  1 6 km  of driving for the leveling  to complete depending on road surface conditions     If the leveled vehicle is not moved for approximately 15  hours  the leveling system will bleed itself down  The  vehicle must be driven to reset the system           UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL    CONTENTS    ll Instrument Panel And Controls              134  ll Premium Instrument Cluster               135  W Instrument Cluster Descriptions             136  lll Electronic Vehicle Information Center   nde 144  D Electronic Vehicle Information Center  EVIC   DEPIS see Spes bri dnd y foit ROS dor oa 145  Ede Eties Ui AAR ORE DEM 147  dt oupas Display  soe RAU ceteeatares 149  o Telephone     If Equipped sinies n 150  o Navigation     If Equipped                 152    O System Warnings   Customer Information Features     O Personal Settings     Customer Programmable Features           153   Mi Setting The Analog Clock                  157  W Radio General Infor
333. write to   NHTSA  U S  Dept  of Transportation  Washington DC  20590  You can also obtain other information about motor  vehicle safety from the Hotline     In Canada    If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect  you  should contact the Customer Service Department imme   diately  Canadian customers who wish to report a safety  defect to the Canadian government should write to  Transport Canada  Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations  and Recalls  2780 Sheffield Road  Ottawa  Ontario K1B  3V9     PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS   To order the following manuals  you may use either the  website or the phone numbers listed below  Visa  Mas   tercard  American Express  and Discover orders are ac   cepted  If you prefer mailing your payment  please call  for an order form     NOTE  A street address is required when ordering  manuals   No P O  Boxes         342    e Service Manuals     These comprehensive service manuals provide the  information that students and professional technicians  need in diagnosing  troubleshooting  problem solving   maintaining  servicing  and repairing DaimlerChrysler  Corporation vehicles  A complete working knowledge  of the vehicle  system  and or components is written  in straightforward language with illustrations  dia   grams  and charts     Diagnostic Procedure Manuals     Filled with diagrams  charts and detailed illustrations   these practical manuals make it easy for students and  technicians to find and fix problems on computer   controlled veh
334. y freeze  Do not attempt jump starting  because the battery could rupture or explode  The  battery temperature must be brought up above  freezing point before attempting jump start     2  Personal injury or property damage due to battery  explosion     3  Damage to charging system of booster vehicle or  of immobilized vehicle        7  Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster  battery  Let the engine idle a few minutes  Then  start the  engine in the vehicle with the discharged battery     NOTE  Refer to  Synchronizing ESP  under  Electronic  Brake Control System    in Section 5 of this manual if the  ESP BAS light  in the instrument cluster  remains on  continuously after starting the engine of the vehicle with  the discharged battery     NN WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 265  FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE    l  If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud  sand  or snow  it CAUTION     can often be moved by a rocking motion  Turn your e When    rocking    a stuck vehicle by moving be   steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the tween  First  and R  Reverse   do not spin the  front wheels  Then shift back and forth between Reverse wheels faster than 15 mph  24 km h   or drivetrain  and Drive  Usually the least accelerator pedal pressure to damage may result     maintain the rocking motion without spinning the    wheels is most effective  Racing the engine or spinning the wheels too fast    may lead to transmission overheating and failure   NOTE  Turn off the Electro
335. y surfaces  or  hydroplaning  Only a safe  attentive  and skillful  driver can prevent accidents  The capabilities of a  BAS equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a  reckless or dangerous manner  which could jeopar   dize the user s safety or the safety of others        ESP  Electronic Stability Program    This system enhances directional control and stability of  the vehicle under various driving conditions  The ESP  corrects for oversteering and understeering the vehicle  by applying the brake of the appropriate wheel  Engine  power may also be reduced to assist in counteracting the  condition of oversteer or understeer and help the vehicle  maintain the desired path     The ESP uses sensors in the vehicle to determine the path  that the driver intends to steer the vehicle and compares  it to the actual path of the vehicle  When the actual path  does not match the intended path  the ESP applies the  brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting  the condition of oversteer or understeer     e Oversteer   when the vehicle is turning more than  appropriate for the steering wheel position     e Understeer   when the vehicle is turning less than  appropriate for the steering wheel position    The  ESP TCS Indicator Light   located in the     instrument cluster  starts to flash as soon as the  tires lose traction and the ESP system becomes   active  The  ESP TCS Indicator Light    also   flashes when TCS is active  If the  ESP TCS Indicator  Light  begins to fla
336. ystem  These  and all other maintenance services  included in this manual  should be done to provide best  vehicle performance and reliability  More freguent main   tenance may be needed for vehicles in severe operating  conditions such as dusty areas and very short trip  driving     Inspection and service also should be done any time a  malfunction is suspected     NOTE  Maintenance  replacement  or repair of the  emission control devices and systems on your vehicle  may be performed by any automotive repair establish   ment or individual using any automotive part  which has  been certified pursuant to U S  EPA or  in the State of  California  California Air Resources Board regulations     MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  There are two maintenance schedules that show the  required service for your vehicle     First is Schedule  B   It is for vehicles that are operated  under the conditions that are listed below and at the  beginning of the schedule     Change the automatic transmission fluid and filter every  60 000 miles  100 000 km  if the vehicle is usually  operated under one or more of the conditions marked  with an        e Day or night temperatures are below 32  F  0  C    e Stop and go driving    e Extensive engine idling    e Driving in dusty conditions    e Short trips of less than 10 miles  16 km      e More than 5076 of your driving is at sustained high  speeds during hot weather  above 90  F  32  C      e Trailer towing        N MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 319    e Taxi  police
337. zed dealer  If the light stays on  flickers  or comes  on while driving  have the system checked by an autho   rized dealer     Defroster   Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and place  the blower control on high speed  You should be able to  feel the air directed against the windshield     Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside  The Vehicle    Tires   Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven wear  patterns  Check for stones  nails  glass  or other objects  lodged in the tread  Inspect the tread and sidewall for  cuts and cracks  Check the wheel nuts for tightness   Check the tires  including spare  for proper pressure     Lights   Have someone observe the operation of exterior lights  while you work the controls  Check turn signal and high  beam indicator lights on the instrument panel     Door Latches  Check for positive closing  latching  and locking     Fluid Leaks   Check area under vehicle after overnight parking for fuel   engine coolant  oil  or other fluid leaks  Also  if gasoline  fumes are detected or if fuel  power steering fluid  or  brake fluid leaks are suspected  the cause should be  located and corrected immediately        UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE    CONTENTS    B Mirrors    D Automatic Dimming Inside Mirror    O Outside Mirrors    o Exterior Mirrors Folding Feature       I EGUIPPed  ra ap RE DERE BRODE w    D Driver s Side Outside Mirror Auto Dimmer       O Tilt In Reverse Feature        ss ss SS ss  D Power Remo
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
防水pH計 取扱説明書  Manual - Radial Engineering  OM, 343 F, 345 FX, 345 FXT, 343 FR, 343 R, 345 RX  取扱説明書 - ロジテック  KitchenAid KBMC147H User's Manual  Hoja de datos - Elcometer NDT    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file